Draytek Vigor 2925 User Guide
Draytek Vigor 2925 User Guide
User’s Guide
Version: 4.5
Firmware Version: V3.8.5
(For future update, please visit DrayTek web site)
Date: December 13, 2017
ii
Vigor2925 Series User’s Guide
Copyrights
© All rights reserved. This publication contains information that is protected by copyright. No part may be
reproduced, transmitted, transcribed, stored in a retrieval system, or translated into any language without
written permission from the copyright holders.
Trademarks
The following trademarks are used in this document:
Microsoft is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corp.
Windows, Windows 95, 98, Me, NT, 2000, XP, Vista, 7 and Explorer are trademarks of Microsoft Corp.
Apple and Mac OS are registered trademarks of Apple Inc.
Other products may be trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective manufacturers.
Safety Instructions
Read the installation guide thoroughly before you set up the router.
The router is a complicated electronic unit that may be repaired only be authorized and qualified personnel.
Do not try to open or repair the router yourself.
Do not place the router in a damp or humid place, e.g. a bathroom.
The router should be used in a sheltered area, within a temperature range of +5 to +40 Celsius.
Do not expose the router to direct sunlight or other heat sources. The housing and electronic components
may be damaged by direct sunlight or heat sources.
Do not deploy the cable for LAN connection outdoor to prevent electronic shock hazards.
Keep the package out of reach of children.
When you want to dispose of the router, please follow local regulations on conservation of the environment.
Warranty
We warrant to the original end user (purchaser) that the router will be free from any defects in workmanship
or materials for a period of two (2) years from the date of purchase from the dealer. Please keep your
purchase receipt in a safe place as it serves as proof of date of purchase. During the warranty period, and upon
proof of purchase, should the product have indications of failure due to faulty workmanship and/or materials,
we will, at our discretion, repair or replace the defective products or components, without charge for either
parts or labor, to whatever extent we deem necessary tore-store the product to proper operating condition.
Any replacement will consist of a new or re-manufactured functionally equivalent product of equal value, and
will be offered solely at our discretion. This warranty will not apply if the product is modified, misused,
tampered with, damaged by an act of God, or subjected to abnormal working conditions. The warranty does
not cover the bundled or licensed software of other vendors. Defects which do not significantly affect the
usability of the product will not be covered by the warranty. We reserve the right to revise the manual and
online documentation and to make changes from time to time in the contents hereof without obligation to
notify any person of such revision or changes.
Be a Registered Owner
Web registration is preferred. You can register your Vigor router via http://www.DrayTek.com.
Firmware & Tools Updates
Due to the continuous evolution of DrayTek technology, all routers will be regularly upgraded. Please consult
the DrayTek web site for more information on newest firmware, tools and documents.
http://www.DrayTek.com
vi
Vigor2925 Series User’s Guide
II-5-3-2 Domain Diagnose ....................................................................... 167
II-5-4 Schedule......................................................................................................................... 168
II-5-5 RADIUS/TACACS+ ........................................................................................................ 171
II-5-5-1 External RADIUS ........................................................................ 171
II-5-5-2 Internal RADIUS ........................................................................ 172
II-5-5-3 External TACACS+...................................................................... 174
II-5-6 Active Directory/LDAP .................................................................................................... 175
II-5-6-1 General Setup .......................................................................... 175
II-5-6-2 Profiles .................................................................................. 176
II-5-7 UPnP .............................................................................................................................. 178
II-5-8 IGMP............................................................................................................................... 179
II-5-9 Wake on LAN ................................................................................................................. 180
II-5-10 SMS / Mail Alert Service............................................................................................... 181
II-5-10-1 SMS Alert............................................................................... 181
II-5-10-2 Mail Alert .............................................................................. 182
II-5-11 Bonjour ......................................................................................................................... 183
II-5-12 High Availability ............................................................................................................ 186
II-5-12-1 General Setup ......................................................................... 187
II-5-12-2 Config Sync ............................................................................ 188
II-5-13 Local 802.1X General Setup ........................................................................................ 191
Application Notes ..................................................................................................................... 193
A-1 How to use DrayDDNS? ..................................................................... 193
A-2 How to Configure Customized DDNS?.................................................... 198
A-3 How to Implement the LDAP/AD Authentication for User Management? ......... 202
II-6 Routing..................................................................................................................................... 205
Web User Interface .................................................................................................................. 206
II-6-1 Static Route .................................................................................................................... 206
II-6-2 Load-Balance /Route Policy ........................................................................................... 211
II-6-2-1 General Setup .......................................................................... 211
II-6-2-2 Diagnose ................................................................................. 216
II-6-3 BGP ................................................................................................................................ 218
II-6-3-1 Basic Settings ........................................................................... 218
II-6-3-1 Static Network ......................................................................... 219
Application Notes ..................................................................................................................... 220
A-1 How to Customize a Secure Route between VPN Router and Remote Router by Using
Route Policy ...................................................................................... 220
A-2 How to Setup Address Mapping........................................................... 224
A-3 How to setup Load Balance for Packets?................................................ 228
II-7 LTE ........................................................................................................................................... 230
Web User Interface .................................................................................................................. 231
II-7-1 General Settings............................................................................................................. 231
II-7-2 SMS Inbox ...................................................................................................................... 233
II-7-3 Send SMS ...................................................................................................................... 236
II-7-4 Router Commands ......................................................................................................... 237
II-7-5 Status ............................................................................................................................. 239
Part IV VoIP.....................................................................................................................277
IV-1 VoIP ........................................................................................................................................ 278
Web User Interface .................................................................................................................. 280
IV-1-1 VoIP Wizard .................................................................................................................. 280
IV-1-2 General Settings ........................................................................................................... 282
IV-1-3 SIP Accounts................................................................................................................. 285
IV-1-4 DialPlan......................................................................................................................... 290
IV-1-4-1 Phone Book ............................................................................. 290
IV-1-4-2 Digit Map ............................................................................... 292
IV-1-4-3 Call Barring ............................................................................ 294
IV-1-4-4 Regional ................................................................................ 296
IV-1-4-5 PSTN Setup ............................................................................. 297
IV-1-5 Phone Settings.............................................................................................................. 298
IV-1-6 Status ............................................................................................................................ 302
viii
Vigor2925 Series User’s Guide
V-1-9 VPN Trunk Management ............................................................................................... 338
V-1-10 Connection Management............................................................................................. 347
Application Notes ..................................................................................................................... 349
A-1 How to Build a LAN-to-LAN VPN Between Remote Office and Headquarter via IPsec
Tunnel (Main Mode) ............................................................................. 349
V-2 SSL VPN .................................................................................................................................. 354
Web User Interface .................................................................................................................. 355
V-2-1 General Setup ................................................................................................................ 355
V-2-2 SSL Web Proxy.............................................................................................................. 356
V-2-3 SSL Application.............................................................................................................. 358
V-2-4 User Account.................................................................................................................. 360
V-2-5 User Group..................................................................................................................... 364
V-2-6 Online User Status ......................................................................................................... 366
V-3 Certificate Management........................................................................................................... 367
Web User Interface .................................................................................................................. 368
V-3-1 Local Certificate ............................................................................................................. 368
V-3-2 Trusted CA Certificate.................................................................................................... 372
V-3-3 Certificate Backup .......................................................................................................... 374
x
Vigor2925 Series User’s Guide
A-2 How to create Google APP for Web Portal Authentication? ......................... 544
VII-5 Central Management (VPN) .................................................................................................. 547
Web User Interface .................................................................................................................. 548
VII-5-1 General Setup .............................................................................................................. 548
VII-5-1-1 General Settings...................................................................... 548
VII-5-1-2 IPsec VPN Settings.................................................................... 549
VII-4-2 CPE Management........................................................................................................ 550
VII-4-2-1 Managed Device List ................................................................. 550
VII-5-2-2 CPE Maintenance ..................................................................... 553
VII-5-2-3 Google Map ............................................................................ 555
VII-5-3 VPN Management........................................................................................................ 556
VII-5-4 Log & Alert ................................................................................................................... 557
Application Notes ..................................................................................................................... 558
A-1 CVM Application - How to manage the CPE (router) through Vigor2925 series? . 558
A-2 CVM Application - How to build the VPN between remote devices and Vigor2925
series? ............................................................................................. 562
A-3 CVM Application - How to upgrade CPE firmware through Vigor2925 series? .... 564
VII-6 Central Management (AP)..................................................................................................... 567
Web User Interface .................................................................................................................. 568
VII-6-1 Dashboard.................................................................................................................... 568
VII-6-2 Status ........................................................................................................................... 569
VII-6-3 WLAN Profile................................................................................................................ 570
VII-6-4 AP Maintenance........................................................................................................... 575
VII-6-5 AP Map ........................................................................................................................ 576
VII-6-6 Traffic Graph ................................................................................................................ 581
VII-6-7 Temperature Sensor .................................................................................................... 582
VII-6-8 Rogue AP Detection..................................................................................................... 583
VII-6-9 Event Log ..................................................................................................................... 586
VII-6-10 Total Traffic ................................................................................................................ 586
VII-6-11 Station Number .......................................................................................................... 587
VII-6-12 Load Balance ............................................................................................................. 587
VII-6-13 Function Support List ................................................................................................. 589
Application Notes ..................................................................................................................... 590
A-1 How to use AP Management function (in Vigor2925) to check AP status and deploy
WLAN profile ..................................................................................... 590
VII-7 Central Management (Switch) ............................................................................................... 593
VII-7-1 Status ........................................................................................................................... 593
VII-7-1-1 Switch Status.......................................................................... 593
VII-7-1-2 Switch Hierarchy ..................................................................... 596
VII-7-2 Profile ........................................................................................................................... 597
VII-7-3 Group ........................................................................................................................... 600
VII-7-4 Maintenance................................................................................................................. 602
VII-7-5 Alert and Log................................................................................................................ 603
VII-7-5-1 Alert Setup ............................................................................ 603
VII-7-5-2 Switch and Port Setup ............................................................... 604
xii
Vigor2925 Series User’s Guide
IX-1-4 IPv6 Neighbour Table ................................................................................................... 662
IX-1-5 DHCP Table .................................................................................................................. 663
IX-1-6 NAT Sessions Table ..................................................................................................... 664
IX-1-7 DNS Cache Table ......................................................................................................... 665
IX-1-8 Ping Diagnosis .............................................................................................................. 666
IX-1-9 Data Flow Monitor ......................................................................................................... 667
IX-1-10 Traffic Graph ............................................................................................................... 670
IX-1-11 VPN Graph.................................................................................................................. 671
IX-1-12 Trace Route ................................................................................................................ 672
IX-1-13 Syslog Explorer ........................................................................................................... 673
IX-1-14 IPv6 TSPC Status ....................................................................................................... 674
IX-1-15 High Availability Status ............................................................................................... 675
IX-1-16 Authentication Information .......................................................................................... 677
IX-1-17 DoS Flood Table ......................................................................................................... 678
IX-1-18 Route Policy Diagnosis ............................................................................................... 680
IX-2 Checking If the Hardware Status Is OK or Not ....................................................................... 682
IX-3 Checking If the Network Connection Settings on Your Computer Is OK or Not..................... 683
IX-4 Pinging the Router from Your Computer ................................................................................ 686
IX-5 Checking If the ISP Settings are OK or Not............................................................................ 688
IX-6 Problems for 3G/4G Network Connection .............................................................................. 689
IX-7 Backing to Factory Default Setting If Necessary .................................................................... 690
IX-8 Contacting DrayTek ................................................................................................................ 692
Appendix I: VLAN Applications on Vigor Router ............................................................................ 693
Index ...............................................................................................................................926
Vigor2925 series integrates IP layer QoS, NAT session/bandwidth management to help users
control works well with large bandwidth.
By adopting hardware-based VPN platform and hardware encryption of AES/DES/3DES, the
router increases the performance of VPN greatly, and offers several protocols (such as
IPSec/PPTP/L2TP) with VPN tunnels.
The object-based design used in SPI (Stateful Packet Inspection) firewall allows users to set
firewall policy with ease. CSM (Content Security Management) provides users control and
management in IM (Instant Messenger) and P2P (Peer to Peer) more efficiency than before. By
the way, DoS/DDoS prevention and URL/Web content filter strengthen the security outside
and control inside. Object-based firewall is flexible and allows your network be safe.
User Management implemented on your router firmware can allow you to prevent any
computer from accessing your Internet connection without a username or password. You can
also allocate time budgets to your employees within office network.
With the 6-port Gigabit switch on the LAN side provides extremely high speed connectivity for
the highest speed local data transfer of any server or local PCs. The tagged VLANs
(IEEE802.1Q) can mark data with a VLAN identifier. This identifier can be carried through an
onward Ethernet switch to specific ports. The specific VLAN clients can also pick up this
identifier as it is just passed to the LAN. You can set the priorities for LAN-side QoS. You can
assign each of VLANs to each of the different IP subnets that the router may also be operating,
to provide even more isolation. The said functionality is tag-based Multi-subnet
(Multiple-Private LAN Subnets).
On the Wireless-equipped models (Vigor2925n/n-plus/Vn/Vn-plus/ac/Vac) each of the
wireless SSIDs can also be grouped within one of the VLANs.
In addition, Vigor2925 series supports USB interface for connecting USB printer to share
printing function or 3G USB modem for network connection.
Vigor2925 series provides two-level management to simplify the configuration of network
connection. The user mode allows user accessing into WEB interface via simple configuration.
However, if users want to have advanced configurations, they can access into WEB interface
through admin mode.
Interface Description
Factory Reset Restore the default settings. Usage: Turn on the router (ACT LED is
blinking). Press the hole and keep for more than 5 seconds. When you
see the ACT LED begins to blink rapidly than usual, release the button.
Then the router will restart with the factory default configuration.
USB1~USB2 Connector for a USB device (for 3G/4G USB Modem or printer or
Environmental Thermometer).
WAN1 Fiber connection (100Mbps) for accessing the Internet.
(for Vigor2925F)
WAN1~WAN2 Connecter for local network devices or modem for accessing Internet.
LAN1~LAN5 Connecters for local network devices.
PWR Connecter for a power adapter.
ON/OFF Power Switch.
SIM Card Slot Connector for a SIM card.
Extension
Base
There are two mounting holes for installing antennas with sockets on Vigor router. Please
install them as shown below.
Major Signal
Transmitted Hole
SIM Card
Slot
Note, if only one antenna shall be installed, please use the mounting hole (major signal
transmitted hole) near to the SIM card slot.
Interface Description
Wireless LAN For Vigor2925n/Vigor2925Fn/Vigor2925Ln :
ON/OFF/WPS Press the button and release it within 2 seconds. When the
wireless function is ready, the green LED will be on.
Press the button and release it within 2 seconds to turn off the
WLAN function. When the wireless function is not ready, the
LED will be off.
For Vigor2925ac/Vigor2925n-plus:
Wireless band will be switched /changed according to the button
pressed and released. For example,
2.4G (On) and 5G (On) – in default.
2.4G (Off) and 5G (On) – pressed and released the button once.
2.4G (On) and 5G (Off) – pressed and released the button
twice.
2.4G (Off) and 5G (Off) – pressed and released the button three
times.
When WPS function is enabled by web user interface, press this
Extension
Base
Major Signal
Transmitted Hole
SIM Card
Slot
Note, if only one antenna shall be installed, please use the mounting hole (major signal
transmitted hole) near to the SIM card slot.
While installing the SIM card into the card slot, note that back plate of the SIM card slot must
be removed first and the direction of card notch must be on the left side.
Before using it, please follow the steps below to configure settings for connected computers
(or wireless clients).
1. Connect the printer with the router through USB/parallel port.
2. Open All Programs>>Getting Started>>Devices and Printers.
5. In this dialog, choose Create a new port. In the field of Type of port, use the drop down
list to select Standard TCP/IP Port. Then, click Next.
13. Edit the property of the new printer you have added by clicking Configure Port.
The printer can be used for printing now. Most of the printers with different manufacturers
are compatible with vigor router.
Info Some printers with the fax/scanning or other additional functions are not
supported.
Vigor router supports printing request from computers via LAN ports but not
WAN port.
Info If you fail to access to the web configuration, please go to “Trouble Shooting” for
detecting and solving your problem.
Info The home page will be different slightly in accordance with the type of the
router you have.
5. The web page can be logged out according to the chosen condition. The default setting
is Auto Logout, which means the web configuration system will logout after 5 minutes
without any operation. Change the setting for your necessity.
Please change the password for the original security of the router.
1. Open a web browser on your PC and type http://192.168.1.1. A pop-up window will
open to ask for username and password.
2. Please type “admin/admin” as Username/Password for accessing into the web user
interface with admin mode.
3. Go to System Maintenance page and choose Administrator Password.
4. Enter the login password (the default is “admin”) on the field of Old Password. Type
New Password and Confirm Password. Then click OK to continue.
Info The maximum length of the password you can set is 23 characters.
5. Now, the password has been changed. Next time, use the new password to access the
Web user interface for this router.
Info Even the password is changed, the Username for logging onto the web user interface
is still “admin”.
Dashboard shows the connection status including System Information, IPv4 Internet Access,
IPv6 Internet Access, Interface (physical connection), Security and Quick Access.
Click Dashboard from the main menu on the left side of the main page.
A web page with default selections will be displayed on the screen. Refer to the following
figure:
For detailed information about the LED display, refer to I-1-1 LED Indicators and
Connectors.
The function links of System Status, Dynamic DDNS, TR-069, User Management, IM/P2P Block,
Schedule, Syslog/Mail Alert, LDAP, RADIUS, Firewall Object Setting and Data Flow Monitor are
displayed here. Move your mouse cursor on any one of the links and click on it. The
corresponding setting page will be open immediately.
In addition, quick access for VPN security settings such as Remote Dial-in User and LAN to
LAN are located on the bottom of this page. Scroll down the page to find them and use them
if required.
Host connected physically to the router via LAN port(s) will be displayed with green circles in
the field of Connected.
All of the hosts (including wireless clients) displayed with Host ID, IP Address and MAC address
indicates that the traffic would be transmitted through LAN port(s) and then the WAN port.
The purpose is to perform the traffic monitor of the host(s).
All the functions the router supports are listed with table clearly in this page. Users can click
the function link to access into the setting page of the function for detailed configuration.
Click the icon on the top of the main screen to display all the functions.
It is not necessary to use the telnet command via DOS prompt. The changes made by using
web console have the same effects as modified through web user interface. The
functions/settings modified under Web Console also can be reviewed on the web user
interface.
Click the Web Console icon on the top of the main screen to open the following screen.
There is one way to store current used settings quickly by clicking the Config Backup icon. It
allows you to backup current settings as a file. Such configuration file can be restored by
using System Maintenance>>Configuration Backup.
Simply click the icon on the top of the main screen and a pop up dialog will appear.
I-5-9 Logout
Item Description
LAN Status Primary DNS-Displays the primary DNS server address for
WAN interface.
Secondary DNS -Displays the secondary DNS server address
for WAN interface.
IP Address-Displays the IP address of the LAN interface.
TX Packets-Displays the total transmitted packets at the
LAN interface.
RX Packets-Displays the total received packets at the LAN
interface.
WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 Enable – Yes in red means such interface is available but
/WAN4 Status not enabled. Yes in green means such interface is enabled.
Line – Displays the physical connection (VDSL, ADSL,
Ethernet, or USB) of this interface.
Name – Display the name of the router.
Mode - Displays the type of WAN connection (e.g., PPPoE).
Up Time - Displays the total uptime of the interface.
IP - Displays the IP address of the WAN interface.
GW IP - Displays the IP address of the default gateway.
Item Description
LAN Status IP Address- Displays the IPv6 address of the LAN interface..
TX Packets-Displays the total transmitted packets at the LAN
interface.
RX Packets-Displays the total received packets at the LAN
interface.
TX Bytes - Displays the speed of transmitted octets at the
LAN interface.
RX Bytes - Displays the speed of received octets at the LAN
interface.
WAN IPv6 Status Enable – No in red means such interface is available but not
enabled. Yes in green means such interface is enabled. No in
red means such interface is not available.
Mode - Displays the type of WAN connection (e.g., TSPC).
Up Time - Displays the total uptime of the interface.
IP - Displays the IP address of the WAN interface.
Gateway IP - Displays the IP address of the default gateway.
Info The words in green mean that the WAN connection of that interface is ready for
accessing Internet; the words in red mean that the WAN connection of that interface
is not ready for accessing Internet.
Quick Start Wizard can help you to deploy and use the router easily and quickly. Go to
Wizards>>Quick Start Wizard. The first screen of Quick Start Wizard is entering login
password. After typing the password, please click Next.
On the next page as shown below, please select the WAN interface that you use. If Ethernet
interface is used, please choose WAN1/WAN2; if 3G/4G USB modem is used, please choose
WAN3/WAN4; if LTE SIM card is used, please choose LTE.. Then click Next for next step.
WAN1, WAN2, WAN3/LTE and WAN4 will bring up different configuration page. Refer to the
following for detailed information. In which, WAN3 will be treated as USB WAN or LTE WAN
according to the USB modem or SIM Card used for accessing Internet.
On the next page as shown below, please select the appropriate Internet access type
according to the information from your ISP. For example, you should select PPPoE mode if the
ISP provides you PPPoE interface. Then click Next for next step.
PPPoE
1. Choose WAN1/WAN2 as the WAN Interface and click the Next button. The following
page will be open for you to specify Internet Access Type.
Item Description
Service Name Enter the description of the specific network service.
(Optional)
Username Assign a specific valid user name provided by the ISP.
Note: The maximum length of the user name you can set is
63 characters.
Password Assign a valid password provided by the ISP.
Note: The maximum length of the password you can set is 62
characters.
Confirm Password Retype the password.
Back Click it to return to previous setting page.
Next Click it to get into the next setting page.
Cancel Click it to give up the quick start wizard.
4. Click Finish. A page of Quick Start Wizard Setup OK!!! will appear. Then, the system
status of this protocol will be shown.
2. Click PPTP/L2TP as the Internet Access Type. Then click Next to continue.
Item Description
Username Assign a specific valid user name provided by the ISP.
Note: The maximum length of the user name you can set is
63 characters.
Password Assign a valid password provided by the ISP.
Note: The maximum length of the password you can set is 62
characters.
Confirm Password Retype the password.
WAN IP Configuration Obtain an IP address automatically – the router will get an
IP address automatically from DHCP server.
4. Click Finish. A page of Quick Start Wizard Setup OK!!! will appear. Then, the system
status of this protocol will be shown.
2. Click Static IP as the Internet Access type. Simply click Next to continue.
Item Description
WAN IP Type the IP address.
Subnet Mask Type the subnet mask.
Gateway Type the IP address of gateway.
Primary DNS Type in the primary IP address for the router.
Secondary DNS Type in secondary IP address for necessity in the future.
Back Click it to return to previous setting page.
Next Click it to get into the next setting page.
3. Please type in the IP address information originally provided by your ISP. Then click Next
for next step.
4. Click Finish. A page of Quick Start Wizard Setup OK!!! will appear. Then, the system
status of this protocol will be shown.
DHCP
1. Choose WAN2 as the WAN Interface and choose Ethernet as the Physical Mode. Click
the Next button. The following page will be open for you to specify Internet Access
Type.
2. Click DHCP as the Internet Access type. Simply click Next to continue.
Item Description
Host Name Type the name of the host.
Note: The maximum length of the host name you can set is
39 characters.
MAC Some Cable service providers specify a specific MAC address
for access authentication. In such cases you need to enter
the MAC address.
Back Click it to return to previous setting page.
Next Click it to get into the next setting page.
Cancel Click it to give up the quick start wizard.
3. After finished the settings above, click Next for viewing summary of such connection.
Item Description
Internet Access Choose one of the selections as the protocol of accessing the
internet.
4. Click Finish. A page of Quick Start Wizard Setup OK!!! will appear. Then, the system
status of this protocol will be shown.
Item Description
Internet Access Now, DHCP mode is the only choice for LTE WAN.
3G/4G USB Modem SIM Pin code – Type PIN code of the SIM card that will be
(DHCP mode) used to access Internet.
Network Mode – Force Vigor router to connect Internet with
the mode specified here. If you choose 4G/3G/2G as network
mode, the router will choose a suitable one according to the
actual wireless signal automatically.
APN Name – APN means Access Point Name which is provided
and required by some ISPs.
4. Click Finish. A page of Quick Start Wizard Setup OK!!! will appear. Then, the system
status of this protocol will be shown.
Service Activation Wizard can guide you to activate WCF service (Web Content Filter) with a
quick and easy way. For the Service Activation Wizard is only available for admin
operation, therefore, please type “admin/admin” on Username/Password while Logging
into the web user interface.
Service Activation Wizard is a tool which allows you to use trial version of WCF directly
without accessing into the server (MyVigor) located on http://myvigor.draytek.com. For
using Web Content Filter Profile, please refer to later section Web Content Filter Profile for
detailed information.
Now, follow the steps listed below to activate WCF feature for your router.
2. In the following page, you can activate the Web content filter services, APPE
Enforcement service, and DrayTek DDNS service at the same time or individually. When
you finish the selection, please click Next.
Info The service will be activated and applied as the default rule configured in
Firewall>>General Setup.
4. Now, the web page will display the service that you have activated according to your
selection(s). The valid time for the free trial of these services is one month.
You have finished the configuration of Quick Start Wizard and you can surf the Internet at any
time. Now it is the time to register your Vigor router to MyVigor website for getting more
service. Please follow the steps below to finish the router registration.
1 Please login the web configuration interface of Vigor router by typing “admin/admin” as
User Name / Password.
3 A Login page will be shown on the screen. Please type the account and password that
you created previously. And click Login.
4 The following page will be displayed after you logging in MyVigor. When the following
page appears, please type in Nickname (for the router) and choose the right registration
date from the popup calendar (it appears when you click on the box of Registration
Date). Click Add.
5 When the following page appears, your router information has been added to the
database.
6 After clicking OK, you will see the following page. Your router has been registered to
myvigor website successfully.
LTE Application
Item Description
Load Balance Mode This option is available for multiple-WAN for getting enough
bandwidth for each WAN port. If you know the practical
Item Description
Enable Choose Yes to invoke the settings for this WAN interface.
Choose No to disable the settings for this WAN interface.
Display Name Type the description for such WAN interface.
Physical Mode Display the physical mode of such WAN interface.
Physical Type You can change the physical type for WAN2 or choose Auto
negotiation for determined by the system.
Or
Item Description
Enable Choose Yes to invoke the settings for this WAN interface.
Choose No to disable the settings for this WAN interface.
Display Name Type the description for such WAN interface.
Physical Mode Display the physical mode of such WAN interface.
Line Speed If your choose According to Line Speed as the Load Balance
Mode, please type the line speed for downloading and
uploading for such WAN interface. The unit is kbps.
Active Mode Choose Always On to make the WAN2 connection being
activated always.
Item Description
Index Display the WAN interface.
Display Name It shows the name of the WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 or LTE/WAN4
that entered in general setup.
Physical Mode It shows the physical connection for WAN1/WAN2
(Ethernet) /WAN3 or LTE /WAN4 (USB) according to the
real network connection.
Access Mode Use the drop down list to choose a proper access mode. The
details page of that mode will be popped up. If not, click
Details Page for accessing the page to configure the
settings.
Details Page This button will open different web page (based on IPv4)
according to the access mode that you choose in WAN
interface.
IPv6 This button will open different web page (based on Physical
Mode) to setup IPv6 Internet Access Mode for WAN
interface.
If IPv6 service is active on this WAN interface, the color of
“IPv6” will become green.
Advanced This button allows you to configure DHCP client options.
DHCP packets can be processed by adding option number
and data information when such function is enabled and
configured.
Item Description
Enable/Disable Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
this function will be closed and all the settings that you
adjusted in this page will be invalid.
ISP Access Setup Enter your allocated username, password and authentication
parameters according to the information provided by your
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
Item Description
Enable / Disable Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
this function will be closed and all the settings that you
adjusted in this page will be invalid.
Keep WAN Connection Normally, this function is designed for Dynamic IP
environments because some ISPs will drop connections if
there is no traffic within certain periods of time. Check
Enable PING to keep alive box to activate this function.
PING to the IP - If you enable the PING function, please
specify the IP address for the system to PING it for keeping
alive.
PING Interval - Enter the interval for the system to execute
the PING operation.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through ARP Detect or Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose ARP Detect, Ping Detect or Always On for
the system to execute for WAN detection. If you choose Ping
Detect as the detection mode, you have to type required
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
Item Description
PPTP/L2TP Enable PPTP- Click this radio button to enable a PPTP client
to establish a tunnel to a DSL modem on the WAN interface.
Enable L2TP - Click this radio button to enable a L2TP client
to establish a tunnel to a DSL modem on the WAN interface.
Disable – Click this radio button to close the connection
through PPTP or L2TP.
Server Address - Specify the IP address of the PPTP/L2TP
server if you enable PPTP/L2TP client mode.
Specify Gateway IP Address – Specify the gateway IP address
for DHCP server.
ISP Access Setup Username -Type in the username provided by ISP in this
field. The maximum length of the user name you can set is 63
characters.
Password -Type in the password provided by ISP in this field.
The maximum length of the password you can set is 62
characters.
Index (1-15) in Schedule Setup - You can type in four sets of
time schedule for your request. All the schedules can be set
previously in Application >> Schedule web page and you can
use the number that you have set in that web page.
MTU It means Max Transmit Unit for packet.
Path MTU Discovery – It is used to detect the maximum MTU
size of a packet not to be segmented in specific transmit
path.
Click Detect to open the following dialog.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
Item Description
Enable/Disable Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
this function will be closed and all the settings that you
adjusted in this page will be invalid.
Obtain an IP address Click this radio button to obtain the IP address automatically
automatically if you want to use Dynamic IP mode.
Specify an IP address Click this radio button to specify dome data if you want to
use Static IP mode.
IP address - Type the IP address.
Subnet Mask - Type the subnet mask.
Gateway IP Address - Type the gateway IP address.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through ARP Detect or Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose ARP Detect, Ping Detect or Always On for
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
Item Description
Modem Support List It lists all of the modems supported by such router.
3G /4G USB Modem (PPP Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
mode) this function will be closed and all the settings that you
adjusted in this page will be invalid.
SIM PIN code Type PIN code of the SIM card that will be used to access
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
II-1-2-6 Details Page for 3G/4G USB Modem (DHCP mode) in WAN3/WAN4
To use 3G/4G USB Modem (DHCP mode) as the accessing protocol of the internet, please
choose Internet Access from WAN menu. Then, select 3G/4G USB Modem (DHCP mode) for
WAN3/WAN4. The following web page will be shown.
Item Description
Modem Support List It lists all of the modems supported by such router.
3G/4G USB Modem (DHCP Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
mode) this function will be closed and all the settings that you
adjusted in this page will be invalid.
SIM PIN code Type PIN code of the SIM card that will be used to access
Internet.
The maximum length of the PIN code you can set is 19
characters.
Network Mode Force Vigor router to connect Internet with the mode
specified here. If you choose 4G/3G/2G as network mode,
the router will choose a suitable one according to the actual
wireless signal automatically.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
II-1-2-7 Details Page for 3G/4G USB Modem (DHCP mode) in LTE WAN
It is available for “L” model only. LTE WAN uses the embedded LTE module to access internet.
To use 3G/4G USB Modem (DHCP mode) as the accessing protocol of the internet, please
choose Internet Access from WAN menu. Then, select 3G/4G USB Modem (DHCP mode) for
LTE. The following web page will be shown.
Item Description
3G/4G USB Modem (DHCP Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
mode) this function will be closed and all the settings that you
adjusted in this page will be invalid.
SIM PIN code Type PIN code of the SIM card that will be used to access
Internet.
The maximum length of the PIN code you can set is 19
characters.
Network Mode Force Vigor router to connect Internet with the mode
specified here. If you choose 4G/3G/2G as network mode,
the router will choose a suitable one according to the actual
wireless signal automatically.
APN Name APN means Access Point Name which is provided and
required by some ISPs. Type the name and click Apply.
The maximum length of the name you can set is 47
characters.
UserName Type the username (optional). The maximum length of the
name you can set is 47 characters.
Password Type the password (optional). The maximum length of the
password you can set is 62 characters.
Authentication Select None or PAP or CHAP.
MTU It means Max Transmit Unit for packet.
Path MTU Discovery – It is used to detect the maximum MTU
size of a packet not to be segmented in specific transmit
path.
Click Choose IP to open the following dialog.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
Item Description
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose Always On or Ping Detect for the system to
execute for WAN detection. Always On means no detection
will be executed. The network connection will be on always.
Ping IP/Hostname – If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type IP address in this field
for pinging.
TTL (Time to Live) –If you choose Ping Detect as
Below shows an example for successful IPv6 connection based on PPP mode.
Info At present, the IPv6 prefix can be acquired via the PPPoE mode connection which is
available for the areas such as Taiwan (hinet), the Netherlands, Australia and UK.
Item Description
Username Type the name obtained from the broker. It is suggested for
you to apply another username and password for
http://gogonet.gogo6.com/page/freenet6-account.
The maximum length of the name you can set is 63
characters.
Password Type the password assigned with the user name.
The maximum length of the name you can set is 19
characters.
Tunnel Broker Type the address for the tunnel broker IP, FQDN or an
optional port number.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose Always On or Ping Detect for the system to
execute for WAN detection. Always On means no detection
will be executed. The network connection will be on always.
Ping IP/Hostname – If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type IP address in this field
for pinging.
TTL (Time to Live) –If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type TTL value.
Item Description
Always On Check this box to keep the network connection always.
Username Type the name obtained from the broker. Please apply new
account at http://www.sixxs.net/. It is suggested for you to
apply another username and password.
The maximum length of the name you can set is 19
characters.
Password Type the password assigned with the user name.
The maximum length of the password you can set is 19
characters.
Tunnel Broker It means a server of AICCU. The server can provide IPv6
tunnels to sites or end users over IPv4.
Type the address for the tunnel broker IP, FQDN or an
optional port number.
Tunnel ID One user account may have several tunnels. And, each
tunnel shall have one specified tunnel ID (e.g., T115394).
Type the ID offered by Tunnel Broker.
Subnet Prefix Type the subnet prefix address obtained from service
provider.
The maximum length of the prefix you can set is 128
characters.
Item Description
Identify Association Choose Prefix Delegation or Non-temporary Address as
the identify association.
IAID Type a number as IAID.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through NS Detect or Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose Always On, Ping Detect or NS Detect for
the system to execute for WAN detection. With NS Detect
mode, the system will check if network connection is
established or not, like IPv4 ARP Detect. Always On means
no detection will be executed. The network connection will
be on always.
Ping IP/Hostname – If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type IP address in this field
for pinging.
TTL (Time to Live) –If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type TTL value.
RIPng Protocol RIPng (RIP next generation) offers the same functions and
benefits as IPv4 RIP v2.
Bridge Mode Enable Bridge Mode - If the function is enabled, the router
will work as a bridge modem.
Enable Firewall – It is available when Bridge Mode is
enabled. When both Bridge Mode and Firewall check boxes
are enabled, the settings configured (user profiles) under
User Management will be ignored. And all of the filter rules
defined and enabled in Firewall menu will be activated.
Bridge Subnet – Make a bridge between the selected LAN
Item Description
Static IPv6 Address IPv6 Address – Type the IPv6 Static IP Address.
configuration Prefix Length – Type the fixed value for prefix length.
Add – Click it to add a new entry.
Delete – Click it to remove an existed entry.
Current IPv6 Address Display current interface IPv6 address.
Table
Static IPv6 Gateway IPv6 Gateway Address - Type your IPv6 gateway address
Configuration here.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose Always On or Ping Detect for the system to
execute for WAN detection. Always On means no detection
will be executed. The network connection will be on always.
Ping IP/Hostname – If you choose Ping Detect as
Item Description
Remote Endpoint IPv4 Type the static IPv4 address for the remote server.
Address
6in4 IPv6 Address Type the static IPv6 address for IPv4 tunnel with the value
for prefix length.
LAN Routed Prefix Type the static IPv6 address for LAN routing with the value
for prefix length.
Tunnel TTL Type the number for the data lifetime in tunnel.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose Always On or Ping Detect for the system to
execute for WAN detection. Always On means no detection
will be executed. The network connection will be on
always.
Ping IP/Hostname – If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type IP address in this field
for pinging.
TTL (Time to Live) –If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type TTL value.
Item Description
6rd Mode Auto 6rd – Retrieve 6rd prefix automatically from 6rd
service provider. The IPv4 WAN must be set as "DHCP".
Static 6rd - Set 6rd options manually.
General
This page shows the basic configurations used by every channel.
Item Description
Channel Display the number of each channel.
Channels 1 and 2 are used by the Internet Access web user
interface and can not be configured here.
Channels 5 ~ 10 are configurable.
Enable Display whether the settings in this channel are enabled
(Yes) or not (No).
WAN Type Displays the physical medium that the channel will use.
VLAN Tag Displays the VLAN tag value that will be used for the packets
traveling on this channel.
Port-based Bridge The network traffic flowing on each channel will be
identified by the system via their VLAN Tags. Channels using
the same WAN type may not configure the same VLAN tag
value.
Enable - Check this box to enable the port-based bridge
function on this channel.
WAN links for Channel 5, 6 and 7 are provided for router-borne application such as TR-069.
The settings must be applied and obtained from your ISP. For your special request, please
contact with your ISP and then click WAN link of Channel 5, 6 or 7 to configure your router.
Item Description
Multi-VLAN Channel 5/6/7 Enable – Select to enable this channel.
Disable – Select to disable this channel.
WAN Type The connections and interfaces created in every channel may
select a specific WAN type to be built upon. In the
Multi-VLAN application, only the Ethernet WAN type is
available. The user will be able to select the physical WAN
interface the channel shall use here.
ISP Access Setup This section is available when PPPoE / PPPoA is selected as
WAN Setup.
Enter your allocated username, password and authentication
parameters according to the information provided by your
ISP.
ISP Name – PPP Service Name. Enter if your ISP requires this
setting; otherwise leave blank.
Username – Name provided by the ISP for PPPoE/PPPoA
authentication.
Password – Password provided by the ISP for PPPoE/PPPoA
authentication.
PPP Authentication –The protocol used for PPP
authentication.
PAP only- Only PAP (Password Authentication Protocol)
is used.
PAP or CHAP- Both PAP and CHAP
(Challenge-Handshake Authentication Protocol) can be
After finished the above settings, click OK to save the settings and return to previous page.
Item Description
Multi-VLAN Channel Enable – Select to enable this channel.
8/9/10 Disable – Select to disable this channel.
WAN Type The connections and interfaces created in every channel may
select a specific WAN type to be built upon. In the
Multi-VLAN application, only the Ethernet WAN type is
available. The user will be able to select the physical WAN
interface the channel shall use here.
General Settings VLAN Tag – Type the value as the VLAN ID number. Valid
settings are in the range from 1 to 4095. The network traffic
flowing on each channel will be identified by the system via
their VLAN Tags. Channels using the same WAN type may not
configure the same VLAN tag value.
Priority – Choose the number to determine the packet
priority for such VLAN. The range is from 0 to 7.
Bridge mode Enable –If selected, bridge this channel to one or more LAN
ports.
Physical Members – Group the physical ports by checking the
corresponding check box(es) for applying the bridge
connection.
Note: LAN port P1 is reserved for NAT use and cannot be
selected for bridging.
Or,
If the WAN budget is exhausted, a lock will be displayed on the page if Shutdown WAN
interface is selected. Which means no data transmission will be carried out. Moreover, the
system will send out a warning message to the administrator if Mail Alert is selected. Or, the
system will send out SMS message to the administrator if SMS message is selected.
Info For the IPv6 service, you have to configure WAN/LAN settings before using
the service.
Info Only one WAN interface support IPv6 service at one time. In this
example, WAN2 is chosen as the one supporting IPv6 service.
Different connection types will bring out different configuration page. Refer to the
following:
PPP – Dual Stack application, IPv4 and IPv6 services can be utilized at the same time
Choose PPP and type the information for PPPoE of IPv4.
Access into the setting page for IPv6 service, it is not necessary for you to configure
anything.
Click OK and open Online Status. If the connection is successful, you will get the IP
address for IPv4 and IPv6 at the same time.
Info While using such mode, you have to make sure the IPv4 network
connection is normal.
(In the following figure, the TSPC information is obtained from http://gogo6.com/ after
applied for the service.)
Click OK and open Online Status. If the connection is successful, the physical connection
will be shown as follows:
Info While using such mode, you have to make sure the IPv4 network
connection is normal.
Click OK and open Online Status. If the connection is successful, the physical connection
will be shows as follows:
Click OK and open Online Status. If the connection is successful, the physical connection
will be shows as follows:
Click OK and open Online Status. If the connection is successful, the physical connection
will be shows as follows:
Click OK and open Online Status. If the connection is successful, the physical connection
will be shows as follows:
Click OK and open Online Status. If the connection is successful, the physical connection
will be shows as follows:
2. In the field of RADVD Configuration, the default setting is Enable. The client’s PC will
ask RADVD service for the Prefix of IPv6 address automatically, and generate an
Interface ID by itself to compose a full and unique IPv6 address.
3. In the field of DHCPv6 Server Configuration, when DHCPv6 service is enabled, you can
assign available IPv6 address for the client manually.
Info When both mechanisms are enabled, the client can determine which
mechanism to be used (e.g., the default mechanism for Windows7 is
RADVD).
From the above figure we can see IPv6 IP address has been captured by the system.
2. Use the Ping command to ping any IPv6 address indicating an IPv6 website. For example,
www.kame.net is a website supporting IPv4 IP and IPv6 IP services. Its IPv6 address is
seen with a format of 2001:200:dff:fff1:216:3eff:feb1:44d7.
After getting the above message, it means the IPv6 service has been activated
successfully.
If you can see a turtle dancing on the screen, that means IPv6 service is ready for you to
access and utilize.
Local Area Network (LAN) is a group of subnets regulated and ruled by router. The design of
network structure is related to what type of public IP addresses coming from your ISP.
The most generic function of Vigor router is NAT. It creates a private subnet of your own. As
mentioned previously, the router will talk to other public hosts on the Internet by using public
IP address and talking to local hosts by using its private IP address. What NAT does is to
translate the packets from public IP address to private IP address to forward the right packets
to the right host and vice versa. Besides, Vigor router has a built-in DHCP server that assigns
private IP address to each local host. See the following diagram for a briefly understanding.
In some special case, you may have a public IP subnet from your ISP such as 220.135.240.0/24.
This means that you can set up a public subnet or call second subnet that each host is
equipped with a public IP address. As a part of the public subnet, the Vigor router will serve
for IP routing to help hosts in the public subnet to communicate with other public hosts or
servers outside. Therefore, the router should be set as the gateway for public hosts.
Item Description
General Setup Allow to configure settings for each subnet respectively.
Index - Display all of the LAN items.
Status- Basically, LAN1 status is enabled in default.
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Network Configuration For NAT Usage,
IP Address - Type in private IP address for connecting to a
local private network (Default: 192.168.1.1).
Subnet Mask - Type in an address code that determines the
size of the network. (Default: 255.255.255.0/ 24)
LAN IP Alias - If you want to make devices surf the Internet
through different WAN and make the decision by the devices,
you can set the LAN IP Alias as other gateway IP and pair it
with a WAN interface.
Then, you can set the gateway IP and the output interface on
devices to bring into effect.
RIP Protocol Control,
Disable - deactivate the RIP protocol. It will lead to a
stoppage of the exchange of routing information between
routers. (Default)
Enable – activate the RIP protocol.
DHCP Server DHCP stands for Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol. The
Configuration router by factory default acts a DHCP server for your network
so it automatically dispatches related IP settings to any local
user configured as a DHCP client. It is highly recommended
that you leave the router enabled as a DHCP server if you do
not have a DHCP server for your network.
If you want to use another DHCP server in the network other
than the Vigor Router’s, you can let Relay Agent help you to
redirect the DHCP request to the specified location.
Enable Server - Let the router assign IP address to every host
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Network Configuration Enable/Disable - Click Enable to enable such configuration;
click Disable to disable such configuration.
For NAT Usage - Click this radio button to invoke NAT
function.
For Routing Usage - Click this radio button to invoke this
function.
IP Address - Type in private IP address for connecting to a
local private network (Default: 192.168.1.1).
Subnet Mask - Type in an address code that determines the
size of the network. (Default: 255.255.255.0/ 24)
DHCP Server DHCP stands for Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol. The
Configuration router by factory default acts a DHCP server for your network
so it automatically dispatch related IP settings to any local
user configured as a DHCP client. It is highly recommended
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Network Configuration Enable/Disable - Click Enable to enable such configuration;
click Disable to disable such configuration.
For Routing Usage,
IP Address - Type in private IP address for connecting to a
local private network (Default: 192.168.1.1).
Subnet Mask - Type in an address code that determines the
size of the network. (Default: 255.255.255.0/ 24)
RIP Protocol Control,
Disable - deactivate the RIP protocol. It will lead to a
stoppage of the exchange of routing information between
routers. (Default)
Enable – activate the RIP protocol.
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Enable Check the box to enable the configuration of LAN 1 IPv6
Setup.
WAN Primary Interface Use the drop down list to specify a WAN interface for IPv6.
Static IPv6 Address IPv6 Address –Type static IPv6 address for LAN.
configuration Prefix Length – Type the fixed value for prefix length.
Add – Click it to add a new entry.
Delete – Click it to remove an existed entry.
Unique Local Address Such feature is used for the host without assigned IPv6
(ULA) configuration address to obtain IPv6 address automatically or have an IPv6
address specified manually via ULA configuration. It is
convenient for communication among different subnets.
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
2. In the setting page, type the settings as follows and click OK to save the settings. Note
that LAN1 is always for NAT usage.
4. Return to LAN>>General Setup. Now, LAN2 is available for configuration. Click the
Details Page button of LAN2. Choose For Routing Usage. Type the settings as follows and
click OK to save the settings.
5. Open WAN>>Internet Access. Choose Static or Dynamic IP as Access Mode. Then click
Details Page.
6. In the configuration web page, type the settings as follows and click OK to save the
settings.
Tagged VLAN
The tagged VLANs (802.1q) can mark data with a VLAN identifier. This identifier can be
carried through an onward Ethernet switch to specific ports. The specific VLAN clients can
also pick up this identifier as it is just passed to the LAN. You can set the priorities for
LAN-side QoS. You can assign each of VLANs to each of the different IP subnets that the router
may also be operating, to provide even more isolation. The said functionality is tag-based
multi-subnet.
Port-Based VLAN
Relative to tag-based VLAN which groups clients with an identifier, port-based VLAN uses
physical ports (P1 ~ P5) to separate the clients into different VLAN group.
Virtual LAN function provides you a very convenient way to manage hosts by grouping them
based on the physical port. The multi-subnet can let a small businesses have much better
isolation for multi-occupancy applications. Go to LAN page and select VLAN. The following
page will appear. Click Enable to invoke VLAN function.
Below is an example page in Vigor2925n:
Info Settings in this page only applied to LAN port but not WAN port.
Item Description
Enable Click it to enable VLAN configuration.
LAN P1 – P5– Check the LAN port(s) to group them under the
selected VLAN.
Note: P5 is supported only for Non-Fiber series.
Wireless LAN (2.4GHz) SSID1 – SSID4 – Check the SSID boxes to group them under the
selected VLAN.
Wireless LAN (5GHz) SSID1 – SSID4 – Check the SSID boxes to group them under the
selected VLAN.
This option is only available for Vigor2925Vn-plus
/Vigor2925n-plus.
VLAN Tag Enable – Check the box to enable the function of VLAN with
tag.
The router will add specific VLAN number to all packets on
the LAN while sending them out.
Please type the tag value and specify the priority for the
packets sending by LAN.
VID – Type the value as the VLAN ID number. The range is
Info Leave one VLAN untagged at least to prevent from not connecting to Vigor
router due to unexpected error.
Vigor2925 series features a hugely flexible VLAN system. In its simplest form, each of the
Gigabit LAN ports can be isolated from each other, for example to feed different companies
or departments but keeping their local traffic completely separated.
4. Click OK.
5. Open LAN>>General Setup. If you want to let the clients in both groups communicate
with each other, simply activate Inter-LAN Routing by checking the box between LAN1
and LAN2.
Item Description
Enable Click this radio button to invoke this function. However,
IP/MAC which is not listed in IP Bind List also can connect to
Internet.
Disable Click this radio button to disable this function. All the
settings on this page will be invalid.
ARP Table This table is the LAN ARP table of this router. The
information for IP and MAC will be displayed in this field.
Each pair of IP and MAC address listed in ARP table can be
selected and added to IP Bind List by clicking Add below.
Select All Click this link to select all the items in the ARP table.
Sort Reorder the table based on the IP address.
Refresh Refresh the ARP table listed below to obtain the newest ARP
table information.
Add or Update IP Address – Type the IP address that will be used for the
specified MAC address.
Mac Address – Type the MAC address that is used to bind
with the assigned IP address.
Comment – Type a brief description for the entry.
Show Comment – Check this box to display the comment on
IP Bind List box.
IP Bind List It displays a list for the IP bind to MAC information.
Add It allows you to add the one you choose from the ARP table or
the IP/MAC address typed in Add and Edit to the table of IP
Bind List.
Update It allows you to edit and modify the selected IP address and
MAC address that you create before.
Delete You can remove any item listed in IP Bind List. Simply click
and select the one, and click Delete. The selected item will
be removed from the IP Bind List.
Backup Store the configuration for Bind IP to MAC as a file.
Restore Restore the previously stored configuration file and apply to
such page.
Item Description
Port Mirror Check Enable to activate this function. Or, check Disable to
close this function.
Mirror Port Select a port to view traffic sent from mirrored ports.
Mirrored Tx Port Select which ports are necessary to be mirrored for
transmitting the packets.
Mirrored Rx Port Select which ports are necessary to be mirrored for receiving
the packets.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Hardware Acceleration is also called PPA in DrayTek for it is based on Protocol Processing
Engine (PPE) of Infineon. It can only support 128 sessions for network traffic (IN & OUT) with
implementing three kinds of modes - Disable, Auto and Manual.
II-3-1 Setup
When the data traffic is heavy and data transmission is getting slowly and slowly, you can
configure this page to accelerate the data streaming by hardware itself. Open Hardware
Acceleration to access into the following page:
Item Description
Mode Disable – The default setting.
Auto - When the hardware acceleration is configured with
the Auto mode, the sessions with the heaviest loading and
the lower latency traffic will be added into PPA. However,
the Auto mode does not support UDP protocol by designed.
Manual - The Manual mode implements three sub-items--
Accelerate most heavy traffic sessions, Apply the Class Rule
in Quality of Service, and Specific Hosts. Each of these
sub-items can support TCP and UDP protocol.
For checking whether the rule of PPA is working or not, a user can login to Vigor2925 series by
using telnet. User can view how many sessions are transferring in each direction of PPA table
after entering “ppa –v”.
Usually, the router serves as an NAT (Network Address Translation) router. NAT is a
mechanism that one or more private IP addresses can be mapped into a single public one.
Public IP address is usually assigned by your ISP, for which you may get charged. Private IP
addresses are recognized only among internal hosts.
When the outgoing packets destined to some public server on the Internet reach the NAT
router, the router will change its source address into the public IP address of the router,
select the available public port, and then forward it. At the same time, the router shall list an
entry in a table to memorize this address/port-mapping relationship. When the public server
response, the incoming traffic, of course, is destined to the router’s public IP address and the
router will do the inversion based on its table. Therefore, the internal host can communicate
with external host smoothly.
The benefit of the NAT includes:
Save cost on applying public IP address and apply efficient usage of IP address. NAT
allows the internal IP addresses of local hosts to be translated into one public IP address,
thus you can have only one IP address on behalf of the entire internal hosts.
Enhance security of the internal network by obscuring the IP address. There are
many attacks aiming victims based on the IP address. Since the attacker cannot be
aware of any private IP addresses, the NAT function can protect the internal network.
Info On NAT page, you will see the private IP address defined in RFC-1918.
Usually we use the 192.168.1.0/24 subnet for the router. As stated before,
the NAT facility can map one or more IP addresses and/or service ports into
different specified services. In other words, the NAT function can be
achieved by using port mapping methods.
Item Description
Index Display the number of the profile.
Service Name Display the description of the specific network service.
WAN Interface Display the WAN IP address used by the profile.
Protocol Display the transport layer protocol (TCP or UDP).
Public Port Display the port number which will be redirected to the
specified Private IP and Port of the internal host.
Private IP Display the IP address of the internal host providing the
service.
Status Display if the profile is enabled (v) or not (x).
Press any number under Index to access into next page for configuring port redirection.
Item Description
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Note that the router has its own built-in services (servers) such as Telnet, HTTP and FTP etc.
Since the common port numbers of these services (servers) are all the same, you may need to
reset the router in order to avoid confliction.
For example, the built-in web user interface in the router is with default port 80, which may
conflict with the web server in the local network, http://192.168.1.13:80. Therefore, you
need to change the router’s http port to any one other than the default port 80 to avoid
conflict, such as 8080. This can be set in the System Maintenance >>Management Setup. You
then will access the admin screen of by suffixing the IP address with 8080, e.g.,
http://192.168.1.1:8080 instead of port 80.
The security properties of NAT are somewhat bypassed if you set up DMZ host. We suggest
you to add additional filter rules or a secondary firewall.
Click DMZ Host to open the following page. You can set different DMZ host for each WAN
interface. Click the WAN tab to switch into the configuration page for that WAN.
Item Description
Choose Private IP or Active True IP first.
Active True IP selection is available for WAN1 only.
Private IP Enter the private IP address of the DMZ host, or click Choose
PC to select one.
Choose IP Click this button and then a window will automatically pop
up, as depicted below. The window consists of a list of private
IP addresses of all hosts in your LAN network. Select one
private IP address in the list to be the DMZ host.
When you have selected one private IP from the above dialog,
the IP address will be shown on the following screen. Click OK
to save the setting.
DMZ Host for WAN2, WAN3, LTE or WAN4 is slightly different with WAN1. Active True IP
selection is available for WAN1 only.
See the following figure.
Item Description
Enable Check to enable the DMZ Host function.
Private IP Enter the private IP address of the DMZ host, or click Choose
IP to select one.
Choose IP Click this button and then a window will automatically pop
up, as depicted below. The window consists of a list of
private IP addresses of all hosts in your LAN network. Select
one private IP address in the list to be the DMZ host.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Index Indicate the relative number for the particular entry that you
want to offer service in a local host. You should click the
appropriate index number to edit or clear the corresponding
entry.
Comment Specify the name for the defined network service.
WAN Interface Display the WAN interface used by such index.
Aux. WAN IP Display the IP alias setting used by such index. If no IP alias
setting exists, such field will not appear.
Local IP Address Display the private IP address of the local host offering the
service.
Status Display the state for the corresponding entry. X or V is to
represent the Inactive or Active state.
To add or edit port settings, click one index number on the page. The index entry setup page
will pop up. In each index entry, you can specify 10 port ranges for diverse services.
Item Description
Enable Open Ports Check to enable this entry.
Comment Make a name for the defined network application/service.
WAN Interface Specify the WAN interface that will be used for this entry.
Source IP Use the drop down list to specify an IP object. Or click IP
Object link to create a new one for applying.
WAN IP Specify the WAN IP address that will be used for this entry.
This setting is available when WAN IP Alias is configured.
Private IP Enter the private IP address of the local host or click Choose
IP to select one.
Choose IP - Click this button and, subsequently, a window
having a list of private IP addresses of local hosts will
automatically pop up. Select the appropriate IP address of
the local host in the list.
Protocol Specify the transport layer protocol. It could be TCP, UDP,
or ----- (none) for selection.
Start Port Specify the starting port number of the service offered by
the local host.
End Port Specify the ending port number of the service offered by the
local host.
Item Description
Comment Display the text which memorizes the application of this
rule.
Item Description
Enable Check to enable this entry.
Service Choose the predefined service to apply for such trigger
profile.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
II-4-5 ALG
ALG means Application Layer Gateway. There are two methods provided by Vigor router,
RTSP (Real Time Streaming Protocol) ALG and SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) ALG, for
processing the packets of voice and video.
RTSP ALG makes RTSP message, RTCP message, and RTP packets of voice and video be
transmitted and received correctly via NAT by Vigor router.
However, SIP ALG makes SIP message and RTP packets of voice be transmitted and received
correctly via NAT by Vigor router.
Item Description
Enable ALG Check to enable such function.
Listen Port Type a port number for SIP or RTSP protocol.
TCP Check the box to make correspond protocol message packet
from TCP transmit and receive via NAT.
UDP Check the box to make correspond protocol message packet
from UDP transmit and receive via NAT.
Dynamic DNS
The ISP often provides you with a dynamic IP address when you connect to the Internet via
your ISP. It means that the public IP address assigned to your router changes each time you
access the Internet. The Dynamic DNS feature lets you assign a domain name to a dynamic
WAN IP address. It allows the router to update its online WAN IP address mappings on the
specified Dynamic DNS server. Once the router is online, you will be able to use the registered
domain name to access the router or internal virtual servers from the Internet. It is
particularly helpful if you host a web server, FTP server, or other server behind the router.
Before you use the Dynamic DNS feature, you have to apply for free DDNS service to the DDNS
service providers. The router provides up to three accounts from three different DDNS service
providers. Basically, Vigor routers are compatible with the DDNS services supplied by most
popular DDNS service providers such as www.dyndns.org, www.no-ip.com, www.dtdns.com,
www.changeip.com, www.dynamic- nameserver.com. You should visit their websites to
register your own domain name for the router.
Schedule
The Vigor router has a built-in clock which can update itself manually or automatically by
means of Network Time Protocols (NTP). As a result, you can not only schedule the router to
dialup to the Internet at a specified time, but also restrict Internet access to certain hours so
that users can connect to the Internet only during certain hours, say, business hours. The
schedule is also applicable to other functions.
RADIUS/TACACS+
Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) is a security authentication
client/server protocol that supports authentication, authorization and accounting, which is
widely used by Internet service providers. It is the most common method of authenticating
and authorizing dial-up and tunneled network users.
The built-in RADIUS client feature enables the router to assist the remote dial-in user or a
wireless station and the RADIUS server in performing mutual authentication. It enables
centralized remote access authentication for network management.
Wake on LAN
A PC client on LAN can be woken up by the router it connects. When a user wants to wake up
a specified PC through the router, he/she must type correct MAC address of the specified PC
on this web page of Wake on LAN (WOL) of this router.
In addition, such PC must have installed a network card supporting WOL function. By the way,
WOL function must be set as “Enable” on the BIOS setting.
Item Description
Enable Dynamic DNS Check this box to enable DDNS function.
Setup
Set to Factory Clear all profiles and recover to factory settings.
Default
View Log Display DDNS log status.
4. Select Index number 1 to add an account for the router. Check Enable Dynamic DNS
Account, and choose correct Service Provider: dyndns.org, type the registered
hostname: hostname and domain name suffix: dyndns.org in the Domain Name block.
The following two blocks should be typed your account Login Name: test and Password:
test.
If User-Defined is specified as the service provider, the web page will be changed
slightly as follows:
Item Description
Enable Dynamic DNS Check this box to enable the current account. If you did
Account check the box, you will see a check mark appeared on the
Active column of the previous web page in step 2).
WAN Interface WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 or LTE/WAN4 First - While connecting,
the router will use WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 or LTE /WAN4 as the
first channel for such account. If WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 or LTE
/WAN4 fails, the router will use another WAN interface
instead.
WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 or LTE /WAN4 Only - While connecting,
the router will use WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 or LTE /WAN4 as the
only channel for such account.
Service Provider Select the service provider for the DDNS account.
Service Type Select a service type (Dynamic, Custom or Static). If you
choose Custom, you can modify the domain that is chosen in
the Domain Name field.
Note that such option is not available when Customized is
selected as Service Provider.
Domain Name Type in one domain name that you applied previously. Use
the drop down list to choose the desired domain.
Note that such option is not available when Customized is
selected as Service Provider.
Provider Host Type the IP address or the domain name of the host which
provides related service.
Note that such option is available when Customized is
selected as Service Provider.
Service API Type the API information obtained from DDNS server.
Note that such option is available when Customized is
5. Click OK button to activate the settings. You will see your setting has been saved.
DrayDDNS Settings
DrayDDNS, a new DDNS service developed by DrayTek, can record multiple WAN IP (IPv4) on
single domain name. It is convenient for users to use and easily to set up. Each Vigor Router is
available to register one domain name.
Choose DrayTek Global as the service provider, the web page will be displayed as follows:
Item Description
Enable Dynamic DNS Check this box to enable the current account. If you did check the
Account box, you will see a check mark appeared on the Active column of
the previous web page in step 2).
Service Provider Choose DrayTek Global as the service provider.
Wizard – This button is available when DrayTek Global is selected as
Service Provider. To activate the DrayTek’s DDNS service, click it to
enable license issued by DrayTek through Wizards>>Service
Activation Wizard.
Refer to section A-1 How to use DrayDDNS? for detailed
information.
Status Display if the license is actvtaed or not.
Determine WAN IP If a Vigor router is installed behind any NAT router, you can enable
such function to locate the real WAN IP.
When the WAN IP used by Vigor router is private IP, this function
can detect the public IP used by the NAT router and use the
detected IP address for DDNS update.
There are two methods offered for you to choose:
WAN IP - If it is selected and the WAN IP of Vigor router is
private, DDNS update will take place right away.
Internet IP – If it is selected and the WAN IP of Vigor router is
private, it will be converted to public IP before DDNS update
takes place.
WAN Interfaces WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 or LTE/WAN4 First - While connecting, the
router will use WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 or LTE /WAN4 as the first
channel for such account. If WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 or LTE /WAN4
fails, the router will use another WAN interface instead.
WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 or LTE /WAN4 Only - While connecting, the
router will use WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 or LTE /WAN4 as the only
channel for such account.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles and recover to factory settings.
Enable Check the box to enable the selected profile.
Item Description
Enable Check this box to enable such profile.
Profile Type a name for such profile.
Note: If you type a name here for LAN DNS and click OK to
save the configuration, the name also will be applied to
conditional DNS forwarding automatically.
Domain Name Type the domain name for such profile.
IP Address List The IP address listed here will be used for mapping with the
domain name specified above. In general, one domain name
maps with one IP address. If required, you can configure two
IP addresses mapping with the same domain name.
Add – Click it to open a dialog to type the host’s IP address.
Item Description
Enable Check this box to enable such profile.
Profile Type a name for such profile.
Note: If you type a name here for conditional DNS forwarding
and click OK to save the configuration, the name also will be
applied to LAN DNS automatically.
Domain Name Type the domain name for such profile.
DNS Server IP Address Type the IP address of the DNS server you want to use for DNS
forwarding.
Item Description
Enable Check the box to enable the DNS security management.
Interface There are four WAN interfaces allowed to be set with DNS
security enabled.
Primary DNS Display the IP address of primary DNS obtained from DHCP
server or specified by Static WAN.
Secondary DNS Display the IP address of secondary DNS obtained from DHCP
server or specified by Static WAN.
Bogus DNS Reply Sometime, Vigor router might encounter packets from bogus
DNS inquiry. There are two ways to reply such DNS inquiry.
Drop – Discard the packets.
Pass – Accept the packets and let them pass through Vigor
router.
Item Description
Domain Type the domain name or IP address (IPv4/IPv6) that you
want to query.
Interface Specify the interface required for executing diagnose.
DNS Server Type the IP address of the DNS Server which will diagnose the
domain specified above.
Diagnose Click it to perform the diagnosis for the domain.
Result The diagnosed information will be displayed on such field.
Item Description
Current System Time Display the time Vigor router used.
System time set Click it to acess into the time setup page (System
Maintenance>>Time and Date).
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles and recover to factory settings.
Enable Click the box to enable such schedule profile.
You can set up to 15 schedules. Then you can apply them to your Internet Access or VPN and
Remote Access >> LAN-to-LAN settings.
To add a schedule:
1. Click any index, say Index No. 1.
2. The detailed settings of the schedule with index 1 will be shown below.
Item Description
Enable Schedule Check to enable the schedule.
Setup
Comment Type a short description for such schedule.
Start Date Specify the starting date of the schedule.
(yyyy-mm-dd)
Start Time (hh:mm) Specify the starting time of the schedule.
Duration Time Specify the duration (or period) for the schedule.
(hh:mm)
End Time (hh:mm) It will be calculated automatically when Start Time and
Duration Time are configured well.
Example
Suppose you want to control the PPPoE Internet access connection to be always on (Force On)
from 9:00 to 18:00 for whole week. Other time the Internet access connection should be
disconnected (Force Down).
Office
Hour:
(Force On)
1. Make sure the PPPoE connection and Time Setup is working properly.
2. Configure the PPPoE always on from 9:00 to 18:00 for whole week.
3. Configure the Force Down from 18:00 to next day 9:00 for whole week.
4. Assign these two profiles to the PPPoE Internet access profile. Now, the PPPoE Internet
connection will follow the schedule order to perform Force On or Force Down action
according to the time plan that has been pre-defined in the schedule profiles.
Item Description
Enable Check to enable RADIUS client feature.
Server IP Address Enter the IP address of RADIUS server
Destination Port The UDP port number that the RADIUS server is using. The
default value is 1812, based on RFC 2138.
Shared Secret The RADIUS server and client share a secret that is used to
authenticate the messages sent between them. Both sides
must be configured to use the same shared secret. The
maximum length of the shared secret you can set is 36
characters.
Confirm Shared Secret Re-type the Shared Secret for confirmation.
After finished the above settings, click OK button to save the settings.
Item Description
Enable Check to enable internal RADIUS client feature.
Authentication Port Set a port number for internal RADIUS server.
RADIUS Client Access List Allow to configure that clients under specified domain (IPv4
and IPv6) must be authenticated with the specified shared
secret.
Enable - Check to enable RADIUS client feature.
Shared Secret - The RADIUS server and client share a secret
that is used to authenticate the messages sent between
them. Both sides must be configured to use the same shared
secret. The maximum length of the shared secret you can set
is 36 characters.
After finished the above settings, click OK button to save the settings.
Item Description
Enable Check to enable TACACS+ feature.
Server IP Address Enter the IP address of TACACS+ server.
Destination Port The UDP port number that the TACACS+ server is using.
Shared Secret The TACACS+ server and client share a secret that is used to
authenticate the messages sent between them. Both sides
must be configured to use the same shared secret.
Confirm Shared Secret Re-type the Shared Secret for confirmation.
After finished the above settings, click OK button to save the settings.
Item Description
Enable Check to enable such function.
Bind Type There are three types of bind type supported.
Simple Mode – Just simply do the bind authentication
without any search action.
Anonymous – Perform a search action first with
Anonymous account then do the bind authentication.
Regular Mode– Mostly it is the same with anonymous
mode. The different is that, the server will firstly check
if you have the search authority.
For the regular mode, you’ll need to type in the Regular DN
After finished the above settings, click OK button to save the settings.
II-5-6-2 Profiles
You can configure eight AD/LDAP profiles. These profiles would be used with User
Management for different purposes in management.
Item Description
Name Type a name for such profile. The length of the user name is
limited to 19 characters.
Common Name Identifier Type or edit the common name identifier for the LDAP server.
The common name identifier for most LDAP server is “cn”.
Base Distinguished Name Type or edit the distinguished name used to look up entries on
/ Group Distinguished the LDAP server.
Name
Sometimes, you may forget the Distinguished Name since it’s
too long. Then you may click the button to list all the
account information on the AD/LDAP Server to assist you finish
the setup.
After finished the above settings, click OK to save and exit this page. A new profile has been
created.
Info UPnP is required for some applications such as PPS, Skype, eMule...and etc.
If you are not familiar with UPnP, it is suggested to turn off this function for
security.
Item Description
Enable UPNP Service Accordingly, you can enable either the Connection Control
Service or Connection Status Service.
Default WAN It is used to specify the WAN interface for applying such
function.
Item Description
IGMP Proxy Check this box to enable this function. The application of
multicast will be executed through WAN /PVC/VLAN port.
In addition, such function is available in NAT mode.
Interface – Specify an interface for packets passing
through.
IGMP version – At present, two versions (v2 and v3) are
supported by Vigor router. Choose the correct version
based on the IPTV service you subscribe.
General Query Interval – Vigor router will periodically
check which IP obtaining IPTV service by sending query. It
might cause inconvenience for client. Therefore, set a
suitable time (unit: second) as the query interval to limit
the frequency of query sent by Vigor router.
Add PPP header – Check this box if the interface type for
IGMP is PPPoE. It depends on the specifications regulated
by each ISP. If you have no idea to enable or disable, simply
contact your ISP providers.
IGMP Snooping Check this box to enable this function. Multicast traffic will
be forwarded to ports that have members of that group.
Disabling IGMP snooping will make multicast traffic treated
in the same manner as broadcast traffic.
IGMP Fast Leave Check this box to make the router stop forwarding
multicast traffic to a LAN port as soon as it receives a leave
message from that port. Each LAN port should have one
IGMP host connected.
Refresh Click this link to renew the working multicast group status.
Item Description
Wake by Two types provide for you to wake up the binded IP.
If you choose Wake by MAC Address, you have to type
the correct MAC address of the host in MAC Address
boxes.
If you choose Wake by IP Address, you have to choose
the correct IP address.
IP Address The IP addresses that have been configured in
Firewall>>Bind IP to MAC will be shown in this drop down
list. Choose the IP address from the drop down list that you
want to wake up.
MAC Address Type any one of the MAC address of the bound PCs.
Wake Up Click this button to wake up the selected IP. See the
following figure. The result will be shown on the box.
Item Description
Index Check the box to enable such profile.
SMS Provider Use the drop down list to choose SMS service provider.
You can click SMS Provider link to define the SMS server.
Recipient Number Type the phone number of the one who will receive the
SMS.
Notify Profile Use the drop down list to choose a message profile. The
recipient will get the content stated in the message profile.
You can click the Notify Profile link to define the content
of the SMS.
Schedule (1-15) Type the schedule number that the SMS will be sent out.
You can click the Schedule(1-15) link to define the
schedule.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Index Check the box to enable such profile.
Mail Service Use the drop down list to choose mail service object. All of
the available objects are created in Object
Settings>>SMS/Mail Service Object. If there is no object
listed, click Mail Service link to define a new one with
specified service provider.
Mail Address Type the e-mail address of the one who will receive the
notification message.
Notify Profile Use the drop down list to choose a message profile. The
recipient will get the content stated in the message profile.
You can click the Notify Profile link to define the content
of the mail message.
Schedule (1-15) Type the schedule number that the notification will be sent
out.
You can click the Schedule(1-15) link to define the
schedule.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Below shows an example for applying the bonjour feature that Vigor router can be used as the
FTP server.
1. Here, we use Firefox and DNSSD to discover the service in such case. Therefore, just
ensure the Bonjour client program and DNSSD for Firefox have been installed on the
computer.
3. Open System Maintenance>>Management. Type a name as the Router Name and click
OK.
4. Next, open Applications>>Bonjour. Check the service that you want to use via Bonjour.
5. Open the DNSSD page again. The available items will be changed as the follows. It means
the Vigor router (based on Bonjour protocol) is ready to be used as a printer server, FTP
server, SSH Server, Telnet Server, and HTTP Server.
Item Description
Enable High Abailablity Check this box to enable HA function.
Redundancy Method Choose Hot-Standby or Active-Standby as the method for HA.
Hot-Standby -
Such method is suitable for a user which has one ISP account.
With such method;
All WANs of secondary routers will be shut down by HA
function.
WAN settings of primary and secondary routers can be
the same.
Note: When Hot-Standby is used, wireless LAN will be
“enabled” automatically for clients connecting to the
primary router; however, wireless LAN on secondary
router will be “disabled” directlly. Thus clients can
not connect to the secondary router any more.
Active-Standby -
Such method is suitable for a user which has multiple ISP
accounts. With such method;
All WANs of secondary routers can be up. Therefore,
the user can route it's traffic to secondary.
WAN settings of primary and secondary routers must
not be the same.
The Config Sync must be disabled, or you cannot change
redundancy method to active-standby.
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Enable Config Sync (Max. Check this box to enable configuration synchronization.
Sync to 10 routers) To sync configuration from primary to secondary router,
both primary and seconday routers need to enable “config
sync”. Note that config sync can be enabled by Hot-Standby
redundancy method only.
Config Sync Interval Day / Hour / Minute - Primary router will sync its
configuration to secondary router based on the time interval
set here.
Exclude the following Settings selected in this field will be excluded when
settings from config sync executing configuration synchronization. For example, under
active-standby mode, WAN settings will not be synchronized.
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Enable Click it to enable local 802.1X server.
At present, such feature can be used for wireless and wired
802.1x authentication.
User Profile Select All – Click it to select all of the profiles under
Available List.
Clear All – Click it to remove all of the profiles under
Authentication List.
Sync User Profile …. Make the enabling/disabling setting for both Internal RADIUS
and Local 802.1X synchronize for all of the user profiles
(User Management>>User Profile).
For example, if Local 802.1x is configured as Enabled
(checked), the Internal RADIUS will be configured as Enabled
too.
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Vigor router supports various DDNS service providers, user can set up user-defined profile to
update the DDNS even the service provider is not on the list. Now, DrayTek starts to support
our own DDNS service - DrayDDNS. We will provide a domain name for each Vigor Router, this
single domain name can record IP addresses of all WAN.
e. Select the WAN you would like to upload the IP to DDNS server
Currently, only the domain name is allowed to be modified MyVigor website. We will need to
register the router to MyVigor server, and log in to MyVigor website to modify it.
2. Log in to MyVigor Website, choose the profile, then click Edit DDNS settings.
4. Vigor router will get the modified domain name when the it performs next DDNS
updating. We can click Sync domain to accelerate this process.
After few seconds, the router will get the new domain name and print it on the profiles
list.
This article describes how to configure customized DDNS on Vigor routers to update your IP to
the DDNS server. We will take “Changeip.org” and “3322.net” as example. Before setting,
please make sure that the WAN connection is up.
Part A : Changeip.org
Note that,
Username: jo***
Password: jo********
Host name: j*****.changeip.org
WAN IP address: 1.169.185.242
Following is the screenshot of editing the HTML script on the browser to update your IP to the
DDNS server.
3. Please go to Applications >> Dynamic DNS to create a profile for Customized DDNS
client.
In which, ###IP### is a value which will be replaced with the current interface IP
address automatically when DDNS service is running. In this case the IP will be
1.169.185.242.
4. After setting, the Customized DDNS service will be up, and our IP will be updated to the
DDNS server.
Part B : 3322.net
Username: bi*******
Password: 88********
Host name: bi*******.3322.org
To update the IP to the DDNS server via editing the HTML script, we can type the following
script on the browser:
“good 111.243.178.53” means our IP has been updated to the server successfully.
Now we have to configure the router so it can do the same job for us automatically.
1. Please go to Applications >> Dynamic DNS to create a profile for Customized DDNS
client.
8. After the setting, the Customized DDNS service will be up, and our IP will be updated to
the DDNS server automatically.
After above configurations, users belong to either “rd1” or “shrd” group can access Internet
after inputting their credentials on LDAP server.
Route Policy (also well known as PBR, policy-based routing) is a feature where you may need
to get a strategy for routing. The packets will be directed to the specified interface if they
match one of the policies. You can setup route policies in various reasons such as load balance,
security, routing decision, and etc.
Through protocol, IP address, port number and interface configuration, Route Policy can be
used to configure any routing rules to fit actual request. In general, Route Policy can easily
reach the following purposes:
Load Balance
You may manually create policies to balance the traffic across network interface.
Specify Interface
Through dedicated interface (WAN/LAN/VPN), the data can be sent from the source IP to the
destination IP.
Address Mapping
Allows you specify the outgoing WAN IP address (es) for an internal private IP address or a
range of internal private IP addresses.
Priority
The router will determine which policy will be adopted for transmitting the packet according
to the priority of Static Route and Route Policy.
Failover to/Failback
Packets will be sent through another Interface or follow another Policy when the original
interface goes down (Failover to). Once the original interface resumes service (Failback),
the packets will be returned to it immediately.
Other routing
Specify routing policy to determine the direction of the data transmission.
Info For more detailed information about using policy route, refer to Support
>>FAQ/Application Notes on www.draytek.com.
1. Go to LAN page and click General Setup, select 1st Subnet as the RIP Protocol Control.
Then click the OK button.
Info There are two reasons that we have to apply RIP Protocol Control on
1st Subnet. The first is that the LAN interface can exchange RIP
packets with the neighboring routers via the 1st subnet
(192.168.1.0/24). The second is that those hosts on the internal
private subnets (ex. 192.168.10.0/24) can access the Internet via the
router, and continuously exchange of IP routing information with
different subnets.
Item Description
Enable Click it to enable this profile.
Destination IP Type an IP address as the destination of such static route.
Address
Subnet Mask Type the subnet mask for such static route.
Network Interface Use the drop down list to specify an interface for such
static route.
3. Return to Static Route Setup page. Click on another Index Number to add another
static route as show below, which regulates all packets destined to 211.100.88.0 will be
forwarded to 192.168.1.3. Click OK.
Item Description
Index The number (1 to 40) under Index allows you to open next
page to set up static route.
Destination Address Displays the destination address of the static route.
Status Displays the status of the static route.
Set to Factory Default Clear all of the settings and return to factory default
settings.
Viewing IPv6 Routing Displays the routing table for your reference.
Table
Item Description
Enable Click it to enable this profile.
Destination IPv6 Address / Type the IP address with the prefix length for this entry.
Prefix Len
Gateway IPv6 Address Type the gateway address for this entry.
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Index Click the number of index to access into the configuration
web page.
Enable Check this box to enable this policy.
Protocol Display the protocol used for this policy.
Interface Display the interface to send packets to once the policy is
matched.
Priority Display the priority value for such route policy profile.
Src IP Start Display the IP address for the start of the source IP.
Src IP End Display the IP address for the end of the source IP.
Dest IP Start Display the IP address for the start of the destination IP.
Dest IP End Display the IP address for the end of the destination IP.
Dest Port Start Display the IP address for the start of the destination port.
Dest Port End Display the IP address for the end of the destination port.
Move UP/Move Down Use Up or Down link to move the order of the policy.
Wizard Mode Allow to configure frequently used settings of route policy
via three setting pages
Advance Mode Allow to configure detailed settings of route policy.
Item Description
Source IP Any – Any IP can be treated as the source IP.
Src IP Start - Type the source IP start for the specified WAN
interface.
Src IP End - Type the source IP end for the specified WAN
interface. If this field is blank, it means that all the source
IPs inside the LAN will be passed through the WAN
interface.
Destination IP Any – Any IP can be treated as the destination IP.
Dest IP Start- Type the destination IP start for the specified
WAN interface.
Dest IP End - Type the destination IP end for the specified
WAN interface. If this field is blank, it means that all the
destination IPs will be passed through the WAN interface.
Country Object - Specify a country object. All the IPs
coming from the country (countries) specified in the object
will be passed through the WAN interface.
Item Description
4. After specifying the interface, click Next to get the following page.
Item Description
Force NAT /Force It determines which mechanism that the router will use to
Routing forward the packet to WAN.
5. After choosing the mechanism, click Next to get the summary page for reference.
Item Description
Enable Check this box to enable this policy.
Comment Type a brief explanation for such profile.
Protocol Use the drop-down menu to choose a proper protocol for
the WAN interface.
3. When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
II-6-2-2 Diagnose
With the analysis done by such page, possible path (static route, routing table or policy
route) of the packets sent out of the router can be traced.
or
Item Description
Item Description
Local
Enable BGP Check the box to enable basic BGP function for local
router.
Local AS Number Set the AS number for local router.
Hold Time Set the time interval (in seconds) to determine the peer is
dead when the router is unable to receive any keepalive
message from the peer within the time.
Connect Retry Time If the router fails to connect to neighboring router, it
requires a period of time to reconnect.
Set the time interval to do reconnection.
Router ID Specify the LAN subnet for the router.
Neighbor
Enable Check the box to enable the basic BGP function for
neighboring router.
Index Click the index number link to configure neighbor profile.
Item Description
Select Check the box to enable the configuration for the selected
index entry.
IP Address Type the IP address for a router.
Subnet Mask Type the mask value for the IP address.
A-1 How to Customize a Secure Route between VPN Router and Remote
Router by Using Route Policy
Example 1:
In the following figure, a LAN to LAN VPN tunnel is built between DrayTek VPN router (e.g.,
Vigor2925 series) and the remote router. Firewall Router can receive all of the traffic coming
from remote PC which wants to access into Internet; and send back the packets to Remote
Router through VPN Router.
1. Establish a VPN tunnel between VPN Router and the Remote Router.
2. Change to default route for the router located in Remote Router.
3. Access into the web user interface of the router in VPN Router. Then, open
Load-Balance / Route Policy>>General Setup and click Advance Mode.
Now, if you want such route policy will be applied by Vigor router with higher priority,
please adjust the value of Priority for such route policy. In general, default route is
specified with the lowest priority for it value is fixed as “250”. And Routes in Routing
Table are fixed as “150”. You can adjust the value for such route policy with lower value,
e.g., 100 to ensure it will be applied to packets transmission with the highest priority.
5. After finished the above settings, click OK to save the configuration.
Click the WAN IP Alias button to configure the other IP address which is 202.211.100.11.
Make sure Join IP NAT Pool is not checked. Click OK to save the settings.
5. Click Index number 1 and 2 to configure the details. After finished the settings, click OK
to save the settings respectively.
6. Upon completing the above configuration, you have specified the outgoing IP address(es)
for some specific computers.
7. Now, you bind some specific computers to some WAN IP alias for outgoing traffic.
2. From the following web page, simply click index number #1.
Now, the packets sent to the remote PC (IP address: 203.65.1.35) will be forced to pass
through WAN1.
This section can guide you to use the SIM card in LTE WAN to perform SMS related operations.
Item Description
Enable SMS Quota Limit Check the box to enable such feature.
Quota Limit Specify the maximum number of sending SMS for LTE.
When quota exceeded There are two actions to be performed when the quota limit
is expired.
Stop sending SMS – If it is checked, no SMS for LTE will be
sent after the quota limit is expired.
Send Mail Alert to Administrator – If it is checkd, a mail
alert will be sent to the administrator when the quota limit is
expired.
Monthly This setting is to offer a mechanism of resetting the number
of SMS sent record every month.
SMS quota resets on day XX at XX … –You can determine the
starting day in one month. The number of SMS sent will be
reset.
Custom This setting allows the user to define the billing cycle
according to his request.
The number of SMS sent will be reset with an interval of
cycle duration.
Custom – Monthly is default setting. If long period or a short
period is required, use Custom. The period of reset is
between 1 day and 60 days. You can determine the cycle
duration by specifying the days and the hours.
Cycle duration: Specify the days to reset the number of
Item Description
Mark as Read Those messages in "unread" state are showed in bold text. If
you want to change messages into "read" state, select them
and click the OK button. Checking the checkbox in title will
select all "unread" messages in this page.
Delete If you want to delete messages, select them and click the OK
button. Checking the checkbox in title will select all
messages in this page.
Details If you want to read the full content of the message, click the
View link of that message to open the following page. It will
change the message into "read" state.
Item Description
Mark as Read Those SMS in "unread" state are shown in bold text. If you
want to change SMS into "read" state, select them and click
the OK button. Checking the checkbox in title will select all
"unread" SMS in this page.
Delete If you want to delete SMS, select them and click the OK
button. Checking the checkbox in title will select all SMS in
this page.
Index If you want to read the full content of the message of the
SMS, click the index link of that SMS to open the following
page. It will change all SMS of the message into "read" state.
Item Description
Recipient Number Type the phone number of the recipient.
The format can be an international phone number
( +8869123455678) or a general phone number(0912345678).
Data Coding Scheme The router will automatically select a suitable Data Coding
Scheme according to the current content in Message. GSM
7-bit and UCS-2 are supported.
Message Type in the message content to send.
The total number of characters that you can type in this field
is 1024.
Send Message Click it to send this SMS message to the recipient
immediately.
View SMS Outbox Cache Display the record of SMS messages sent from the Router.
Item Description
Reboot on SMS Message
Enable with Password / To reboot Vigor router remotely via SMS, please check such
PIN box and type the password/PIN number (treated as
This page will display basic information about the embedded LTE module and the current LTE
connection.
Item Description
Status LTE WAN status.
IMEI International Mobile Equipment Identity of the embedded
LTE module.
IMSI International Mobile Subscripber Identity of the LTE SIM card.
Access Tech Type of LTE connection
(CDMA/GSM/WCDMA/LTE/TD-SCDMA).
Band Band of LTE connection.
Operator ISP name of LTE connection.
Mobile Country Code / Base station information.
Mobile Network Code /
Location Area Code / Cell
ID :
Signal Signal strength of LTE connection.
Active Channel Frequency of LTE connection.
Interference with 2.4GHz Whether the current LTE frequency causes interference with
2.4G wireless. If Yes, the interfered 2.4G wireless channels
Info The actual data throughput will vary according to the network conditions
and environmental factors, including volume of network traffic, network
overhead and building materials.
In an Infrastructure Mode of wireless network, Vigor wireless router plays a role as an Access
Point (AP) connecting to lots of wireless clients or Stations (STA). All the STAs will share the
same Internet connection via Vigor wireless router. The General Settings will set up the
information of this wireless network, including its SSID as identification, located channel etc.
Multiple SSIDs
Info The password (PSK) of default security mode is provided and stated on the
label pasted on the bottom of the router. For the wireless client who wants
to access into Internet through such router, please input the default PSK
value for connection.
DFS Restrictions
Some of 5GHz channels are DFS channels which are governed radars. Without passing DFS
certificate test, we can not open those DFS channels in Vigor router. We are working on DFS
certification in Europe and open those channels by releasing new firmware once we receive
DFS certification. According to DFS certificate in Europe, we will open channels 52, 56, 60, 64,
100, 104, 108, 112, 116, 120, 124, 128, 132, and 136.
At present, we will not open DFS channels in the USA because we do not have plan for DFS
certification in the USA. Channels 52, 56, 60, 64, 100, 104, 108, 112, 116, 120, 124, 128, 132,
and 136 will be restricted in the USA.
In some countries, there are restrictions on DFS channels as well. We will implement country
code to restrict uncertified channels.
Below shows the menu items for Wireless LAN (2.4Ghz) and Wireless LAN(5GHz).
WPS
WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) provides easy procedure to make network connection between
wireless station and wireless access point (vigor router) with the encryption of WPA and
WPA2.
2. The screen of wireless wizard will be shown as follows. This page will be used for internal
users in a company or your home. Besides, the settings will change based on different
model of Vigor2925 series. In this case, Vigor2925ac is used as an example.
Item Description
Wireless 2.4GHz Settings
Name Type the SSID name of this router for wireless 2.4GHz. The
default name is defined with DrayTek. Change the name if
required.
Mode At present, the router can connect to 11n Only, 11g Only,
3. After typing the required information, click Next. The settings in the page limit the
wireless station (guest) accessing into Internet but not being allowed to share the LAN
network and VPN connection.
Item Description
Wireless 2.4GHz Settings
Enable/Disable Click it to enable or disable settings in this page.
SSID Type the SSID name of this router. (SSID1)
Security Key The wireless mode offered by this wizard is WPA2/PSK.
The WPA encrypts each frame transmitted from the radio
using the key, which either PSK (Pre-Shared Key) entered
manually in this field below or automatically negotiated via
802.1x authentication.
Either 8~63 ASCII characters, such as 012345678(or 64
Hexadecimal digits leading by 0x, such as
"0x321253abcde...").
Rate Control It controls the data transmission rate through wireless
connection.
Upload – Check Enable and type the transmitting rate for
data upload. Default value is 30,000 kbps.
Download – Type the transmitting rate for data download.
Default value is 30,000 kbps.
Wireless 5GHz Settings
Enable/Disable Click it to enable or disable settings in this page.
Use the same SSID Check the box to use the same settings configured above.
and Security Key as
above
SSID Type the SSID name of this router. (SSID2)
Security Key The wireless mode offered by this wizard is WPA2/PSK.
The WPA encrypts each frame transmitted from the radio
using the key, which either PSK (Pre-Shared Key) entered
manually in this field below or automatically negotiated via
5. The following page will display the configuration summary for wireless setting.
Item Description
Enable Wireless LAN Check the box to enable wireless function.
Mode 2.4GHz in “n”, “n-plus” and “ac” model:
At present, the router can connect to 11g Only, 11n Only(2.4
GHz), Mixed (11b+11g), Mixed (11g+11n), and Mixed
(11b+11g+11n) stations simultaneously. Simply choose Mixed
(11b+11g+11n) mode.
Hide SSID Check it to prevent from wireless sniffing and make it harder
for unauthorized clients or STAs to join your wireless LAN.
Depending on the wireless utility, the user may only see the
information except SSID or just cannot see any thing about
Vigor wireless router while site surveying. The system allows
you to set four sets of SSID for different usage. In default,
the first set of SSID will be enabled. You can hide it for your
necessity.
SSID Means the identification of the wireless LAN. SSID can be any
text numbers or various special characters.
Isolate Member –Check this box to make the wireless clients
(stations) with the same SSID not accessing for each other.
VPN – Check this box to make the wireless clients (stations)
with different VPN not accessing for each other.
Rate Control It controls the data transmission rate through wireless
connection.
Upload – Check Enable and type the transmitting rate for
data upload. Default value is 30,000 kbps.
Download – Type the transmitting rate for data download.
Default value is 30,000 kbps.
Schedule Set the wireless LAN to work at certain time interval only.
You may choose up to 4 schedules out of the 15 schedules
pre-defined in Applications >> Schedule setup. The default
setting of this field is blank and the function will always
work.
Enable Special SSID Selected SSID (2 /3 /4) will be forced up /down based on the
Schedule Profiles schedule profile used.
By clicking the Wireless LAN>>Security Settings, a new web page will appear so that you
could configure the settings of WPA and WEP.
Item Description
WPA The WPA encrypts each frame transmitted from the radio
using the key, which either PSK (Pre-Shared Key) entered
manually in this field below or automatically negotiated via
802.1x authentication. Either 8~63 ASCII characters, such as
012345678(or 64 Hexadecimal digits leading by 0x, such as
"0x321253abcde...").
Pre-Shared Key (PSK) - Either 8~63 ASCII characters, such as
012345678..(or 64 Hexadecimal digits leading by 0x, such as
"0x321253abcde...").
Password Strength – The system will display the password
strength (represented with the word of weak, medium or
strong) of the PSK specified above.
WEP 64-Bit - For 64 bits WEP key, either 5 ASCII characters, such
as 12345 (or 10 hexadecimal digitals leading by 0x, such as
0x4142434445.)
128-Bit - For 128 bits WEP key, either 13 ASCII characters,
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Enable Mac Address Filter Select to enable the MAC Address filter for wireless LAN
identified with SSID 1 to 4 respectively. All the clients
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
III-1-5 WPS
WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) provides easy procedure to make network connection between
wireless station and wireless access point (vigor router) with the encryption of WPA and
WPA2.
Info WPS is available for the wireless station with WPS supported.
It is the simplest way to build connection between wireless network clients and vigor router.
Users do not need to select any encryption mode and type any long encryption passphrase to
setup a wireless client every time. He/she only needs to press a button on wireless client, and
WPS will connect for client and router automatically.
If you want to use PIN code, you have to know the PIN code specified in wireless client.
Then provide the PIN code of the wireless client you wish to connect to the vigor router.
For WPS is supported in WPA-PSK or WPA2-PSK mode, if you do not choose such mode in
Wireless LAN>>Security, you will see the following message box.
Please click OK and go back Wireless LAN>>Security to choose WPA-PSK or WPA2-PSK mode
and access WPS again.
Item Description
Enable WPS Check this box to enable WPS setting.
WPS Status Display related system information for WPS. If the wireless
security (encryption) function of the router is properly
configured, you can see ‘Configured’ message here.
SSID Display the SSID1 of the router. WPS is supported by SSID1
only.
Authentication Mode Display current authentication mode of the router. Only
WPA2/PSK and WPA/PSK support WPS.
Configure via Push Button Click Start PBC to invoke Push-Button style WPS setup
procedure. The router will wait for WPS requests from
wireless clients about two minutes. The WPS LED on the
router will blink fast when WPS is in progress. It will return to
normal condition after two minutes. (You need to setup WPS
within two minutes)
Configure via Client Please input the PIN code specified in wireless client you
PinCode wish to connect, and click Start PIN button. The WPS LED on
the router will blink fast when WPS is in progress. It will
return to normal condition after two minutes. (You need to
setup WPS within two minutes)
To meet the above requirement, two WDS modes are implemented in Vigor router. One is
Bridge, the other is Repeater. Below shows the function of WDS-bridge interface:
Click WDS from Wireless LAN menu. The following page will be shown.
Item Description
Mode Choose the mode for WDS setting. Disable mode will not
invoke any WDS setting. Bridge mode is designed to fulfill
the first type of application. Repeater mode is for the
second one.
Security There are three types for security, Disable, WEP and
Pre-shared key. The setting you choose here will make the
following WEP or Pre-shared key field valid or not. Choose
one of the types for the router.
WEP When WEP is selected as Security above, Vigor router will
use the same WEP key set in Wireless LAN>>Security
Settings page.
All you have to do is to make sure WEP mode and WEP key
setting have been configured properly in Wireless
Access Point Function Click Enable to make this router serve as an access point.
When Repeater is set as WDS Mode, click Enable to use such
function.
Click Disable if Bridge is set as WDS Mode.
Status It allows user to send “hello” message to peers. Yet, it is
valid only when the peer also supports this function.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Operation Mode Mixed Mode – the router can transmit data with the ways
supported in both 802.11a/b/g and 802.11n standards.
However, the entire wireless transmission will be slowed
down if 802.11g or 802.11b wireless client is connected.
Green Field – to get the highest throughput, please choose
such mode. Such mode can make the data transmission
happen between 11n systems only. In addition, it does not
have protection mechanism to avoid the conflict with
Antenna Vigor router can be attached with two antennas to have good
data transmission via wireless connection. However, if you
have only one antenna attached, please choose 1T1R.
RTS Threshold (1 – 2347) Minimize the collision (unit is bytes) between hidden stations
to improve wireless performance.
Set the RTS threshold. Do not modify default value if you
don’t know what it is, default value is 2347.
Country Code Vigor router broadcasts country codes by following the
802.11d standard. However, some wireless stations will
detect / scan the country code to prevent conflict occurred.
If conflict is detected, wireless station will be warned and is
unable to make network connection. Therefore, changing
the country code to ensure successful network connection
will be necessary for some clients.
Auto Channel Filtered Out The selected wireless channels will be discarded if Auto is
List selected as Channel selection mode in Wireless
LAN>>General Setup.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
SSID Display the SSID that the wireless station will use it to
connect with Vigor router.
Enable Check the box to enable the station control function.
Connection Time / Use the drop down list to choose the duration for the
Reconnection Time wireless client connecting /reconnecting to Vigor router. Or,
type the duration manually when you choose User defined.
Display All Station Control All the wireless stations connecting to Vigor router by using
List such SSID will be listed on Station Control List.
Hotspot Web Portal Click it to access in to Hotspot Web Portal page for
modifying the settings if required.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Scan It is used to discover all the connected AP. The results will be
shown on the box above this button.
Statistics It displays the statistics for the channels used by APs.
Add to If you want the found AP applying the WDS settings, please
type in the AP’s MAC address on the bottom of the page and
click Bridge or Repeater. Next, click Add to. Later, the MAC
address of the AP will be added to Bridge or Repeater field of
WDS settings page.
The wireless channel can be accessed by only one wireless station at the same time.
The principle behind the IEEE802.11 channel access mechanisms is that each station has
equal probability to access the channel. When wireless stations have similar data rate, this
principle leads to a fair result. In this case, stations get similar channel access time which is
called airtime.
However, when stations have various data rate (e.g., 11g, 11n), the result is not fair. The
slow stations (11g) work in their slow data rate and occupy too much airtime, whereas the
fast stations (11n) become much slower.
Take the following figure as an example, both Station A(11g) and Station B(11n) transmit data
packets through Vigor router. Although they have equal probability to access the wireless
channel, Station B(11n) gets only a little airtime and waits too much because Station A(11g)
spends longer time to send one packet. In other words, Station B(fast rate) is obstructed by
Station A(slow rate).
To improve this problem, Airtime Fairness is added for Vigor router. Airtime Fairness function
tries to assign similar airtime to each station (A/B) by controlling TX traffic. In the following
figure, Station B(11n) has higher probability to send data packets than Station A(11g). By this
way, Station B(fast rate) gets fair airtime and it's speed is not limited by Station A(slow rate).
Suitable environment:
Item Description
Enable Airtime Fairness Try to assign similar airtime to each wireless station by
controlling TX traffic.
Airtime Fairness – Click the link to display the following
screen of airtime fairness note.
After finishing this web page configuration, please click OK to save the settings.
Info Airtime Fairness function and Bandwidth Limit function should be mutually
exclusive. So their webs have extra actions to ensure these two functions
are not enabled simultaneously.
If dual-band is detected, the AP will let the wireless client connect to less congested wireless
LAN, such as 5GHz to prevent from network congestion.
Info To make Band Steering work successfully, SSID and security on 2.4GHz also
MUST be broadcasted on 5GHz.
Item Description
Enable Band Steering If it is enabled, Vigor router will detect if the wireless client
is capable of dual-band or not within the time limit.
Check Time…. – If the wireless station does not have the
capability of 5GHz network connection, the system shall wait
and check for several seconds (15 seconds, in default) to
make the 2.4GHz network connection. Specify the time limit
for Vigor router to detect the wireless client.
After finishing this web page configuration, please click OK to save the settings.
Same value
for 2.4GHz
and 5GHz
Same value
for 2.4GHz
and 5GHz
6. Now, Vigor router will let the wireless clients connect to less congested wireless LAN,
such as 5GHz to prevent from network congestion.
These access points connecting for each other shall be verified by pre-authentication. This
page allows you to enable the roaming feature and the pre-authentication.
Item Description
Disable RSSI Requirement When the link rate of wireless station is too low or the signal
received by the wireless station is too worse, Vigor router
will automatically detect (based on the link rate and RSSI
requirement) and cut off the network connection for that
wireless station to assist it to connect another Wireless AP to
get better signal.
This option is to disable the roaming mechanism.
Strictly Minimum RSSI Vigor router uses RSSI (received signal strength indicator) to
decide to terminate the network connection of wireless
station. When the signal strength is below the value (dBm)
set here, Vigor router will terminate the network connection
for that wireless station.
Minimum RSSI Minimum RSSI - When the signal strength of the wireless
station is below the value (dBm) set here and adjacent AP
(must be DrayTek AP and support such feature too) with
higher signal strength value (defined in the field of With
Adjacent AP RSSI over) is detected by Vigor router, Vigor
router will terminate the network connection for that
wireless station. Later, the wireless station can connect to
the adjacent AP (with better RSSI).
With Adjacent AP RSSI over – Specify a value as a
threshold.
After finishing this web page configuration, please click OK to save the settings.
Item Description
Refresh Click this button to refresh the status of station list.
Add Click this button to add current typed MAC address into
Access Control.
Voice over IP network (VoIP) enables you to use your broadband Internet connection to make
toll quality voice calls over the Internet.
There are many different call signaling protocols, methods by which VoIP devices can talk to
each other. The most popular protocols are SIP, MGCP, Megaco and H.323. These protocols
are not all compatible with each other (except via a soft-switch server).
The Vigor V models support the SIP protocol as this is an ideal and convenient deployment for
the ITSP (Internet Telephony Service Provider) and softphone and is widely supported. SIP is
an end-to-end, signaling protocol that establishes user presence and mobility in VoIP
structure. Every one who wants to talk using his/her SIP Uniform Resource Identifier, “SIP
Address”. The standard format of SIP URI is
sip: user:password @ host: port
Some fields may be optional in different use. In general, "host” refers to a domain. The
“userinfo” includes the user field, the password field and the @ sign following them. This is
very similar to a URL so some may call it “SIP URL”. SIP supports peer-to-peer direct calling
and also calling via a SIP proxy server (a role similar to the gatekeeper in H.323 networks),
while the MGCP protocol uses client-server architecture, the calling scenario being very
similar to the current PSTN network.
After a call is setup, the voice streams transmit via RTP (Real-Time Transport Protocol).
Different codecs (methods to compress and encode the voice) can be embedded into RTP
packets. Vigor V models provide various codecs, including G.711 A/μ-law, G.723, G.726 and
G.729 A & B. Each codec uses a different bandwidth and hence provides different levels of
voice quality. The more bandwidth a codec uses the better the voice quality, however the
codec used must be appropriate for your Internet bandwidth.
Peer-to-Peer
Before calling, you have to know your friend’s IP Address. The Vigor VoIP Routers will build
connection between each other.
Vigor V models firstly apply efficient codecs designed to make the best use of available
bandwidth, but Vigor V models also equip with automatic QoS assurance. QoS Assurance
assists to assign high priority to voice traffic via Internet. You will always have the required
inbound and outbound bandwidth that is prioritized exclusively for Voice traffic over Internet
but you just get your data a little slower and it is tolerable for data traffic.
Our Vigor V models firstly apply efficient codecs designed to make the best use of available
bandwidth, but Vigor V models also equip with automatic QoS assurance. QoS Assurance
assists to assign high priority to voice traffic via Internet. You will always have the required
inbound and outbound bandwidth that is prioritized exclusively for Voice traffic over Internet
but you just get your data a little slower and it is tolerable for data traffic.
Item Description
Set VoIP service VoIP service provider - Use the drop down list to choose
provider domain the ISP which offers the VoIP service for your router.
SIP Port – Use the default setting (5060).
Set Account quickly Account Number/Name – Type the account number/name
registered to your ISP.
Password – Type the password for the account registered to
your ISP.
3. After finished the settings above, click Next for viewing summary of such connection.
After checking the box and click OK, the following page appears for you to configure secure
phone, IP call; and set NAT Traversal Setting, RTP for the VoIP function.
Item Description
Secure Phone Enable Secure Phone - It allows users to have encrypted RTP
stream with the peer side using the same protocol
(ZRTP+SRTP). Check this box to have secure call.
Enable SAS Voice Prompt - If it is enabled, SAS prompt will
be heard for both ends every time. If it is disabled, no SAS
Info If the incoming or outgoing calls do not match any entry on the phonebook,
the router will try to make the call "being protected". But, if the call ends
up "unprotected"(e.g. peer side does not support ZRTP+SRTP), the router
will not play out a warning message.
Info Selection items for Ring Port will differ according to the router you have.
Item Description
Index Click this link to access into next page for setting SIP
account.
Profile Display the profile name of the account.
Domain/Realm Display the domain name or IP address of the SIP registrar
server.
Proxy Display the domain name or IP address of the SIP proxy
server.
Account Name Display the account name of SIP address before @.
Codec Display the codec type for the account.
Ring Port Specify which port will ring when receiving a phone call.
Status Show the status for the corresponding SIP account. R means
such account is registered on SIP server successfully. – means
Click any index link to access into the following page for configuring SIP account.
Item Description
Profile Name Assign a name for this profile for identifying. You can type
similar name with the domain. For example, if the domain
name is draytel.org, then you might set draytel-1 in this
field.
Register via If you want to make VoIP call without register personal
information, please choose None and check the box to
achieve the goal. Some SIP server allows user to use VoIP
function without registering. For such server, please check
the box of Call without Registration. Choosing Auto is
recommended. The system will select a proper way for your
VoIP call.
Prefer Codec Select one of five codecs as the default for your VoIP calls.
The codec used for each call will be negotiated with the peer
party before each session, and so may not be your default
choice. The default codec is G.729A/B; it occupies little
bandwidth while maintaining good voice quality.
If your upstream speed is only 64Kbps, do not use G.711
codec. It is better for you to have at least 256Kbps upstream
if you would like to use G.711.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Click any index number to display the dial plan setup page.
Item Description
Enable Click this to enable this entry.
Phone Number The speed-dial number of this index. This can be any number
you choose, using digits 0-9 and * .
Display Name The Caller-ID that you want to be displayed on your friend’s
screen. This let your friend can easily know who’s calling
without memorizing lots of SIP URL Address.
SIP URL Enter your friend’s SIP Address.
Dial Out Account Choose one of the SIP accounts for this profile to dial out. It
is useful for both sides (caller and callee) that registered to
different SIP Registrar servers. If caller and callee do not use
the same SIP server, sometimes, the VoIP phone call
connection may not succeed. By using the specified dial out
account, the successful connection can be assured.
Loop through Choose PSTN to enable loop through function.
Backup Phone Number When the VoIP phone obstructs or the Internet breaks down
for some reasons, the backup phone will be dialed out to
replace the VoIP phone number. At this time, the phone call
will be changed from VoIP phone into PSTN call according to
the loop through direction chosen. Note that, during the
phone switch, the blare of phone will appear for a short
time. And when the VoIP phone is switched into the PSTN
phone, the telecom co. might charge you for the connection
fee. Please type in backup phone number for this VoIP phone
setting.
Secure Phone ZRTP+SRTP - It allows users to have encrypted RTP stream
with the peer side using the same protocol (ZRTP+SRTP).
Check this box to have secure call.
Cancel Return to previous web page.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Info If the incoming or outgoing calls do not match any entry on the phonebook,
the router will try to make the call "being protected". But, if the call ends
up "unprotected"(e.g. peer side does not support ZRTP+SRTP), the router
will not play out a warning message.
Item Description
Enable Check this box to invoke this setting.
Match Prefix It is used to match with the number you dialed and may be
modified by the action (add, strip or replace) with the OP
Number.
Mode None - No action.
Add - When you choose this mode, the OP number will be
added before the match prefix number for calling out
through the specific route.
Strip - When you choose this mode, the partial or whole
match prefix number will be deleted according to the OP
number. Take the above picture (Prefix Table Setup web
page) as an example, the OP number of 886 will be deleted
completely for the match prefix number is set with 886.
Replace - When you choose this mode, the OP number will
be replaced by the prefix number for calling out through
the specific VoIP interface. Take the above picture (Prefix
Table Setup web page) as an example, the prefix number of
03 will be replaced by 8863. For example: dial number of
“031111111” will be changed to “88631111111” and sent to
SIP server.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Additionally, you can set advanced settings for call barring such as Block Anonymous, Block
Unknown Domain or Block IP Address.
For Block Anonymous – this function can block the incoming calls without caller ID on the
interface (Phone port) specified in the following window. Such control also can be done based
on preconfigured schedules.
For Block Unknown Domain – this function can block incoming calls (through Phone port) from
unrecognized domain that is not specified in SIP accounts. Such control also can be done based
on preconfigured schedules.
For Block IP Address – this function can block incoming calls (through Phone port) coming from
IP address. Such control also can be done based on preconfigured schedules.
Item Description
Enable Check it to enable this entry.
Call Direction Determine the direction for the phone call, IN – incoming
call, OUT-outgoing call, IN & OUT – both incoming and
outgoing calls.
Barring Type Determine the type of the VoIP phone call, URI/URL or
number.
Specific URI/URL or This field will be changed based on the type you selected
Specific Number for barring Type.
Route All means all the phone calls will be blocked with such
mechanism.
Index (1-15) in Schedule Enter the index of schedule profiles to control the call
barring according to the preconfigured schedules. Refer to
section Applications>>Schedule for detailed
configuration.
Item Description
Enable Regional Check this box to enable this function.
Last Call Return [Miss] Sometimes, people might miss some phone calls. Please
dial number typed in this field to know where the last
phone call comes from and call back to that one.
Last Call Return [In] You have finished an incoming phone call, however you
want to call back again for some reason. Please dial
number typed in this field to call back to that one.
Last Call Return [Out] Dial the number typed in this field to call the previous
outgoing phone call again.
Call Forward [All][Act] Dial the number typed in this field to forward all the
incoming calls to the specified place.
Call Forward [Deact] Dial the number typed in this field to release the call
forward function.
Call Forward [Busy][Act] Dial the number typed in this field to forward all the
incoming calls to the specified place while the phone is
busy.
Call Forward [No Dial the number typed in this field to forward all the
Ans][Act] incoming calls to the specified place while there is no
answer of the connected phone.
Do Not Disturb [Act] Dial the number typed in this field to invoke the function of
DND.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Phone List Port – there are two phone ports provided here for you to
configure. Phone1/Phone2 allows you to set general settings
for PSTN phones.
Call Feature – A brief description for call feature will be
shown in this field for your reference.
Tone - Display the tone settings that configured in the
advanced settings page of Phone Index.
Gain - Display the volume gain settings for Mic/Speaker that
configured in the advanced settings page of Phone Index.
Default SIP Account – “draytel_1” is the default SIP account.
You can click the number below the Index field to change SIP
account for each phone port.
DTMF Relay – Display DTMF mode that configured in the
advanced settings page of Phone Index.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Hotline Check the box to enable it. Type in the SIP URL in the field
for dialing automatically when you pick up the phone set.
Session Timer Check the box to enable the function. In the limited time
that you set in this field, if there is no response, the
connecting call will be closed automatically.
T.38 Fax Function Check the box to enable T.38 fax function.
Error Correction Mode – choose a mode for error correction.
DND (Do Not Disturb) Set a period of peace time without disturbing by VoIP phone
mode call. During the period, the one who dial in will listen busy
tone, yet the local user will not listen any ring tone.
Index (1-15) in Schedule - Enter the index of schedule
profiles to control when the phone will ring and when will
not according to the preconfigured schedules. Refer to
section Application >>Schedule for detailed configuration.
Index (1-60) in Phone Book - Enter the index of phone book
profiles. Refer to section DialPlan – Phone Book for detailed
configuration.
CLIR (hide caller ID) Check this box to hide the caller ID on the display panel of
the phone set.
Call Waiting Check this box to invoke this function. A notice sound will
appear to tell the user new phone call is waiting for your
response. Click hook flash to pick up the waiting phone call.
Call Transfer Check this box to invoke this function. Click hook flash to
initiate another phone call. When the phone call connection
succeeds, hang up the phone. The other two sides can
In addition, you can press the Advanced button to configure tone settings, volume gain, MISC
and DTMF mode. Advanced setting is provided for fitting the telecommunication custom for
the local area of the router installed. Wrong tone settings might cause inconvenience for
users. To set the sound pattern of the phone set, simply choose a proper region to let the
system find out the preset tone settings and caller ID type automatically. Or you can adjust
tone settings manually if you choose User Defined. TOn1, TOff1, TOn2 and TOff2 mean the
cadence of the tone pattern. TOn1 and TOn2 represent sound-on; TOff1 and TOff2 represent
the sound-off.
Item Description
Region Select the proper region which you are located. The common
settings of Caller ID Type, Dial tone, Ringing tone, Busy
tone and Congestion tone will be shown automatically on
the page. If you cannot find out a suitable one, please choose
User Defined and fill out the corresponding values for dial
tone, ringing tone, busy tone, congestion tone by yourself for
VoIP phone.
InBand - Choose this one then the Vigor will send the
DTMF tone as audio directly when you press the keypad
on the phone.
OutBand - Choose this one then the Vigor will capture
the keypad number you pressed and transform it to
digital form then send to the other side; the receiver
will generate the tone according to the digital form it
receive. This function is very useful when the network
traffic congestion occurs and it still can remain the
accuracy of DTMF tone.
IV-1-6 Status
From this page, you can find codec, connection and other important call status for each port.
Item Description
Refresh Seconds Specify the interval of refresh time to obtain the latest VoIP
calling information. The information will update
immediately when the Refresh button is clicked.
A Virtual Private Network (VPN) is the extension of a private network that encompasses links
across shared or public networks like the Internet. In short, by VPN technology, you can send
data between two computers across a shared or public network in a manner that emulates the
properties of a point-to-point private link.
The VPN built is suitable for:
Communication between home office and customer
Secure connection between Teleworker, staff on business trip and main office
Exchange data between remote office and main office
POS between chain store and headquarters
Item Description
LAN-to-LAN Client Choose the client mode.
Mode Selection Route Mode/NAT Mode – If the remote network only allows
you to dial in with single IP, please choose NAT mode,
otherwise please choose Route Mode.
In this page, you have to select suitable VPN type for the VPN client profile. There are six
types provided here. Different type will lead to different configuration page. After
making the choices for the client profile, please click Next. You will see different
configurations based on the selection(s) you made.
Info The following descriptions for VPN Type are based on the Route Mode
specified in LAN-to-LAN Client Mode Selection.
When you choose PPTP (None Encryption) or PPTP (Encryption), you will see the
following graphic:
When you choose SSL, you will see the following graphic:
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for such profile. The length of the file is limited
to 10 characters.
Or,
WAN1 First/ WAN2 First /WAN3 First (or LTE First) /WAN4
First- While connecting, the router will use
WAN1/WAN2/WAN3(or LTE) /WAN4 as the first channel for
VPN connection. If WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 (or LTE) /WAN4 fails,
the router will use another WAN interface instead.
WAN1 Only /WAN2 Only/WAN3 Only(or LTE Only) /WAN4
Only - While connecting, the router will use
WAN1/WAN2/WAN3(or LTE)/WAN4 as the only channel for
VPN connection.
WAN1 Only: Only establish VPN if WAN2 down - If WAN2
failed, the router will use WAN1 for VPN connection.
WAN2 Only: Only establish VPN if WAN1 down - If WAN1
failed, the router will use WAN2 for VPN connection.
Always On Check to enable router always keep VPN connection.
Server IP/Host Name Type the IP address of the server or type the host name for
for VPN such VPN profile.
IKE Authentication IKE Authentication Method usually applies to those are
Method remote dial-in user or node (LAN to LAN) which uses dynamic
IP address and IPsec-related VPN connections such as L2TP
over IPsec and IPsec tunnel.
Pre-Shared Key- Specify a key for IKE authentication.
Confirm Pre-Shared Key-Confirm the pre-shared key.
Digital Signature Click Digital Signature to invoke this function.
(X.509) Peer ID – Choose the peer ID selection from the drop down
list.
3. After finishing the configuration, please click Next. The confirmation page will be
shown as follows. If there is no problem, you can click one of the radio buttons listed on
the page and click Finish to execute the next action.
Item Description
Item Description
VPN Server Mode Choose the direction for the VPN server.
Selection Site to Site VPN – To set a LAN-to-LAN profile automatically,
please choose Site to Site VPN.
Remote Dial-in User –You can manage remote access by
maintaining a table of remote user profile, so that users can
be authenticated to dial-in via VPN connection.
Please choose a This item is available when you choose Site to Site VPN
LAN-to-LAN Profile (LAN-to-LAN) as VPN server mode. There are 32 VPN profiles
for users to set.
Please choose a This item is available when you choose Remote Dial-in User
Dial-in User Accounts (Teleworker) as VPN server mode. There are 32 VPN tunnels
for users to set.
Allowed Dial-in Type This item is available after you choose any one of dial-in user
account profiles. Next, you have to select suitable dial-in
type for the VPN server profile. There are several types
provided here (similar to VPN Client Wizard).
2. After making the choices for the server profile, please click Next. You will see different
configurations based on the selection you made. Here we take the examples of choosing
Site-to-Site VPN as the VPN Server Mode.
When you check PPTP/SSL, you will see the following graphic:
When you check PPTP & IPsec & L2TP (three types) or PPTP & IPsec (two types) or L2TP
with Policy (Nice to Have/Must), you will see the following graphic:
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for such profile. The length of the file is limited
to 10 characters.
User Name This field is used to authenticate for connection when you
select PPTP or L2TP with or without IPsec policy above.
The length of the name is limited to 11 characters.
Password This field is used to authenticate for connection when you
select PPTP or L2TP with or without IPsec policy above.
3. After finishing the configuration, please click Next. The confirmation page will be
shown as follows. If there is no problem, you can click one of the radio buttons listed on
the page and click Finish to execute the next action.
Item Description
Go to the VPN Click this radio button to access VPN and Remote
Connection Access>>Connection Management for viewing VPN
Management Connection status.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Dial-In PPP Authentication PAP Only - elect this option to force the router to
authenticate dial-in users with the PAP protocol.
PAP/CHAP/MS-CHAP/MS-CHAPv2 - Selecting this option
means the router will attempt to authenticate dial-in users
with the CHAP protocol first. If the dial-in user does not
support this protocol, it will fall back to use the PAP protocol
for authentication.
Dial-In PPP Encryption Optional MPPE - This option represents that the MPPE
(MPPE) encryption method will be optionally employed in the router
for the remote dial-in user. If the remote dial-in user does
not support the MPPE encryption algorithm, the router will
transmit “no MPPE encrypted packets”. Otherwise, the MPPE
encryption scheme will be used to encrypt the data.
Require MPPE (40/128bits) - Selecting this option will
force the router to encrypt packets by using the MPPE
encryption algorithm. In addition, the remote dial-in
user will use 40-bit to perform encryption prior to using
128-bit for encryption. In other words, if 128-bit MPPE
encryption method is not available, then 40-bit
encryption scheme will be applied to encrypt the data.
Maximum MPPE - This option indicates that the router
will use the MPPE encryption scheme with maximum
PPTP LDAP Profile Configured LDAP profiles will be listed under such item.
Simply check the one you want to enable the PPP
authentication by LDAP server profiles.
However, if there is no profile listed, simply click the link of
PPTP LDAP Profile to create/add some new LDAP profiles
you want.
While using Radius or If PPP connection will be authenticated via RADIUS server or
LDAP Authentication LDAP profiles, it is necessary to specify the LAN profile for
the dial-in user to get IP from.
Encapsulating Security Payload (ESP) is a security protocol that provides data confidentiality
and protection with optional authentication and replay detection service.
Item Description
IKE Authentication This usually applies to those are remote dial-in user or node
Method (LAN-to-LAN) which uses dynamic IP address and
IPsec-related VPN connections such as L2TP over IPsec and
IPsec tunnel. There are two methods offered by Vigor router
for you to authenticate the incoming data coming from
remote dial-in user, Certificate (X.509) and Pre-Shared
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Click it to clear all indexes.
Index Click the number below Index to access into the setting page
Click each index to edit one peer digital certificate. There are three security levels of digital
signature authentication: Fill each necessary field to authenticate the remote peer. The
following explanation will guide you to fill all the necessary fields.
Item Description
Profile Name Type the name of the profile. The maximum length of the
name you can set is 32 characters.
Enable this account Check it to enable such account profile.
Accept Any Peer ID Click to accept any peer regardless of its identity.
Accept Subject Click to check one specific field of digital signature to accept
Alternative Name the peer with matching value. The field can be IP Address,
Domain, or E-mail Address. The box under the Type will
appear according to the type you select and ask you to fill in
corresponding setting.
Accept Subject Name Click to check the specific fields of digital signature to
accept the peer with matching value. The field includes
Country (C), State (ST), Location (L), Organization (O),
Organization Unit (OU), Common Name (CN), and Email
(E).
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
The router provides 64 access accounts for dial-in users. Besides, you can extend the user
accounts to the RADIUS server through the built-in RADIUS client function. The following
figure shows the summary table.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Click to clear all indexes.
View All – Click it to display the all of the user accounts.
Online – Click it to display the online user accounts.
Offline – Click it to display the offline user accounts.
Index Click the number below Index to access into the setting page
of Remote Dial-in User.
User Display the username for the specific dial-in user of the
LAN-to-LAN profile. The symbol ??? represents that the
profile is empty.
Active Check the box to activate such profile.
Click each index to edit one remote user profile. Each Dial-In Type requires you to fill the
different corresponding fields on the right. If the fields gray out, it means you may leave it
untouched. The following explanation will guide you to fill all the necessary fields.
Item Description
User account and Enable this account - Check the box to enable this function.
Authentication Idle Timeout- If the dial-in user is idle over the limitation of
the timer, the router will drop this connection. By default,
the Idle Timeout is set to 300 seconds.
Allowed Dial-In Type PPTP - Allow the remote dial-in user to make a PPTP VPN
connection through the Internet. You should set the User
Name and Password of remote dial-in user below.
IPsec Tunnel - Allow the remote dial-in user to make an
IPsec VPN connection through Internet.
L2TP with IPsec Policy - Allow the remote dial-in user to
make a L2TP VPN connection through the Internet. You can
select to use L2TP alone or with IPsec. Select from below:
None - Do not apply the IPsec policy. Accordingly, the
VPN connection employed the L2TP without IPsec
policy can be viewed as one pure L2TP connection.
Nice to Have - Apply the IPsec policy first, if it is
applicable during negotiation. Otherwise, the dial-in
VPN connection becomes one pure L2TP connection.
Must -Specify the IPsec policy to be definitely applied
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
The following figure shows the summary table according to the item (All/Trunk) selected for
View.
The following shows profiles joined into VPN Load Balance and VPN Backup mechanism.
Item Description
View All – Click it to display the LAN to LAN profiles.
Online – Click it to display the online profiles.
Offline – Click it to display the offline profiles.
Trunk – Click it to display the Trunk profiles.
Set to Factory Default Click to clear all indexes.
Name Indicate the name of the LAN-to-LAN profile. The symbol ???
represents that the profile is empty.
Active V – means the profile has been enabled.
X – means the profile has not been enabled.
Status Online – means such LAN to LAN profile is in use.
Offline – means such LAN to LAN profile isn’t in use even if
the profile has been enabled.
1. Click each index to edit each profile and you will get the following page. Each
LAN-to-LAN profile includes 4 subgroups. If the fields gray out, it means you may leave it
untouched. The following explanations will guide you to fill all the necessary fields.
Item Description
Common Settings Profile Name – Specify a name for the profile of the
LAN-to-LAN connection.
Enable this profile - Check here to activate this profile.
VPN Dial-Out Through - Use the drop down menu to choose a
proper WAN interface for this profile. This setting is useful
for dial-out only.
WAN1 First/ WAN2 First/ WAN3 First or LTE
First/WAN4 First- While connecting, the router will use
WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 or LTE/WAN4 as the first channel
for VPN connection. If WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 or LTE
/WAN4 fails, the router will use another WAN interface
instead.
WAN1 Only /WAN2 Only/WAN 3 Only or LTE Only
/WAN 4 Only- While connecting, the router will use
WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 or LTE /WAN4 as the only channel
for VPN connection.
WAN1 Only: Only establish VPN if WAN2 down - If
WAN2 failed, the router will use WAN1 for VPN
connection.
WAN2 Only: Only establish VPN if WAN1 down - If
WAN1 fa
Netbios Naming Packet
Pass – click it to have an inquiry for data transmission
Item Description
Dial-In Settings Allowed Dial-In Type - Determine the dial-in connection
with different types.
PPTP - Allow the remote dial-in user to make a PPTP
VPN connection through the Internet. You should set
the User Name and Password of remote dial-in user
below.
IPsec Tunnel- Allow the remote dial-in user to trigger
an IPsec VPN connection through Internet.
L2TP with IPsec Policy - Allow the remote dial-in user
to make a L2TP VPN connection through the Internet.
You can select to use L2TP alone or with IPsec. Select
from below:
None - Do not apply the IPsec policy. Accordingly,
the VPN connection employed the L2TP without
IPsec policy can be viewed as one pure L2TP
connection.
Nice to Have - Apply the IPsec policy first, if it is
applicable during negotiation. Otherwise, the
dial-in VPN connection becomes one pure L2TP
connection.
Must - Specify the IPsec policy to be definitely
applied on the L2TP connection.
SSL Tunnel- Allow the remote dial-in user to trigger an
SSL VPN connection through Internet.
GRE over IPsec Enable IPsec Dial-Out function GRE over IPsec: Check this
Settings box to verify data and transmit data in encryption with GRE
over IPsec packet after configuring IPsec Dial-Out setting.
Both ends must match for each other by setting same virtual
IP address for communication.
Logical Traffic: Such technique comes from RFC2890. Define
logical traffic for data transmission between both sides of
TCP/IP Network My WAN IP –This field is only applicable when you select
Settings PPTP or L2TP with or without IPsec policy above. The default
value is 0.0.0.0, which means the Vigor router will get a PPP
IP address from the remote router during the IPCP
negotiation phase. If the PPP IP address is fixed by remote
side, specify the fixed IP address here. Do not change the
default value if you do not select PPTP or L2TP.
Remote Gateway IP - This field is only applicable when you
select PPTP or L2TP with or without IPsec policy above. The
default value is 0.0.0.0, which means the Vigor router will
get a remote Gateway PPP IP address from the remote router
during the IPCP negotiation phase. If the PPP IP address is
fixed by remote side, specify the fixed IP address here. Do
not change the default value if you do not select PPTP or
L2TP.
Remote Network IP/ Remote Network Mask - Add a static
route to direct all traffic destined to this Remote Network IP
Address/Remote Network Mask through the VPN connection.
For IPsec, this is the destination clients IDs of phase 2 quick
mode.
Local Network IP / Local Network Mask - Display the local
network IP and mask for TCP / IP configuration. You can
modify the settings if required.
More - Add a static route to direct all traffic destined to
more Remote Network IP Addresses/ Remote Network Masks
through the VPN connection. This is usually used when you
find there are several subnets behind the remote VPN router.
2. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Backup Profile List Set to Factory Default - Click to clear all VPN TRUNK-VPN
Backup mechanism profile.
No – The order of VPN TRUNK-VPN Backup mechanism
profile.
Status - “v” means such profile is enabled; “x” means such
profile is disabled.
Name - Display the name of VPN TRUNK-VPN Backup
mechanism profile.
Member1 - Display the dial-out profile selected from the
Member1 drop down list below.
Active - “Yes” means normal condition. “No” means the
state might be disabled or that profile currently is set with
Dial-in mode (for call direction) in LAN-to-LAN.
Type - Display the connection type for that profile, such as
IPsec, PPTP, L2TP, L2TP over IPsec (NICE), L2TP over
IPsec(MUST) and so on.
Member2 - Display the dial-out profile selected from the
Member2 drop down list below.
Advanced – This button is available only when LAN to LAN
profile (or more) is created.
Time for activating VPN TRUNK – VPN Load Balance mechanism profile
After finishing the connection for one tunnel, the other tunnel will dial out automatically
within two seconds. Therefore, you can choose any one of members under VPN Load Balance
for dialing out.
Time for activating VPN TRUNK –Dial-out when VPN Load Balance Disconnected
For there is one Tunnel created and connected successfully, to keep the load balance effect
between two tunnels, auto-dial will be executed within two seconds.
To close two tunnels of load balance after connecting, please click Disable for Status in
General Setup field.
4. Take a look for LAN-to-LAN profiles. Index 1 is chosen as Member1; index 2 is chosen as
Member2. For such reason, LAN-to-LAN profiles of 1 and 2 will be expressed in red to
indicate that they are fixed. If you delete the VPN TRUNK – VPN Backup/Load Balance
mechanism profile, the selected LAN-to-LAN profiles will be released and expressed in
black.
After setting profiles for load balance, you can choose any one of them and click Advance for
more detailed configuration. The windows for advanced load balance and backup are
different. Refer to the following explanation:
Item Description
Profile Name List the load balance profile name.
Load Balance Algorithm Round Robin – Based on packet base, both tunnels will send
the packet alternatively. Such method can reach the balance
of packet transmission with fixed rate.
Weighted Round Robin –Such method can reach the balance
of packet transmission with flexible rate. It can be divided
into Auto Weighted and According to Speed Ratio. Auto
Weighted can detect the device speed (10Mbps/100Mbps)
and switch with fixed value ratio (3:7) for packet
transmission. If the transmission rate for packets on both
sides of the tunnels is the same, the value of Auto Weighted
should be 5.5. According to Speed Ratio allows user to
adjust suitable rate manually. There are 100 groups of rate
ratio for Member1:Member2 (range from 1:99 to 99:1).
VPN Load Balance Policy Below shows the algorithm for Load Balance.
Edit – Click this radio button for assign a blank table for
configuring Binding Tunnel.
Insert after – Click this radio button to adding a new binding
tunnel table.
Advanced Backup
Item Description
Profile Name List the backup profile name.
ERD Mode ERD means “Environment Recovers Detection”.
Normal – choose this mode to make all dial-out VPN TRUNK
Item Description
Dial-out Tool General Mode - This filed displays the profile configured in
LAN-to-LAN (with Index number and VPN Server IP address).
The VPN connection built by General Mode does not support
VPN backup function.
A-1 How to Build a LAN-to-LAN VPN Between Remote Office and Headquarter
via IPsec Tunnel (Main Mode)
3. Click any index number to open the configuration page. Type a name which is easy for
identification for such profile (in this case, type VPN Server), and check the box of
Enable This Profile. For Vigor router will be set as a server, the call direction shall be
set as Dial-in and set 0 as Idle Timeout.
5. Continue to navigate to the TCP/IP Network Settings for setting the LAN IP for remote
side.
3. Click any index number to open the configuration page. Type a name which is easy for
identification for such profile (in this case, type VPN Client), and check the box of
Enable This Profile. For such Vigor router will be set as a client, the call direction shall
be set as Dial-out. Check the box of Always on for a permanent VPN connection.
5. Continue to navigate to the TCP/IP Network Settings for setting the LAN IP for the
remote side.
An SSL VPN (Secure Sockets Layer virtual private network) is a form of VPN that can be used
with a standard Web browser.
There are two benefits that SSL VPN provides:
It is not necessary for users to preinstall VPN client software for executing SSL VPN
connection.
There are less restrictions for the data encrypted through SSL VPN in comparing with
traditional VPN.
Item Description
Bind to WAN Choose and check WAN interface(s) for SSL VPN tunnel
establishment.
Port Such port is set for SSL VPN server. It will not affect the HTTPS
Port configuration set in System Maintenance>>Management.
In general, the default setting is 443.
Server Certificate When the client does not set any certificate, default
certificate will be used for HTTPS and SSL VPN server. Choose
any one of the user-defined certificates from the drop down
list if users set several certificates previously. Otherwise,
choose Self-signed to use the router’s built-in default
certificate. The default certificate can be used in SSL VPN
server and HTTPS Web Proxy.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Name Display the name of the profile that you create.
URL Display the URL.
Active Display current status (active or inactive) of such profile.
Item Description
Name Type name of the profile. The length of the name is limited to
15 characters.
URL Type the address (function variation or IP address) or path of
the proxy server.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Name Display the application name of the profile that you create.
Host Address Display the IP address for VNC/RDP or SMB path.
Service Display the type of the service selected, e.g., VNC/RDP/SMB.
Active Display current status (active or inactive) of the selected
profile.
Item Description
Enable Application Check the box to enable such profile.
IP Address If you choose VNC or RDP, you have to type the IP address for
this protocol.
Port If you choose VNC or RDP, you have to specify the port used
for this protocol. The default setting is 5900.
Idle Timeout If you choose VNC, you have to specify the time for
disconnecting the SSL VPN tunnel.
Scaling If you choose VNC, you have to choose the percentage (100%,
80%, 60%) for such application.
Screen Size If you choose RDP, you have to choose the screen size for
such application.
SMB Path If you choose SMB, you have to specify the path of the SMB
service.
Item Description
User account and Enable this account - Check the box to enable this function.
Authentication Idle Timeout- If the dial-in user is idle over the limitation of
the timer, the router will drop this connection. By default, the
Idle Timeout is set to 300 seconds.
User Name - This field is applicable when you select PPTP or
L2TP with or without IPsec policy above. The length of the
name/password is limited to 23 characters.
Password - This field is applicable when you select PPTP or
L2TP with or without IPsec policy above. The length of the
name/password is limited to 19 characters.
Enable Mobile One-Time Passwords (mOTP) - Check this box
to make the authentication with mOTP function.
PIN Code – Type the code for authentication (e.g, 1234).
Secret – Use the 32 digit-secret number generated by mOTP in
the mobile phone (e.g., e759bb6f0e94c7ab4fe6).
Allowed Dial-In Type PPTP - Allow the remote dial-in user to make a PPTP VPN
connection through the Internet. You should set the User
Name and Password of remote dial-in user below.
IPSec Tunnel - Allow the remote dial-in user to make an IPSec
VPN connection through Internet.
L2TP with IPSec Policy - Allow the remote dial-in user to
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Click to clear all indexes.
Index Display the number of the client which connecting to FTP
server.
Name Display the name of the group profile.
Click any index number link to open the following page for detailed configuration.
Item Description
Enable Check this box to enable such profile.
Group Name Type a name for such profile. The length of the name is
limited to 23 characters.
Access Authority Specify the authority for such profile.
At present, Vigor router allows you to create SSL Web Proxy
and SSL Application profiles used for SSL VPN. The available
profiles will be displayed here for you to select.
Authentication Methods It can determine the authentication method used for such
profile.
Local User DataBase – The system will do the authentication
by using the user defined account profiles (in VPN and Remote
Access>>Remote Dial-In User). The enabled profiles will be
listed in the Available User Account on the left box. To add a
profile into a group, simply choose the one from the left box
and click the >> button. It will be displayed in the Selected
User Account on the right box. For detailed information about
configuring the profile setting, refer to Objects Setting>>IP
Group.
RADIUS – The RADIUS server will do the authentication by using
the username and password
TACACS+ - The TACACS+ will do the authentication by using
the username and password.
LDAP / Active Directory - If it is checked, the LDAP / AD
server will do the authentication by using the username,
password, information stated on the selected profiles.
If the above three options are enabled, the system will do the
authentication based on them in sequence.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Next, users can open SSL VPN>> Online Status to view logging status of SSL VPN.
Item Description
Active User Display current user who visits SSL VPN server.
Host IP Display the IP address for the host.
Time out Display the time remaining for logging out.
Action You can click Drop to drop certain login user from the router's
SSL Portal UI.
A digital certificate works as an electronic ID, which is issued by a certification authority (CA).
It contains information such as your name, a serial number, expiration dates etc., and the
digital signature of the certificate-issuing authority so that a recipient can verify that the
certificate is real. Here Vigor router support digital certificates conforming to standard
X.509.
Any entity wants to utilize digital certificates should first request a certificate issued by a CA
server. It should also retrieve certificates of other trusted CA servers so it can authenticate
the peer with certificates issued by those trusted CA servers.
Here you can manage generate and manage the local digital certificates, and set trusted CA
certificates. Remember to adjust the time of Vigor router before using the certificate so that
you can get the correct valid period of certificate.
Below shows the menu items for Certificate Management.
Item Description
Generate Click this button to open Generate Certificate Request
window.
Type in all the information that the window requests. Then
click Generate again.
Import Click this button to import a saved file as the certification
information.
Refresh Click this button to refresh the information listed below.
View Click this button to view the detailed settings for certificate
request.
Delete Click this button to delete selected name with certification
information.
GENERATE
Click this button to open Generate Certificate Signing Request window. Type in all the
information that the window request such as certifcate name (used for identifying different
certificate), subject alternative name type and relational settings for subject name. Then
click GENERATE again.
After clicking GENERATE, the generated information will be displayed on the window below:
IMPORT
Vigor router allows you to generate a certificate request and submit it the CA server, then
import it as “Local Certificate”. If you have already gotten a certificate from a third party,
you may import it directly. The supported types are PKCS12 Certificate and Certificate with a
private key.
Click this button to import a saved file as the certification information. There are three types
of local certificate supported by Vigor router.
Item Description
Upload Local Certificate It allows users to import the certificate which is generated by
Vigor router and signed by CA server.
If you have done well in certificate generation, the Status of
the certificate will be shown as “OK”.
Upload PKCS12 It allows users to import the certificate whose extensions are
Certificate usually .pfx or .p12. And these certificates usually
need passwords.
Note that PKCS12 is a standard for storing private keys and
certificates securely. It is used in (among other things)
Netscape and Microsoft Internet Explorer with their import
and export options.
Upload Certificate and It is useful when users have separated certificates and private
Private Key keys. And the password is needed if the private key is
encrypted.
View
Click this button to view the detailed settings for certificate request.
Info You have to copy the certificate request information from above window.
Next, access your CA server and enter the page of certificate request, copy
the information into it and submit a request. A new certificate will be
issued to you by the CA server. You can save it.
Delete
Click this button to remove the selected certificate.
Info Root CA can be deleted but not edited. If you want to modify the settings
for a Root CA, please delete the one and create another one by clicking
Create Root CA.
Creating a Root CA
Click Create to open the following page. Type in all the information that the window request
such as certifcate name (used for identifying different certificate), subject alternative name
type and relational settings for subject name. Then click Generate again.
For viewing each trusted CA certificate, click View to open the certificate detail information
window. If you want to delete a CA certificate, choose the one and click Delete to remove all
the certificate information.
While the broadband users demand more bandwidth for multimedia, interactive applications,
or distance learning, security has been always the most concerned. The firewall of the Vigor
router helps to protect your local network against attack from unauthorized outsiders. It also
restricts users in the local network from accessing the Internet. Furthermore, it can filter out
specific packets that trigger the router to build an unwanted outgoing connection.
Firewall Facilities
The users on the LAN are provided with secured protection by the following firewall facilities:
User-configurable IP filter (Call Filter/ Data Filter).
Stateful Packet Inspection (SPI): tracks packets and denies unsolicited incoming data
Selectable Denial of Service (DoS) /Distributed DoS (DDoS) attacks protection
IP Filters
Depending on whether there is an existing Internet connection, or in other words “the WAN
link status is up or down”, the IP filter architecture categorizes traffic into two: Call Filter
and Data Filter.
Call Filter - When there is no existing Internet connection, Call Filter is applied to all
traffic, all of which should be outgoing. It will check packets according to the filter rules.
If legal, the packet will pass. Then the router shall “initiate a call” to build the Internet
connection and send the packet to Internet.
Data Filter - When there is an existing Internet connection, Data Filter is applied to
incoming and outgoing traffic. It will check packets according to the filter rules. If legal,
the packet will pass the router.
The following illustrations are flow charts explaining how router will treat incoming traffic
and outgoing traffic respectively.
Item Description
Call Filter Check Enable to activate the Call Filter function. Assign a
start filter set for the Call Filter.
Item Description
Filter Select Pass or Block for the packets that do not match with
the filter rules.
Sessions Control The number typed here is the total sessions of the packets
that do not match the filter rule configured in this page. The
default setting is 60000.
Quality of Service Choose one of the QoS rules to be applied as firewall rule.
For detailed information of setting QoS, please refer to the
related section later.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
To edit or add a filter, click on the set number to edit the individual set. The following page
will be shown. Each filter set contains up to 7 rules. Click on the rule number button to edit
each rule. Check Active to enable the rule.
Item Description
Filter Rule Click a button numbered (1 ~ 7) to edit the filter rule. Click
the button will open Edit Filter Rule web page. For the
detailed information, refer to the following page.
Active Enable or disable the filter rule.
Comment Enter filter set comments/description. Maximum length is
23–character long.
Direction Display the direction of packet.
Src IP / Dst IP Display the IP address of source /destination.
Service Type Display the type and port number of the packet.
Item Description
Comments Enter filter set comments/description. Maximum length is
14- character long.
Direction Set the direction of packet flow. It is for Data Filter only.
For the Call Filter, this setting is not available since Call
Filter is only applied to outgoing traffic.
Note: RT means routing domain for 2nd subnet or other
LAN.
Source/Destination IP To set the IP address manually, please choose Any
Address/Single Address/Range Address/Subnet Address as
the Address Type and type them in this dialog.
Protocol Specify the protocol(s) which this filter rule will apply to.
Item Description
Pass Immediately Packets matching the rule will be passed immediately.
APP Enforcement - Select an APP Enforcement profile for
global IM/P2P application blocking. If there is no profile for
you to select, please choose [Create New] from the drop
down list in this page to create a new profile. All the hosts
in LAN must follow the standard configured in the APP
Enforcement profile selected here. For detailed
information, refer to the section of APP Enforcement
profile setup. For troubleshooting needs, you can specify to
record information for IM/P2P by checking the Log box. It
will be sent to Syslog server. Please refer to section
Syslog/Mail Alert for more detailed information.
URL Content Filter - Select one of the URL Content Filter
profile settings (created in CSM>> URL Content Filter) for
applying with this router. Please set at least one profile for
choosing in CSM>> URL Content Filter web page first. Or
choose [Create New] from the drop down list in this page
to create a new profile. For troubleshooting needs, you can
specify to record information for URL Content Filter by
checking the Log box. It will be sent to Syslog server. Please
refer to section Syslog/Mail Alert for more detailed
information.
Web Content Filter - Select one of the Web Content Filter
profile settings (created in CSM>> Web Content Filter) for
applying with this router. Please set at least one profile for
anti-virus in CSM>> Web Content Filter web page first. Or
4. After choosing the mechanism, click Next to get the summary page for reference.
Item Description
Check to enable the Check this box to enable the filter rule.
Filter Rule
Comments Enter filter set comments/description. Maximum length is
14- character long.
Index(1-15) Set PCs on LAN to work at certain time interval only. You
may choose up to 4 schedules out of the 15 schedules
pre-defined in Applications >> Schedule setup. The
default setting of this field is blank and the function will
always work.
Clear sessions when Check this box to clear the sessions when the above
schedule ON schedule profiles are applied.
Direction Set the direction of packet flow. It is for Data Filter only.
For the Call Filter, this setting is not available since Call
Filter is only applied to outgoing traffic.
From the IP Group drop down list, choose the one that you
want to apply. Or use the IP Object drop down list to
choose the object that you want.
Service Type Click Edit to access into the following dialog to choose a
suitable service type.
3. When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Enable Dos Defense Check the box to activate the DoS Defense Functionality.
Select All Click this button to select all the items listed below.
Enable SYN flood defense Check the box to activate the SYN flood defense function.
Once detecting the Threshold of the TCP SYN packets from
the Internet has exceeded the defined value, the Vigor
router will start to randomly discard the subsequent TCP
SYN packets for a period defined in Timeout. The goal for
this is prevent the TCP SYN packets’ attempt to exhaust the
limited-resource of Vigor router.
By default, the threshold and timeout values are set to
2000 packets per second and 10 seconds, respectively. That
means, when 2000 packets per second received, they will
be regarded as “attack event” and the session will be
paused for 10 seconds.
Enable UDP flood defense Check the box to activate the UDP flood defense function.
Once detecting the Threshold of the UDP packets from the
Internet has exceeded the defined value, the Vigor router
will start to randomly discard the subsequent UDP packets
for a period defined in Timeout.
The default setting for threshold and timeout are 2000
Info The result obtained by using Diagnose is offered for RD debug. It will be
different according to actual state such as netework connection, LAN/WAN
settings and so on.
Item Description
Mode To have a firewall rule test, specify the service type (ICMP,
UDP, TCP) of the packet and type of the IP address
(IPv4/IPv6).
Direction Set the way (from WAN or from LAN) that Vigor router
receives the first packet for test. Different way means the
firewall will process the connection initiated from LAN or
from WAN.
Test View This is a dynamic display page.
According to the direction specified, test view will display
the figure to guide you typing IP address, port number, and
MAC address.
Later, after clicking the Analyze button, the information for
the firewall rule profile and address translation will be
shown on this page.
Src IP Type the IPv4/IPv6 address of the packet’s source.
Src Port Type the port number of the packet’s source.
Src MAC Type the MAC address of the packet’s source.
The way we can use is to set two rules under Firewall. For Rule 1 of Set 2 under
Firewall>>Filter Setup is used as the default setting, we have to create a new rule starting
from Filter Rule 2 of Set 2.
1. Access into the web user interface of Vigor router.
2. Open Firewall>>Filter Setup. Click the Set 2 link, choose Advance Mode and choose the
Filter Rule 2 button.
Info In default, the router will check the packets starting with Set 2, Filter Rule
2 to Filter Rule 7. If Block If No Further Match for is selected for Filter, the
firewall of the router would check the packets with the rules starting from
Rule 3 to Rule 7. The packets not matching with the rules will be processed
according to Rule 2.
4. Next, set another rule. Just open Firewall>>Filter Setup. Click the Set 2 link and
choose the Filter Rule 3 button.
5. Check the box of Check to enable the Filter Rule. Type the comments (e.g., open_ip).
Click the Edit button for Source IP.
7. Now, check the content of Source IP is correct or not. The action for Filter shall be set
with Pass Immediately. Then, click OK to save the settings.
Now, all the settings are configured well. Only the computers with the IP addresses within
192.168.1.10 ~ 192.168.1.20 can access to Internet.
Info The priority of URL Content Filter is higher than Web Content Filter.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Profile Display the number of the profile which allows you to click to
set different policy.
Name Display the name of the APP Enforcement Profile.
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for the CSM profile. The maximum length of the
name you can set is 15 characters.
Select All Click it to choose all of the items in this page.
Clear All Uncheck all the selected boxes.
Enable Check the box to select the APP to be blocked by Vigor
router.
Adv A button under Enable check box allows you to open a pop up
window to specify activity for that APP.
The profiles configured here can be applied in the Firewall>>General Setup and
Firewall>>Filter Setup pages as the standard for the host(s) to follow.
Item Description
Upgrade Setting APPE Module Version – Display current version status of
APPE signature.
New version from the Internet – Download button is
available only when Vigor router detects new APPE version.
After clicking it, a dialog will appear with information added
to such new version. Click OK to exit the dialog and start the
signature upgrade.
Upgrade via interface – Choose one of the WAN interfaces as
a channel for APPE signature upgrade.
Setup Download Server Specify the download server by typing the URL of the server
located. Or you can click Find more link to search the one
you want.
Signature authentication/download message – Display the
status of APPE Signature Upgrade.
Upgrade Automatically Scheduled Update - Check the box to make Vigor router
upgrading the APPE signature based on the schedule
configured here.
After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for the CSM profile. The maximum length of the
name you can set is 15 characters.
Priority It determines the action that this router will apply.
Both: Pass – The router will let all the packages that match
with the conditions specified in URL Access Control and Web
Feature below passing through. When you choose this
setting, both configuration set in this page for URL Access
Control and Web Feature will be inactive.
Both:Block –The router will block all the packages that
match with the conditions specified in URL Access Control
and Web Feature below. When you choose this setting, both
configuration set in this page for URL Access Control and Web
Feature will be inactive.
Either: URL Access Control First – When all the packages
matching with the conditions specified in URL Access Control
and Web Feature below, such function can determine the
priority for the actions executed. For this one, the router
will process the packages with the conditions set below for
URL first, then Web feature second.
Either: Web Feature First –When all the packages matching
with the conditions specified in URL Access Control and Web
Feature below, such function can determine the priority for
the actions executed. For this one, the router will process
the packages with the conditions set below for web feature
first, then URL second.
URL Access Control Enable URL Access Control - Check the box to activate URL
Access Control. Note that the priority for URL Access
Control is higher than Restrict Web Feature. If the web
content match the setting set in URL Access Control, the
router will execute the action specified in this field and
ignore the action specified under Restrict Web Feature.
Prevent web access from IP address - Check the box to deny
any web surfing activity using IP address, such as
http://202.6.3.2. The reason for this is to prevent someone
dodges the URL Access Control. You must clear your browser
cache first so that the URL content filtering facility operates
properly on a web page that you visited before.
Action – This setting is available only when Either : URL
Access Control First or Either : Web Feature First is
selected.
Pass - Allow accessing into the corresponding webpage
with the keywords listed on the box below.
Block - Restrict accessing into the corresponding
webpage with the keywords listed on the box below.
If the web pages do not match with the keyword set
here, it will be processed with reverse action.
Exception List – Specify the object profile(s) as the
exception list which will be processed in an opposite manner
to the action selected above.
Group/Object Selections – The Vigor router provides several
frames for users to define keywords and each frame supports
multiple keywords. The keyword could be a noun, a partial
noun, or a complete URL string. Multiple keywords within a
frame are separated by space, comma, or semicolon. In
addition, the maximal length of each frame is 32-character
long. After specifying keywords, the Vigor router will decline
the connection request to the website whose URL string
matched to any user-defined keyword. It should be noticed
that the more simplified the blocking keyword list is, the
more efficiently the Vigor router performs.
After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Info 1 Web Content Filter (WCF) is not a built-in service of Vigor router but a
service powered by Commtouch. If you want to use such service (trial or
formal edition), you have to perform the procedure of activation first. For
the service of formal edition, please contact with your dealer/distributor
for detailed information.
Info 2 Commtouch is merged by Cyren, and GlobalView services will be continued
to deliver powerful cloud-based information security solutions! Refer to:
http://www.prnewswire.com/news-releases/commtouch-is-now-cyren-239
025151.html
Item Description
Activate Click it to access into MyVigor for activating WCF service.
Setup Query Server It is recommended for you to use the default setting,
auto-selected. You need to specify a server for categorize
searching when you type URL in browser based on the web
content filter profile.
Setup Test Server It is recommended for you to use the default setting,
auto-selected.
Find more Click it to open http://myvigor.draytek.com for searching
another qualified and suitable server.
Test a site to verify Click this link to do the verification.
whether it is categorized
Set to Factory Default Click this link to retrieve the factory settings.
Administration Message You can type the message manually for your necessity or
click Default Message button to get the default text
displayed on the field of Administration Message.
Cache None – the router will check the URL that the user wants to
access via WCF precisely, however, the processing rate is
normal. Such item can provide the most accurate URL
matching.
L1 – the router will check the URL that the user wants to
access via WCF. If the URL has been accessed previously, it
will be stored in the router to be accessed quickly if
Eight profiles are provided here as Web content filters. Simply click the index number under
Profile to open the following web page. The items listed in Categories will be changed
according to the different service providers. If you have and activate another web content
filter license, the items will be changed simultaneously. All of the configuration made for web
content filter will be deleted automatically. Therefore, please backup your data before you
change the web content filter license.
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for the CSM profile. The maximum length of the
name you can set is 15 characters.
Black/White List Enable – Activate white/black list function for such profile.
Group/Object Selections – Click Edit to choose the group or
object profile as the content of white/black list.
Pass - allow accessing into the corresponding webpage with
After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Info For DNS filter must use the WCF service profile to filter the packets,
therefore WCF license must be activated first. Otherwise, DNS filter does
not have any effect on packets.
Item Description
DNS Filter Profile Table It displays a list of different DNS filter profiles (with
specified WCF and UCF).
Click the profile link to open the following page. Then, type
the name of the profile and specify WCF/UCF based on your
requirement.
DNS Filter Local Setting DNS Filter Local Setting will be applied to DNS query from
clients on LAN when router’s DNS server is used.
DNS Filter - Check Enable to enable such feature.
Syslog - The filtering result can be recorded according to the
setting selected for Syslog.
None – There is no log file will be recorded for this
profile.
Pass – Only the log about Pass will be recorded in Syslog.
Block – Only the log about Block will be recorded in
Syslog.
All – All the actions (Pass and Block) will be recorded in
Syslog.
WCF- Set the filtering conditions.
UCF - Set the filtering conditions.
Black/White List – Specify IP address, subnet mask, IP
object, or IP group as a black list or white list for DNS
packets passing through or blocked by Vigor router.
Administration Message Type the words or sentences which will be displayed when a
web page is blocked by Vigor router. You can type the
message manually for your necessity or click Default
Message button to get the default text displayed on the field
of Administration Message.
After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Or
Click System Maintenance>>Activation to open the following page.
8. Check to see the confirmation email with the title of New Account Confirmation Letter
from myvigor.draytek.com.
9. Click the Activate my Account link to enable the account that you created. The following
screen will be shown to verify the register process is finished. Please click Login.
11. Now, click Login. Your account has been activated. You can access into MyVigor server to
activate the service (e.g., WCF) that you want.
3. Type your personal information in this page and then click Continue.
7. Click the Activate my Account link to enable the account that you created. The following
screen will be shown to verify the register process is finished. Please click Login.
Now, click Login. Your account has been activated. You can access into MyVigor server to
activate the service (e.g., WCF) that you want.
3. Open CSM>>URL Content Filter Profile. Click an index number to open the setting
page.
4. Configure the settings as the following figure.
5. When you finished the above steps, please open Firewall>>General Setup.
6. Click the Default Rule tab. Choose the profile just configured from the drop down list in
the field of URL Content Filter. Now, users cannot open any web page with the word
“facebook” inside.
For the system setup, there are several items that you have to know the way of configuration:
System Status, TR-069, Administrator Password, User Password, Login Page Greeting,
Configuration Backup, Syslog /Mail Alert, Time and Date, Management, Reboot System,
Firmware Upgrade, Activation and International Service User List.
Below shows the menu items for System Maintenance.
Item Description
Model Name Display the model name of the router.
Firmware Version Display the firmware version of the router.
Build Date/Time Display the date and time of the current firmware build.
LAN MAC Address
- Display the MAC address of the LAN Interface.
IP Address
- Display the IP address of the LAN interface.
Subnet Mask
- Display the subnet mask address of the LAN interface.
Item Description
Tr069 Click Enable to activate the settings on this page.
ACS Server On Choose the interface for the router connecting to ACS server.
ACS Server URL/Username/Password – Such data must be typed
according to the ACS (Auto Configuration Server) you want to
link. Please refer to Auto Configuration Server user’s manual
for detailed information.
Wizard – Click it to enter the IP address of VigorACS server,
port number and the handler.
Test With Inform – Click it to send a message based on the
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Administrator Password Old Password - Type in the old password. The factory default
setting for password is “admin”.
New Password -Type in new password in this field. The
length of the password is limited to 23 characters.
Confirm Password -Type in the new password again.
Administrator Local User The administrator can login web user interface of Vigor
router to modify all of the settings to fit the requirements.
This feature allows other user in LAN who can access into the
web user interface with the same privilege of the
administrator.
Local User – Check the box to enable the local user
configuration.
Local User List – It displays the username of the local user.
When you click OK, the login window will appear. Please use the new password to access into
the web user interface again.
Item Description
Enable User Mode for After checking this box, you can access into the web user
simple web configuration interface with the password typed here for simple web
configuration.
The settings on simple web user interface will be different
with full web user interface accessed by using the
administrator password.
Password Type in new password in this field. The length of the
password is limited to 31 characters.
Confirm Password Type in the new password again.
Password Strength Display the security strength of the password specified
above.
Set to Factory Default Click to return to the factory default setting.
When you click OK, the login window will appear. Please use the new password to access into
the web user interface again. Below shows an example for accessing into User Operation with
User Password.
2. Check the box of Enable User Mode for simple web configuration to enable user mode
operation. Type a new password in the field of New Password and click OK.
4. Log out Vigor router web user interface by clicking the Logout button.
5. The following window will be open to ask for username and password. Type the new user
password in the filed of Password and click Login.
Settings to be configured in User Mode will be less than settings in Admin Mode. Only basic
configuration settings will be available in User Mode.
Item Description
Enable Check this box to enable the login customization function.
Login Page Title Type a brief description (e.g., Welcome to DrayTek) which
will be shown on the heading of the login dialog.
Welcome Message and Type words or sentences here. It will be displayed for
Bulletin bulletin message. In addition, it can be displayed on the
login dialog at the bottom.
Note that do not type URL redirect link here.
Preview Click it to display the preview of the login window based on
the settings on this web page.
Set to Factory Default Click to return to the factory default setting.
Below shows an example of login customization with the information typed in Login
Description and Bulletin.
Item Description
Restore Choose File – Click it to specify a file to be restored.
Restore configuration except the login password - If the
password settings shall not be restored and applied to
Vigor2925, simply check this box to get rid of password
settings.
Click Restore to restore the configuration. If the file is
encrypted, the system will ask you to type the password to
decrypt the configuration file.
Backup Click it to perform the configuration backup of this router.
Protect with password- For the sake of security, the
configuration file for the router can be encrypted.
2. Click Backup button to get into the following dialog. Click Save button to open another
dialog for saving configuration as a file.
3. In Save As dialog, the default filename is config.cfg. You could give it another name by
yourself.
Restore Configuration
1. Go to System Maintenance >> Configuration Backup. The following windows will be
popped-up, as shown below.
Item Description
Router Name Display the name for such router configured in System
Maintenance>>Management.
If there is no name here, simply lick the link to access into
System Maintenance>>Management to set the router name.
Server IP Address -The IP address of the Syslog server.
Destination Port - Assign a port for the Syslog protocol.
Mail Syslog – Check the box to recode the mail event on
Syslog.
Enable syslog message - Check the box listed on this web
page to send the corresponding message of firewall, VPN,
User Access, Call, WAN, Router/DSL information to Syslog.
Item Description
Current System Time Click Inquire Time to get the current time.
Use Browser Time Select this option to use the browser time from the remote
administrator PC host as router’s system time.
Use Internet Time Select to inquire time information from Time Server on the
Internet using assigned protocol.
Time Server Type the web site of the time server.
Priority Choose Auto or IPv6 First as the priority.
Time Zone Select the time zone where the router is located.
Enable Daylight Saving Check the box to enable the daylight saving. Such feature is
available for certain area.
Advanced – Click it to open a pop up dialog.
Use the default time setting or set user defined time for your
requirement.
Automatically Update Select a time interval for updating from the NTP server.
Interval
VII-1-9 SNMP
This page allows you to configure settings for SNMP and SNMPV3 services.
The SNMPv3 is more secure than SNMP through the encryption method (support AES and DES)
and authentication method (support MD5 and SHA) for the management needs.
Item Description
Enable SNMP Agent Check it to enable this function.
Get Community Set the name for getting community by typing a proper
character. The default setting is public.
The maximum length of the text is limited to 23 characters.
Set Community Set community by typing a proper name. The default setting
Privacy Password Type a password for privacy. The maximum length of the
text is limited to 23 characters.
For IPv4
Item Description
Router Name Type in the router name provided by ISP.
Default: Disable If it is enabled, the function of auto-logout for web user
Auto-Logout interface will be disabled.
For IPv6
For LAN
Item Description
Allow management from Enable the checkbox to allow system administrators to login
LAN from LAN interface. There are several servers provided by
the system which allow you to manage the router from LAN
interface. Check the box(es) to specify.
Apply To Subnet Check the LAN interface for the administrator to use for
accessing into web user interface of Vigor router.
Index in IP Object- Type the index number of the IP object
profile. Related IP address will appear automatically.
Click Regeneration to open Regenerate Self-Signed Certificate window. Type in all the
information that the window request such as certifcate name (used for identifying different
certificate), subject alternative name type and relational settings for subject name. Then
click GENERATE.
Index (1-15) in Schedule Setup - You can type in four sets of time schedule for performing
system reboot. All the schedules can be set previously in Applications >> Schedule web page
and you can use the number that you have set in that web page.
If you want to reboot the router using the current configuration, check Using current
configuration and click Reboot Now. To reset the router settings to default values, check
Using factory default configuration and click Reboot Now. The router will take 5 seconds to
reboot the system.
Info When the system pops up Reboot System web page after you configure web
settings, please click Reboot Now to reboot your router for ensuring normal
operation and preventing unexpected errors of the router in the future.
Click the button of Check The Latest Firmware to open a pop up window displaying the
newest firmware version released for such Vigor router.
Choose the one you need and click Download. After that, click Select to specify the one you
just download. Then, click Upgrade. The system will upgrade the firmware of the router
automatically.
Item Description
Activate via Interface Choose WAN interface used by such device for activating
Web Content Filter.
Activate The Activate link brings you accessing into
www.vigorpro.com to finish the activation of the account
and the router.
Authentication Message As for authentication information of web filter, the process
of authenticating will be displayed on this field for your
reference.
Item Description
User Name Display the name of the existed user profile. To modify the
detailed settings, simply click the user name link to access
into the web page for modification.
Radius Check the box to turn on the security authentication service
offered by internal RADIUS server for the user profile.
Uncheck the box to turn off ecurity authentication service
offered by internal RADIUS server for the user profile.
If you check the box next to such item, all of the user profiles
listed in this page will be enabled with RADIUS service
enabled vice versa.
Local 802.1X Check the box to turn on the security authentication service
offered by Local 802.1X server for the user profile.
Uncheck the box to turn off ecurity authentication service
offered by Local 802.1X server for the user profile.
If you check the box next to such item, all of the user profiles
listed in this page will be enabled with Local 802.1X service
enabled; vice versa.
Info For the detailed setting (such as IP address, port number) configuration of
internal RADIUS, refer to Applications>>RADIUS/TACACS+.
For the detailed setting (such as IP address, port number) configuration of
Local 802.1X, refer to LAN>>Wired 802.1X and Wireless LAN>>Security.
Sessions Limit
A PC with private IP address can access to the Internet via NAT router. The router will
generate the records of NAT sessions for such connection. The P2P (Peer to Peer) applications
(e.g., BitTorrent) always need many sessions for procession and also they will occupy over
resources which might result in important accesses impacted. To solve the problem, you can
use limit session to limit the session procession for specified Hosts.
Bandwidth Limit
The downstream or upstream from FTP, HTTP or some P2P applications will occupy large of
bandwidth and affect the applications for other programs. Please use Limit Bandwidth to
make the bandwidth usage more efficient.
However, each node may take different attitude toward packets with high priority marking
since it may bind with the business deal of SLA among different DS domain owners. It’s not
easy to achieve deterministic and consistent high-priority QoS traffic throughout the whole
network with merely Vigor router’s effort.
To activate the function of limit session, simply click Enable and set the default session limit.
Available settings are explained as follows:
Item Description
Session Limit Enable - Click this button to activate the function of limit
session.
Disable - Click this button to close the function of limit
session.
Default session limit - Defines the default session number
After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
To activate the function of limit bandwidth, simply click Enable and set the default upstream
and downstream limit.
Available settings are explained as follows:
Item Description
Enable Click this button to activate the function of limit bandwidth.
IP Routed Subnet – Check this box to apply the bandwidth
limit to the second subnet specified in LAN>>General Setup.
It is available for IPv4 settings only.
Default TX limit - Define the default speed of the upstream
for each computer in LAN.
Default RX limit - Define the default speed of the
downstream for each computer in LAN.
Disable Click this button to close the function of limit bandwidth.
Limitation List Display a list of specific limitations that you set on this web
page.
Item Description
General Setup Index – Display the WAN/LTE interface number that you can
edit.
Status – Display if the WAN interface is available for such
function or not.
Bandwidth – Display the inbound and outbound bandwidth
setting for the WAN interface.
Direction – Display which direction that such function will
influence.
Class 1/Class2/Class 3/Others – Display the bandwidth
percentage for each class.
UDP Bandwidth Control –Display the UDP bandwidth control
is enabled or not.
Online Statistics –Display an online statistics for quality of
service for your reference.
Setup – Allow to configure general QoS setting for WAN
interface.
Class Rule Index – Display the class number that you can edit.
Name – Display the name of the class.
Rule – Allow to configure detailed settings for the selected
Class.
Service Type – Allow to configure detailed settings for the
service type.
Enable the First Priority When this feature is enabled, the VoIP SIP/UDP packets will be
for VoIP SIP/RTP sent with highest priority.
SIP UDP Port – Set a port number used for SIP.
Online Statistics
Display an online statistics for quality of service for your reference. This feature is available
only when the Quality of Service for WAN interface is enabled.
Item Description
Enable the QoS Control The factory default for this setting is checked.
Please also define which traffic the QoS Control settings will
apply to.
IN- apply to incoming traffic only.
OUT-apply to outgoing traffic only.
BOTH- apply to both incoming and outgoing traffic.
Check this box and click OK, then click Setup link again. You
will see the Online Statistics link appearing on this page.
WAN Inbound Bandwidth It allows you to set the connecting rate of data input for
other WAN. For example, if your ADSL supports 1M of
downstream and 256K upstream, please set 1000kbps for this
box. The default value is 10000kbps.
WAN Outbound Bandwidth It allows you to set the connecting rate of data output for
other WAN. For example, if your ADSL supports 1M of
downstream and 256K upstream, please set 256kbps for this
box. The default value is 10000kbps.
Reserved Bandwidth Ratio It is reserved for the group index in the form of ratio of
reserved bandwidth to upstream speed and reserved
bandwidth to downstream speed.
Enable UDP Bandwidth Check this and set the limited bandwidth ratio on the right
Control field. This is a protection of TCP application traffic since UDP
application traffic such as streaming video will exhaust lots
of bandwidth.
Outbound TCP ACK The difference in bandwidth between download and upload
Info The rate of outbound/inbound must be smaller than the real bandwidth to
ensure correct calculation of QoS. It is suggested to set the bandwidth value
for inbound/outbound as 80% - 85% of physical network speed provided by
ISP to maximize the QoS performance.
2. After you click the Edit link, you will see the following page. Now you can define the
name for that Class. In this case, “Test” is used as the name of Class Index #1.
Item Description
ACT Check this box to invoke these settings.
Hardware Check this box to enable the hardware acceleration when
Acceleration such rule is applied.
Ethernet Type Please specify which protocol (IPv4 or IPv6) will be used for
this rule.
Local Address Click the Edit button to set the local IP address (on LAN) for
the rule.
Remote Address Click the Edit button to set the remote IP address (on
LAN/WAN) for the rule.
4. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
2. After you click the Edit link, you will see the following page.
Item Description
Service Name Type in a new service for your request. The maximum length
of the name you can set is 11 characters.
Service Type Choose the type (TCP, UDP or TCP/UDP or other) for the new
service.
Port Configuration Type - Click Single or Range as the Type. If you select
Range, you have to type in the starting port number and the
end porting number on the boxes below.
Port Number – Type in the starting port number and the end
porting number here if you choose Range as the type.
5. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
By the way, you can set up to 10 service types. If you want to edit/delete an existed service
type, please select the radio button of that one and click Edit/Edit for modification.
Item Description
Enable/Disable Click Enable to activate APP QoS function.
Click Disable to deactivate APP QoS function.
Traceable The protocol listed below is traceable by Vigor router.
Each tab offers different types of protocols to fit your
request.
Untraceable The protocol listed below is not easy to be traced by Vigor
router.
Each tab offers different types of protocols to fit your
2. You will get the following page. Click the Edit link for Class 1.
3. In the following page, type a name (e.g., VoIP) for such class and click Add.
5. In the pop-up window, choose Range Address as the Address Type and type the start IP
address and end IP address in relational fields. Click OK to save the settings and exit the
window.
8. Do the same steps to add class rules for IPTV and Data/Email with IP addresses as shown
below.
and
10. In the Setup page, check the box of Enable the QoS Control. Type 30, 50 and 15 in the
boxes for VoIP, IPTV and Data/Email respectively. Check the box of Enable UDP
Bandwidth Control.
11. Click OK to save the settings. The class rules for WAN1 are defined as shown below.
2. Click Setup link of WAN(1/2/3/4). Make sure the QoS Control on the left corner is
checked. And select BOTH in Direction.
4. Return to previous page. Enter the Name of Index Class #1 by clicking Edit link. Type the
name “E-mail” for Class 1. Click OK to save the settings.
5. Click the Setup link for WAN2. The user can set reserved bandwidth (e.g., 25%) for
E-mail using protocol POP3 and SMTP. Click OK to save the settings.
6. Return to previous page. Enter the Name of Index Class #2 by clicking Edit link. In this
index, the user will set reserved bandwidth for HTTPS. And click OK.
8. Check Enable UDP Bandwidth Control on the bottom to prevent enormous UDP traffic
influence other application. Click OK.
9. If the worker has connected to the headquarter using host to host VPN tunnel. (Please
refer to Chapter 3 VPN for detail instruction), he may set up an index for it. Enter the
10. Click Edit for Class 3 to open a new window. In this index, the user will set reserved
bandwidth for VPN.
11. Click Add to open the following window. Check the ACT box, first.
User Management is a security feature which disallows any IP traffic (except DHCP-related
packets) from a particular host until that host has correctly supplied a valid username and
password. Instead of managing with IP address/MAC address, User Management function
manages hosts with user account. Network administrator can give different firewall policies
or rules for different hosts with different User Management accounts. This is more flexible
and convenient for network management. Not only offering the basic checking for Internet
access, User Management also provides additional firewall rules, e.g. CSM checking for
protecting hosts.
Info Filter rules configured under Firewall usually are applied to the host (the
one that the router installed) only. With user management, the rules can be
applied to every user connected to the router with customized profiles.
Item Description
Mode There are two modes offered here for you to choose. Each
mode will bring different filtering effect to the users
involved.
User-Based - If you choose such mode, the router will apply
the filter rules configured in User Management>>User
Profile to the users.
Rule-Based –If you choose such mode, the router will apply
the filter rules configured in Firewall>>General Setup and
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
To set the user profile, please click any index number link to open the following page. Notice
that profile 1 (admin) and profile 2 (Dial-In User) are factory default settings. Profile 2 is
reserved for future use.
Item Description
Enable this account Check this box to enable such user profile.
User Name Type a name for such user profile (e.g., LAN_User_Group_1,
WLAN_User_Group_A, WLAN_User_Group_B, etc). When a
user tries to access Internet through this router, an
authentication step must be performed first. The user has to
type the User Name specified here to pass the
authentication. When the user passes the authentication,
he/she can access Internet via this router. However the
accessing operation will be restricted with the conditions
configured in this user profile.
The maximum length of the name you can set is 24
characters.
Password Type a password for such profile (e.g., lug123,
wug123,wug456, etc). When a user tries to access Internet
through this router, an authentication step must be
performed first. The user has to type the password specified
here to pass the authentication. When the user passes the
authentication, he/she can access Internet via this router
with the limitation configured in this user profile.
The maximum length of the password you can set is 24
– Click this box to set and increase the time quota for
such profile.
Enable Data Quota Data Quota means the total amount for data transmission
allowed for the user. The unit is MB/GB.
– Click this box to set and increase the data quota for
such profile.
Local 802.1X Check the box to enable security authenticated via 802.1X
server.
Please click any index number link to open the following page.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this user group.
Available User Objects You can gather user profiles (objects) from User Profile page
within one user group. All the available user objects that you
have created will be shown in this box. Notice that user
object, Admin and Dial-In User are factory settings. User
defined profiles will be numbered with 3, 4, 5 and so on.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Refresh Seconds Use the drop down list to choose the time interval of
refreshing data flow that will be done by the system
automatically.
With User Management authentication function, before a valid username and password have
been correctly supplied, a particular client will not be allowed to access Internet through the
router. There are three ways for authentication: Web, Telnet and Alert Tool.
With Mozilla Firefox, you may get the following warning message. Select I
Understand the Risks.
After that, the web authentication window will appear. Input the user name and the
password for your account (defined in User Management) and click Login.
If the authentication is successful, the client will be redirected to the original web site
that he tried to access. In this example, it is http://www.draytek.com . Furthermore, you
will get a popped up window as the following. Then you can access the Internet.
In above description, you access an external web site to trigger the authentication. You
may also directly access the router’s Web UI for authentication. Both HTTP and HTTPS
are supported, for example http://192.168.1.1 or https://192.168.1.1 . Replace
192.168.1.1 with your router’s real IP address, and add the port number if the default
management port has been modified.
If the authentication is successful, you will get the Welcome Message that is set in the
User Management >> General Setup page.
Also you will get a Tracking Window if you don’t block the pop-up window.
Don’t setup a user profile in User Management and a VPN Remote Dial-in user profile
with the same Username. Otherwise, you may get unexpected result. It is because the
If SSL Tunnel or SSL Web Proxy is disabled in the VPN profile, a User
Management account and a remote dial-in VPN profile can use the same
Username, even with different passwords. However, we recommend you to use
different usernames for different user profiles in User Management and VPN
profiles.
2. Type the password for authentication and press Enter. The message User login
successful will be displayed with the expired time (if configured).
Info Here expired time is “Unlimited” means the Time Quota function is not
enabled for this account. After login, this account will not be expired
until it is logout.
3. In the Web interface of router, the configuration page of Time Quota is shown as below.
You will get the following message. The expired time is shown after you login.
After you run out the available time, you can’t use this account any more until the
administrator manually adds additional time for you.
2. You may get the VigorPro Alert Notice Tool from the following link:
http://www.draytek.com/user/SupportDLUtility.php
Info 1 Any modification to the Firewall policy will break down the
connections of all current users. They all have to authenticate again
for Internet access.
Info 2 The administrator may check the current users from User Online
Status page.
Example 1:Users can see the message for landing page after logging into Internet
successfully
1. Open the web user interface of Vigor2925.
2. Open User Management -> General Setup to get the following page. In the field of
Landing Page, please type the words of “Login Success”. Please note that the
maximum number of characters to be typed here is 255.
3. Now you can enable the Landing Page function. Open User Management -> User Profile
and click one of the index number (e.g., index number 3) links.
5. Open any browser (e.g., FireFox, Internet Explorer). The logging page will appear and
asks for username and password. Please type the correct username and password.
6. Click Login. If the logging is successful, you will see the message of Login Success from
the browser you use.
2. Next, enable the Landing Page function. Open User Management -> User Profile and
click one of the index number (e.g., index number 3) links.
3. In the following page, check the box of Landing page and click OK to save the settings.
5. Click Login. If the logging is successful, you will be directed into the website of
www.draytek.com.
Item Description
Index Click the index number link to view or update the profile
settings.
Enable Check the box to enable the profile.
Comments Shows the description of the profile.
Login Mode Shows the login mode used by the profile. See the section
Login Mode for details.
Skip Login
This mode does not perform any authentication. The user will be redirected to the landing
page. The user can then leave the landing page to visit other websites.
Click-through
The following page will be shown to the users when they first attempt to access the Internet
through the router. After clicking Accept on the page, users will be directed to the landing
page and be granted access to the Internet.
Social Login
The following page will appear when users attempt to access the Internet for the first time
via the router. After authenticating themselves using either a Facebook or Google account,
they will be directed to the landing page and be granted access to the Internet.
1. Login Method
Click the index link (e.g., #1) of the selected profile to display the following page.
Item Description
Enable this profile Check to enable this profile.
Comments Enter a brief description to identify this profile.
Choose Login Select the desired Login Mode.
If you have chosen Skip Login as the Login Mode, skip to step 4 Whitelisting below.
Otherwise, proceed to configure the login page by following steps 2 and 3.
2. Background
If you have selected a Login Mode that requires authentication, select a background for the
login page.
Item Description
Choose Login Select either Color Background or Image Background as the login
If you have selected Skip Login as the Login Mode, proceed to Step 4 Whitelist Setting;
otherwise, continue to Step 3 Login Page Setup.
Click Through
This section describes the Login Page setup if you have selected Click Through as the Login
Mode.
Item Description
Welcome Message Enter the text to be displayed as the welcome message.
Terms and Enter the text to be displayed as the Terms and Conditions
Conditions hyperlink text.
Description
Terms and Enter the text to be displayed in the Terms and Conditions pop-up
Conditions Content window.
Accept Button Enter the text to be displayed on the accept button
Description
Accept Button Color Select the color of the accept button from the predefined color
list, or select Customize Color and enter the RGB value. Click
Preview to preview the selected color.
Save and Next Click to save the configuration on this page and proceed to the
next page.
Cancel Click to abort the configuration process and return to the profile
summary page.
Settings that are common to Facebook, Google and PIN authentication are:
Item Description
Welcome Message Enter the text to be displayed as the welcome message.
Terms and Enter the text to be displayed as the Terms and Conditions
Conditions hyperlink text.
Description
Terms and Enter the text to be displayed in the Terms and Conditions pop-up
Conditions Content window.
Item Description
Facebook Login Enter the text to be displayed on the Facebook login button.
Description
Facebook APP ID Enter a valid Facebook developer app ID.
If you do not already have an app ID, refer to section A-1 How to
create a Facebook App ID for Web Portal Authentication for
instructions on obtaining an APP ID.
Facebook APP Enter the secret configured for the APP ID entered above.
Secret Refer to section A-1 How to create a Facebook App ID for Web
Portal Authentication for details.
Item Description
Google Login Enter the text to be displayed on the Google login button.
Description
Google App ID Enter a valid Google app ID.
If you do not already have an app ID, refer to section A-2 How to
create a Google App ID for Web Portal Authentication for
instructions on obtaining an APP ID.
Google App Secret Enter the secret configured for the APP ID entered above.
Refer to section A-2 How to create a Google APP ID for Web Portal
Authentication for details.
And finally, the save and cancel buttons are always displayed.
Item Description
Back Button Enter text for the label of the hyperlink to return to the previous
Description page.
PIN Code Message Enter text to be displayed as the body text on the page.
Default Country Select the default country code to be displayed using the dropdown
Code menu.
4. Whitelist Setting
In this step you can configure the whitelist settings. Users are allowed to send and receive
traffic that satisfies whitelist settings.
Item Description
NAT Rules To prevent web portal settings from conflicting with NAT rules
resulting in unexpected behavior, select the NAT rules that are
allowed to bypass the web portal. Hosts listed in selected NAT
rules can always access the Internet without being intercepted by
the web portal.
Dest Domain Enter up to 30 destination domains that are allowed to be
accessed.
Dest IP Enter up to 30 destination IP addresses that are allowed to be
accessed.
Dest Port Enter up to 30 destination protocols and ports that are allowed
through the router.
Source IP Enter up to 30 source IP addresses that are allowed through the
router.
5. More Options
In this step you can configure advanced options for the Hotspot Web Portal.
Item Description
Expired Time After Enter the time duration that users are allowed to have Internet
Activation access after logging in.
HTTPS Redirection If this option is selected, unauthenticated clients accessing HTTPS
websites will be redirected to the login page, but the browser may
alert the user of certificate errors. If this option is not selected,
attempts to access to HTTPS website will time out without
redirection.
Captive Portal If this option is selected, the web portal page is triggered
Detection automatically when an unauthenticated client tries to access the
Internet. This function is not available when the Login Mode is
Social Login, as the web portal page may not be shown correctly
due to the limitations of the operating system’s built-in Captive
Portal Detection.
Landing Page After Specifies the webpage that will be displayed after the user has
Authentication successfully authenticated.
Fixed URL – The user will be redirected to the specified URL. This
could be used for displaying advertisements to users, such as
guests requesting wireless Internet access in a hotel.
User Requested URL – The user will be redirected to the URL they
initially requested.
Bulletin Message –The message configured here will be briefly
shown for a few seconds to the user.
Default Message – This button is enabled when Bulletin Message is
selected. Click to load the default text into the bulletin message
textbox.
Applied Interfaces Subnet – The current Hotspot Web Portal profile will be in effect
for the selected subnets.
WLAN – The current Hotspot Web Portal profile will be in effect for
the selected WLAN SSIDs.
Cancel Click to abort the configuration process and return to the profile
summary page.
Finish Click to complete the configuration.
Item Description
Select Columns to Simply specify the profile and the login method for filtering users
Filter Users who want to access Internet through the login method. It is useful
for system administrator to manage the user’s access based on
different conditions when there are a lot of users requiring to
access into Internet.
User Table Information for the users accessing into Internet via Hotsport Web
Portal will be displayed and recorded in this page.
Click the MAC address link for certain user, information page related to the selected device
will be shown as the following page.
Item Description
Enable database to Check the box to record user information on router’s database.
record user Before checking this box, insert a USB disk with adequate storage
information space, first.
File Path If a USB disk has been inserted into the USB port of Vigor router,
the file path will be shown in this area.
Database Usage Display the usage and remaining space on the database.
Clear User Info – The user information will be displayed on the
page of User Info. You can delete the information by clicking this
button.
Notification and Action when Storage Exceeded
Notification Don’t send notification – Vigor router system will not send any
notification to any receipient.
Send notification - Vigor router system will not send a notification
e-mail to specified receipient(s) that selected from Email
Notification Object and SMS Notification Object.
Action Stop recording user information – Vigor router system will stop to
record the user information onto USB disk.
Backup and clean up all user info, and start a new record – Vigor
router system will backup all existed information on the USB disk
onto the host and clean up the information from USB disk. Later, it
will start a new record.
5. Choose country then type phone number, click Send as Text in Get Confirmation Code.
Wait confirmation code message received then enter the confirmation code. Click
Register to finish the register process.
7. Click Skip and Create App ID on first use. Type Display Name. Choose Category. Click
Create App ID.
12. Enter the Site URL as http://portal.draytek.com. (Note: If you change http port in the
vigor, please add http port in URLs. For example, we use 8080 as http port and we'll
put http://portal.draytek.com:8080). Enter the Contact Email. And click Save Change.
14. Go to My Apps>>Status & Review, and switch available status to YES to activate the APP.
3. Edit Auth Consent screen. Go to Credentials > Auth consent screen. Enter your email,
product name and other optional item then click on Save.
5. Choose Web application as Application Type, then enter name. Set Authorized
JavaScript origins and Authorized redirect URLs as http://portal.draytek.com, and
click Create. (Note: If you change http port in the vigor, please add http port in URLs. For
example, we use 8080 as http port and we'll put http://portal.draytek.com:8080).
6. Get client ID and client secret. Such information will be used in Vigor Router's Web Portal
Setup page.
Vigor2925 can build virtual private network (VPN) between itself and any other TR-069 CPE by
the function of central VPN management. In addition, it can be treated as a server (called
CVM server) which can manage TR-069 CPE for periodical firmware upgrade, configuration
backup and restoring configuration.
Item Description
CVM SSL Port Check the box to enable the port setting.
Type the port number in the box.
CVM Port Check the box to enable the port setting.
Type the port number in the box.
CVM WAN Interface For Vigor router can manage only the client from WAN
interface, therefore you have to specify which interface will
be used for such function. If you choose MANUALLY, you have
to specify WAN IP address.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
IPsec Mode Choose Aggressive or Main as the IPsec Mode.
Security Method Choose one of the following methods (AH or ESP) for the
security of data transmission. For example, choose AH to
specify the IPsec protocol for the Authentication Header
protocol. The data will be authenticated but not be
encrypted.
Encryption Type Choose one of the selections as the encryption type.
Local Subnet Type the IP address and subnet mask of local host.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Managed Devices List This area displays device icons (up to 8) for the CPE managed
by Vigor2925 series.
Edit – To modify the name and location of specific CPE, click
the one you want and click the Edit button. A pop up window
will appear. Simply change the name and/or location
manually.
Item Description
Refresh Click it to refresh current page.
USB Disk
- It means a USB disk connecting to
Vigor2925.
- When there is no
USB disk connecting to Vigor2925, such message will be
displayed in this field.
Click the icon to see the content inside the USB disk.
Item Description
Profile Name Type the name of the maintenance profile.
Enable Check it to enable such profile.
Only Run Once Check it to activate such profile running for once.
Device Name The drop down list will display all the CPE devices detected by
Vigor2925 series. Choose the one which will be applied with
such new created profile.
Router Name / It displays the name and model of Vigor router.
Router Model
Item Description
CPE VPN Connection List
VPN Display the name of the LAN-to-LAN profile.
It is generated automatically when you click the
PPTP/IPsec/Advanced button to build the VPN connection
between Vigor2925 and remote CPE.
Type Display the dial-in type and the authentication method.
Remote IP Display the IP address of the remote CPE and the interface.
Virtual Network Display the IP address and subnet mask of Vigor2925 series.
Tx Pkts Display the number of the transmitted packets.
Tx Rate(Bps) Display the number of the transmitted rate.
Rx Pkts Display the number of the received packets.
Rx Rate(Bps) Display the number of the received rate.
Up Time Display the connection time of such VPN.
Once the device is managed (controlled) by Vigor2925 series, it will be displayed on such
screen automatically. If not, refer to sections “How to manage the CPE (router) through
Vigor2925?” for more detailed information.
Item Description
Display Mode Choose the mode you want to display the related information
on the following table.
Stop record when fulls – when the capacity of CVM log is
full, the system will stop recording.
Always record the new event – only the newest events
will be recorded by the system.
Device Name Display the name of the managed CPE.
Description Name Display the brief explanation for the managed CPE.
Time & date Display the time and date that the managed CPE scanned by
Vigor2925 series.
Action Type Display the action that Vigor2925 series will perform for the
managed CPE.
Message Display the information for each event.
The Alert page offers brief information to identify the CPE connected to Vigor2925 series.
A-1 CVM Application - How to manage the CPE (router) through Vigor2925
series?
To manage CPEs through Vigor2925 series, you have to set URL on CPE first and set username
and password for Vigor2925 series. For this section, we use Vigor2850 series as the example.
All the CPE configuration will be done through Vigor2850 series.
3. In the following page, check the boxes for CVM Port and CVM SSL Port to enable the port
setting. Type the values for CVM Port, CVM SSL Port, Username, and Password
respectively. Remember the values configured in this page.
3. In the field of ACS Server, type the URL (IP address with port number) of Vigor2925
series and type the same Username and Password defined on the page of Central VPN
Management>>General Setup in Vigor2925 series. Then, click Enable for CPE Client and
then click OK to save the settings.
6. Open WAN>>Internet Access. Use the drop down list of Access Mode on WAN1 to select
MPoA (RFC1483/2684). Then, click Details Page.
7. Click Specify an IP address. Type correct WAN IP address, subnet mask and gateway IP
address for your CPE. Then click OK.
4. The selected CPE will be moved and displayed on Managed Devices List which means it is
controlled / managed by Vigor2925 series from now on.
3. Click the device icon (marked with ) and click the PPTP/IPsec button.
4. Wait for a moment. If VPN is built successfully, related information will be displayed on
CPE VPN Connection List.
Note: The profile name is created automatically by the system. Do not modify any value in
such page to avoid VPN error.
In the field of Profile Name, type a name for such maintenance profile; check Enable;
and choose the one you want to perform firmware upgrade from Device Name drop down
list. From the Action Type, choose Firmware Upgrade. Type the file/path of the newest
firmware or click Select to locate it. Specify the Schedule profile. At last, click OK.
5. Now, a new maintenance profile has been created.
Click the icon of Vigor2850 and click Edit and view the software version. Another way to
check if the firmware upgrade is completed or not, simply open Central VPN
Management>>Log & Alert.
Vigor2925 can manage the access points supporting AP management via Central AP
Management.
AP Map
AP Map is helpful to determine the best location for VigorAP in a room. A floor plan of a room
is required to be uploaded first. By dragging and dropping available VigorAP icon from the list
to the floor plan, the placement with the best wireless coverage will be clearly indicated
through simulated signal strength
AP Maintenance
Vigor router can execute configuration backup, configuration restoration, firmware upgrade
and remote reboot for the APs managed by the router. It is very convenient for the
administrator to process maintenance without accessing into the web user interface of the
access point.
VII-6-1 Dashboard
This page shows VigorAP’s information about Status, Event Log, Total Traffic or Station
Number by displaying VigorAP icon, text and histogram. Just move and click your mouse
cursor on Status, Event Log, Total Traffic or Station Number. Corresponding web pages will
be open immediately.
VII-6-2 Status
This page displays current status (online, offline or SSID hidden, IP address, encryption,
channel, version, password and etc.) of the access points managed by Vigor router. Please
open Central AP Management>>Function Support List to check what AP Models are
supported.
Item Description
Index Click the index number link for viewing the settings summary
of the access point.
Device Name The name of the AP managed by Vigor router will be displayed
here.
IP Address Display the true IP address of the access point.
SSID Display the SSID configured for the access point(s) connected
to Vigor2925.
Ch. Display the channel used by the access point.
STA List Display the number of wireless clients (stations) connecting to
the access point.
In which, 0/64 means that up to 64 clients are allowed to
connect to the access point. But, now no one connects to the
access point.
The number displayed on the left side means 2.4GHz; and the
number displayed on the right side means 5GHz.
AP List Display the number of the AP around the device.
Uptime Display the duration of the AP powered up.
Version Display the firmware version used by the access point.
Password Vigor2925 can get related information of the access point by
accessing into the web user interface of the access point.
This button is used to modify the logging password of the
connected access point.
Click the number link of the selected profile to modify the content of the profile. Available
settings are explained as follows:
Item Description
Name Display the name of the profile.
The default profile cannot be renamed.
Main SSID Display the SSID configured by such wireless profile.
Security Display the security mode selected by such wireless profile.
Multi-SSID Enable means multiple SSIDs (more than one) are active.
Disable means only SSID1 is active.
WLAN ACL Display the name of the access control list.
Rate Control Display the upload and/or download transmission rate.
Clone It can copy settings from an existing WLAN profile to another
WLAN profile.
First, you have to check the box of the existing profile as the
original profile. Second, click Clone. The following dialog will
appear.
Third, choose the profile index to accept the settings from the
original profile. Forth, type a new name in the field of
Renamed as. Last, click Apply to save the settings on this
dialog.
The new profile has been created with the settings coming
from the original profile.
To AP Click it to apply the selected wireless profile to the specified
Access Point.
3. After finished the general settings configuration, click Next to open the following page
for 2.4G wireless security settings.
5. When you finished the above web page configuration, click Finish to exit and return to
the first page. The modified WLAN profile will be shown on the web page.
Info Config Backup can be performed to one AP at one time. Others functions
(e.g., Config Restore, Firmware Upgrade, Remote Reboot can be performed
to more than one AP at one time by using Vigor2925.
Item Description
Action There are four actions provided by Vigor router to manage the
access points.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to perform the action.
VII-6-5 AP Map
This function is helpful to determine the best location for VigorAP in a room. A floor plan of a
room is required to be uploaded first. By dragging and dropping available VigorAP icon from
the list to the floor plan, the placement with the best wireless coverage will be clearly
indicated through simulated signal strength.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Click the link to clear current page configuration.
Profile Click the link to to view or edit the AP Map.
Location Display a brief description (e.g., ground, roof) of the AP Map.
Online APs Display the number of VigorAP configured and powered up.
Total APs Display the total number of VigorAP configured.
Clients Display the number of clients accessing Internet through the
VigorAP.
Dimension(m) Display the width and length of the AP map.
View Click it to review the layout for the selected AP map.
Item Description
Location (Profile Name) Type a name (e.g., groudfloor) for the AP map profile.
Upload Map Click the Select button to choose an image file (only JPG,
GIF and PNG are supported) for floor plan.
Cancel Click it to cancel the configuration.
Next Click it to go to the next configuration page.
2. Click Next. In the web page of Dimension, set dimension for the map.
The values for length and width will be displayed on the web page.
4. Click Next to open the web page of Planning. Available APs detected by Vigor router will
be displayed on the upper end.
6. Check the box of Show AP Coverage and choose 2.4GHz or 5GHz of wireless signal for the
AP located on the floor plan.
The horizontal axis represents time; the vertical axis represents the transmission rate (in
kbps).
Item Description
Enable Neighbor AP Detection – The access point(s) registered to
Vigor2925 will be used to detect other access points and send
Refresh Min(s) Use the drop down list to specify the time to refresh the web
page.
Refresh Click such link to refresh the web page immediately.
Ch Display the channel used by the detected access point.
SSID Display the SSID specified for the detected access point.
Mode Display the mode (AP or Ad Hoc) used by the detected access
point.
BSSID Display the MAC address of the detected access point.
Security Display the encryption mode used by the access point.
Signal (%) Display the signal strength (represented by percentage) sent
by the access point.
Beacon Period Display the period (time) of the beacon. The beacon signal will
be sent out periodically.
Last Detected Display the date and time that such access point was detected
by Vigor router.
All the APs detected by Vigor router will be treated as unknown APs. You have to specify
which AP is friendly and which one is Rogue respectively. Follow the steps below to perform
the classification of access points.
1. Click the radio button on one of the access points. In this case, DrayTek-LAN-A is
selected.
Item Description
AP’s MAC Address The MAC address of the selected AP will be displayed here
automatically.
AP’s SSID The SSID of the selected AP will be displayed here
automatically.
Add to Friendly APs - If the selected AP shall be treated as Friendly
AP, simply click Add to change its classification from unknown
to Friendly.
Rogue APs - If the selected AP shall be treated as rogue AP,
simply click Add to change its classification from unknown to
Rogue.
Delete From Rogue APs - If you want to change the classification of the
rogue AP, simply choose the one and click Delete. Later, the
page will refresh and the one will be classified as Unknown.
Friendly APs - If you want to change the classification of the
friendly AP, simply choose the one and click Delete. Later, the
page will refresh and the one will be classified as Unknown.
Item Description
AP Load Balance It is used to determine the operation mode when the system
detects overload between access points.
Disable – Disable the function of AP load balance.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
In this case, a device named with AP800_00507F6EE4980 has been detected by Vigor
router.
2. Click the WLAN Profile tab to get the following page. Check the box of the default
profile to make the Edit button be available. Then, click the Edit button.
3. When the following configuration page appears, make the changes you want and check
Apply to All APs. Then, click Next to access into the next page.
4. The following page allows you to modify related settings for 2.4G SSID of managed AP.
Make the changes you want for 2.4G SSID. Click Next for next page.
VII-7-1 Status
Item Description
Group Display the name link of the group.
You can click the link to modify the group settings if
required.
Switch Name Display the name link of VigorSwitch.
You can click the name link to access into the switch profile.
IP Address Display the IP address of VigorSwitch.
Model Display the model name of VigorSwitch.
System Up Time Display the time accumulated since this Vigorwitch is
powered up.
Port in Use Display how many devices connected to VigorSwitch.
Clients Display the number of LAN ports used in VigorSwitch.
Firmware Version Display the firmware version that VigorSwitch current used.
Add New Such button will appear only when there is more than one
switch connected to Vigor2925.
The one under New Switch List is allowed to be managed
under current used group. Simply click Add New.
Please note that, Shutdown Port is available for LAN port of VigorSwitch connects to a LAN
device. When it is checked, after clicking OK, the network connection between that device
and VigorSwitch will be terminated.
Item Description
Index Click the number link to access into the switch profile.
Note: Each connected VigorSwitch will have one setting
profile. If there are many switches connected to Vigor2925,
different index number will be used to represent different
VigorSwitch.
Name Display the user defined name of VigorSwitch.
Group Display the group name of VigorSwitch(es).
IP Address Display the IP address of VigorSwitch.
MAC Address Display the MAC address of VigorSwitch.
Model Display the model name of VigorSwitch.
Password Click it to display the account information including
username and password.
Delete Profile Click the mark of “X” to delete the switch profile.
2. After finished the settings, click VLAN tab to open following page.
Blank page due to LAN>>VLAN not configured previously:
3. Click OK to save VLAN configuration. Then, click Port tab to access the following page:
Item Description
Description If required, type a brief description to explain the device
connected to VigorSwitch via the LAN port.
Shutdown Port Shutdown – The port (e.g, Port 10 in this case) which is used
to connect VigorSwitch and Vigor2925 will not be shutdown
by Vigor2925 series.
Other LAN ports of VigorSwitch allow to connect to any LAN
device. When it is checked, after clicking OK, the network
connection between that device and VigorSwitch will be
terminated.
Schedule – Two sechule profiles can be specified here to
force Vigor2925 executing specific action to VigorSwitch.
4. Click OK to save the changes and then click Send to Device. Settings will be sent to
VigorSwitch immediately.
VII-7-3 Group
Different switches can be classified into different group(s). Specifc password for a group can
be defined and applied to every switch uder that group.
Through the common password setting, it is not necessary for the system administrator to
remember various login passwords to access into different VigorSwitch devices.
Item Description
Group Name Type a name as the group name. Different switches can be
classified within a group.
Group Password Type a password that administrator can use to access into
the managed VigorSwitch connecting to Vigor2925 series. All
of the switches under the same group can be accessed into
via such group password.
Existing Switch Display all of the VigorSwitch devices connecting to
Vigor2925.
Member Switch Choose the switches you want to group and click the button
“>>” to move the selected devices onto the field of Member
Switch. Devices under Member Switch will be grouped under
such group profile.
OK Click it to save the configuration.
Cancel Click it to exit the setting page without saving any change.
Item Description
Selection Action Action Type – Four actions including configuration backup,
configuration restore, remote reboot and factory reset are
offered by Vigor2925 to perform on VigorSwitch.
Item Description
Item Description
Switch Alert Enable – Check it to enable alert mechanism for VigorSwitch.
Port Alert Enable - Check it to enable alert mechanism for each port of
VigorSwitch.
Click the Switch Name link (e.g., G2260 in this case) to get detailed settings.
Item Description
Switch Alert When VigorSwitch encounters the following alert events,
alert mechanism will perform corresponding actions based
on the servity level of the incident encountererd.
Incident – At present, Cold Start, Warm Start, Disconnect
and Reconnect will be treated as alert events.
Level – Specify the severity level for each incident. To
defined more severity level for choosing in this page, simply
open Central Management>>Switch>>Alert and Log and
click Alert Setup.
Port Alert Port – Available Ethernet ports for the selected VigorSwitch
(e.g., G2260 in this case) will be shown on this page. Each
port can be confgiured with different alert level for diffent
alert event.
Item Description
Select Columns to Filter Level – The alert can be divided into four levels, No Alert,
Logs Minor Alert, Moderate Alert and Major Alert. Check the
one(s) you want to check in Alert Logs list.
Type – Check the type (switch / port) of the log to be
displayed in Alert Logs list.
Switch – Switch(es) connecting to Vigor router will be shown
in this area. Click the one you need.
OK – Click it to save the configuration.
Log related to the items selected above will be shown in
Alert Logs list.
Alert Logs This area displays logs (level name, time, type, switch, port,
and incident) related to VigorSwitch managed by Vigor
router.
Item Description
Enable Database to Record Check the box to make the database (in USB disk) to record
alert logs and traffic the alert logs and traffic history.
history
Notification and Action when Storage Exceeded
Notification Don’t send notification – No notification will be sent out
when there is no capacity for storage in USB.
Send notification – A notification will be sent out when there
is no capacity for storage in USB.
Action Stop recording user information – When the capacity of log
is full, the system will stop recording.
Backup and clean up all user infor, and start a new record
- Only the newest events will be recorded by the system.
Vigor router can be used to connect with many types of external devices. In order to control
or manage the external devices conveniently, open External Devices to make detailed
configuration.
Item Description
External Device Syslog Check this box to display information of the detected device
on Syslog.
External Device Auto Check this box to detect the external device automatically
Discovery and display on this page.
From this web page, check the box of External Device Auto Discovery. Later, all the
available devices will be displayed in this page with icons and corresponding information. You
can change the device name if required or remove the information for off-line device
whenever you want.
Define objects such as IP address, service type, keyword, file extension and others. These
pre-defined objects can be applied in CSM.
VIII-1-1 IP Object
For IPs in a range and service ports in a limited range usually will be applied in configuring
router’s settings, therefore we can define them with objects and bind them with groups for
using conveniently. Later, we can select that object/group that can apply it. For example, all
the IPs in the same department can be defined with an IP object (a range of IP address).
You can set up to 192 sets of IP Objects with different conditions.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this profile. Maximum 15 characters are
MAC Address Type the MAC address of the network card which will be
controlled.
Start IP Address Type the start IP address for Single Address type.
End IP Address Type the end IP address if the Range Address type is
selected.
Subnet Mask Type the subnet mask if the Subnet Address type is selected.
Invert Selection If it is checked, all the IP addresses except the ones listed
above will be applied later while it is chosen.
4. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration. Below is
an example of IP objects settings.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the group profile.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this profile. Maximum 15 characters are
allowed.
Interface Choose WAN, LAN or Any to display all the available IP
objects with the specified interface.
Available IP Objects All the available IP objects with the specified interface
chosen above will be shown in this box.
Selected IP Objects Click >> button to add the selected IP objects in this box.
3. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the object profile.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this profile. Maximum 15 characters are
allowed.
Address Type Determine the address type for the IPv6 address.
Select Single Address if this object contains one IPv6 address
only.
Select Range Address if this object contains several IPv6s
within a range.
Select Subnet Address if this object contains one subnet for
IPv6 address.
Select Any Address if this object contains any IPv6 address.
Select Mac Address if this object contains Mac address.
Mac Address Type the MAC address of the network card which will be
controlled.
Start IP Address Type the start IP address for Single Address type.
End IP Address Type the end IP address if the Range Address type is
selected.
Prefix Length Type the number (e.g., 64) for the prefix length of IPv6
address.
Invert Selection If it is checked, all the IPv6 addresses except the ones listed
above will be applied later while it is chosen.
3. After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the group profile.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this profile. Maximum 15 characters are
allowed.
Available IPv6 All the available IPv6 objects with the specified interface
Objects chosen above will be shown in this box.
Selected IPv6 Objects Click >> button to add the selected IPv6 objects in this box.
3. After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the object profile.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this profile. Maximum 15 characters are
allowed.
Protocol Specify the protocol(s) which this profile will apply to.
Source/Destination Source Port and the Destination Port columns are available
Port for TCP/UDP protocol. It can be ignored for other protocols.
The filter rule will filter out any port number.
(=) – when the first and last value are the same, it indicates
one port; when the first and last values are different, it
indicates a range for the port and available for this profile.
(!=) – when the first and last value are the same, it indicates
all the ports except the port defined here; when the first and
last values are different, it indicates that all the ports
except the range defined here are available for this service
type.
(>) – the port number greater than this value is available.
(<) – the port number less than this value is available for this
profile.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the group profile.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this profile. Maximum 15 characters are
allowed.
Available Service All the available service objects that you have added on
Type Objects Objects Setting>>Service Type Object will be shown in this
box.
Selected Service Type Click >> button to add the selected IP objects in this box.
Objects
3. After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the object profile.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this profile, e.g., game. Maximum 15
characters are allowed.
Contents Type the content for such profile. For example, type
gambling as Contents. When you browse the webpage, the
page with gambling information will be watched out and be
passed/blocked based on the configuration on Firewall
settings.
3. After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the group profile.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this group. Maximum 15 characters are
allowed.
Available Keyword You can gather keyword objects from Keyword Object page
Objects within one keyword group. All the available Keyword
objects that you have created will be shown in this box.
Selected Keyword
Objects Click button to add the selected Keyword objects in
this box.
3. After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the object profile.
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for this profile. The maximum length of the
name you can set is 7 characters.
3. Type a name for such profile and check all the items of file extension that will be
processed in the router. Finally, click OK to save this profile.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all of the settings and return to factory default
settings.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Profile Display the name for such SMS profile.
SMS Provider Display the service provider which offers SMS service.
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for such SMS profile. The maximum length of
the name you can set is 31 characters.
Service Provider Use the drop down list to specify the service provider which
offers SMS service.
Username Type a user name that the sender can use to register to
selected SMS provider.
The maximum length of the name you can set is 31
characters.
Password Type a password that the sender can use to register to
selected SMS provider.
The maximum length of the password you can set is 31
characters.
Quota Type the number of the credit that you purchase from the
service provider chosen above.
Note that one credit equals to one SMS text message on the
standard route.
Sending Interval To avoid quota being exhausted soon, type time interval for
sending the SMS.
3. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
You can click the number (e.g., #9) under Index column for configuration in details.
Item Description
Profile Name Display the name of this profile. It cannot be modified.
Service Provider Type the website of the service provider.
Type the URL string in the box under the filed of Service
Provider. You have to contact your SMS provider to obtain
the exact URL string.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all of the settings and return to factory default
settings.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Profile Display the name for such mail server profile.
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for such mail service profile. The maximum
length of the name you can set is 31 characters.
SMTP Server Type the IP address of the mail server.
SMTP Port Type the port number for SMTP server.
Sender Address Type the e-mail address of the sender.
Use SSL Check this box to use port 465 for SMTP server for some
e-mail server uses https as the transmission method.
Authentication The mail server must be authenticated with the correct
username and password to have the right of sending message
out. Check the box to enable the function.
Username – Type a name for authentication. The maximum
length of the name you can set is 31 characters.
Password – Type a password for authentication. The
maximum length of the password you can set is 31
characters.
3. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for such notification profile. The maximum
length of the name you can set is 15 characters.
Category Display the types that will be monitored.
Status Display the status for the category. You can check the box to
be monitored.
For example, the check box of CPE firmware upgrade fail
under the category of Central VPN Management is checked.
Once such profile is enabled, Vigor router system will send
out notification to the recipient via SMS.
3. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Add Click it to open the following page for adding a new string
object.
Set to Factory Default Click it to clear all of the settings in this page.
Index Display the number link of the string profile.
String Display the string defined.
Clear Choose the string that you want to remove. Then click this
check box to delete the selected string.
The country object, by grouping IP addresses for multiple countries, can be applied by other
functions such as router policy destination (refer to the following figure for example).
Item Description
Name Type a name for such profile. The maximum length of the
name you can set is 15 characters.
Countries Check the box(es) for the country/countries to be blocked by
Firewall.
Note that one country profile can contain 1 up to 16
countries.
3. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
A-1 How to Send a Notification to Specified Phone Number via SMS Service in
WAN Disconnection
Follow the steps listed below:
1. Log into the web user interface of Vigor router.
2. Configure relational objects first. Open Object Settings>>SMS/Mail Server Object to
get the following page.
Index 1 to Index 8 allows you to choose the built-in SMS service provider. If the SMS
service provider is not on the list, you can configure Index 9 and Index 10 to add the new
service provider to Vigor router.
3. Choose any index number (e.g., Index 1 in this case) to configure the SMS Provider
setting. In the following page, type the username and password and set the quota that
the router can send the message out.
6. Choose any index number (e.g., Index 1 in this case) to configure conditions for sending
the SMS. In the following page, type the name of the profile and check the Disconnected
and Reconnected boxes for WAN to work in concert with the topic of this paper.
8. Now, open Application >> SMS / Mail Alert Service. Use the drop down list to choose
SMS Provider and the Notify Profile (specify the time of sending SMS). Then, type the
phone number in the field of Recipient (the one who will receive the SMS).
9. Click OK to save the settings. Later, if one of the WAN connections fails in your router,
the system will send out SMS to the phone number specified. If the router has only one
WAN interface, the system will send out SMS to the phone number while reconnecting
the WAN interface successfully.
USB device connected on Vigor router can be regarded as a server or WAN interface. By way of
Vigor router, clients on LAN can access, write and read data stored in USB storage disk with
different applications. After setting the configuration in USB Application, you can type the IP
address of the Vigor router and username/password created in USB Application>>USB User
Management on the client software. Then, the client can use the FTP site (USB storage disk)
or share the SMB service through Vigor router.
Info USB ports on Vigor router are allowed to connect to USB modem. Models of
the modems supported by Vigor router can be seen from USB
Application>>Modem Support List. For network connection via USB
modem, refer to WAN>>Internet Access and WAN>>General Setup for
detailed information.
Item Description
General Settings Simultaneous FTP Connections - This field is used to specify
the quantity of the FTP sessions. The router allows up to 6
FTP sessions connecting to USB storage disk at one time.
Default Charset - At present, Vigor router supports four
types of character sets. Default Charset is for English based
file name.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
FTP/SMB User Enable – Click this button to activate this profile (account)
for FTP service or SMB User service. Later, the user can use
the username specified in this page to login into FTP server.
Disable – Click this button to disable such profile.
Username Type the username for FTP/SMB users for accessing into FTP
server (USB storage disk). Be aware that users cannot access
into USB storage disk in anonymity. Later, you can open FTP
client software and type the username specified here for
accessing into USB storage disk. The length of the name is
limited to 11 characters.
Note: “Admin” could not be typed here as username, for the
word is specified for accessing into web pages of Vigor router
only. Also, it is reserved for FTP firmware upgrade usage.
Note: FTP Passive mode is not supported by Vigor Router.
Please disable the mode on the FTP client.
Password Type the password for FTP/SMB users for accessing FTP
server. Later, you can open FTP client software and type the
password specified here for accessing into USB storage disk.
The length of the password is limited to 11 characters.
Confirm Password Type the password again to make confirmation.
Home Folder It determines the folder for the client to access into.
The user can enter a directory name in this field. Then, after
clicking OK, the router will create the specific/new folder in
the USB storage disk. In addition, if the user types “/” here,
he/she can access into all of the disk folders and files in USB
storage disk.
Note: When write protect status for the USB storage disk is
ON, you cannot type any new folder name in this field. Only
“/” can be used in such case.
Before you click OK, you have to insert a USB storage disk into the USB interface of the Vigor
router. Otherwise, you cannot save the configuration.
Item Description
Click this icon to refresh files list.
Refresh
Click this icon to return to the upper directory.
Back
Click this icon to add a new folder.
Create
Current Path Display current folder.
Item Description
Connection Status If there is no USB device connected to Vigor router, “No Disk
Connected” will be shown here.
Disk Capacity It displays the total capacity of the USB storage disk.
Free Capacity It displays the free space of the USB storage disk. Click
Refresh at any time to get new status for free capacity.
Index It displays the number of the client which connects to FTP
server.
IP Address It displays the IP address of the user’s host which connects to
the FTP server.
Username It displays the username that user uses to login to the FTP
server.
When you insert USB device into the Vigor router, the system will start to find out such device
within several seconds.
Item Description
Display Settings Temperature Calibration - Type a value used for
correcting the temperature error.
Temperature Unit - Choose the display unit of the
temperature. There are two types for you to choose.
Alarm Settings Enable Syslog Alarm - The temperature log will be
recorded on Syslog if it is enabled.
Upper temperature limit/Lower temperature limit - Type
the upper limit and lower limit for the system to send out
temperature alert.
Temperature Chart
Below shows an example of temperature graph:
A-1 How can I get the files from USB storage device connecting to Vigor
router?
Files on USB storage device can be reviewed by opening USB Applicaiton>>File Explorer. If it
is necessary for you to delete, copy files on the device or write, paste files to the devcie, it
must be done through SMB server or FTP server.
SMB service is based on the original USB FTP service. You will need to setup USB FTP first. We
would like to give brief instructions on USB FTP setup here.
1. Plug the USB device to the USB port on the router. Make sure Disk Connected appears on
the Connection Status as the figure shown below:
2. Then, please open USB Application >> USB General Settings to enable SMB service.
5. Make sure the FTP service is running properly. Please open a browser and type
ftp://192.168.1.1. Use the account "user1" to login.
7. Return to USB Application >> USB Disk Status. The information for FTP server will be
shown as below.
Now, users in LAN of Vigor2925 can access into the USB storage device by typing
ftp://192.168.1.1 on any browser. They can add or remove files / directories,
depending on the Access Rule for FTP account settings in USB Application >>USB User
Management.
This section will guide you to solve abnormal situations if you cannot access into the Internet
after installing the router and finishing the web configuration. Please follow sections below to
check your basic installation status stage by stage.
Checking if the hardware status is OK or not.
Checking if the network connection settings on your computer are OK or not.
Pinging the router from your computer.
Checking if the ISP settings are OK or not.
Backing to factory default setting if necessary.
If all above stages are done and the router still cannot run normally, it is the time for you to
contact your dealer or DrayTek technical support for advanced help.
Item Description
Decoded Format It shows the source IP address (local), destination IP
(remote) address, the protocol and length of the package.
Refresh Click it to reload the page.
Item Description
Refresh Click it to reload the page.
Item Description
Show Specify LAN and VLAN to display related information.
In default, this page will display all of the information
about LAN and VLAN.
Refresh Click it to reload the page.
Item Description
Refresh Click it to reload the page.
Item Description
Index It displays the connection item number.
IP Address It displays the IP address assigned by this router for specified
PC.
MAC Address It displays the MAC address for the specified PC that DHCP
assigned IP address for it.
Leased Time It displays the leased time of the specified PC.
HOST ID It displays the host ID name of the specified PC.
Refresh Click it to reload the page.
Item Description
Private IP:Port It indicates the source IP address and port of local PC.
#Pseudo Port It indicates the temporary port of the router used for NAT.
Peer IP:Port It indicates the destination IP address and port of remote
host.
Interface It displays the representing number for different interface.
Refresh Click it to reload the page.
Item Description
Clear Click this link to remove the result on the window.
Refresh Click it to reload the page.
When an entry’s TTL is Check the box the type the value of TTL (time to live) for
larger than…. each entry. Click OK to enable such function.
It means when the TTL value of each DNS query reaches the
threshold of the value specified here, the corresponding
record will be deleted from router’s Cache automatically.
or
Item Description
IPV4 /IPV6 Choose the interface for such function.
Ping through Use the drop down list to choose the WAN/LTE interface that
Click Diagnostics and click Data Flow Monitor to open the web page. You can click IP Address,
TX rate, RX rate or Session link for arranging the data display.
Item Description
Enable Data Flow Monitor Check this box to enable this function.
Refresh Seconds Use the drop down list to choose the time interval of
refreshing data flow that will be done by the system
automatically.
APP QoS Use the drop down list to change the priority in data
transmission for the specified IP address (host).
Current /Peak/Speed Current means current transmission rate and receiving rate
for WAN interface.
Peak means the highest peak value detected by the router in
data transmission.
Speed means line speed specified in WAN>>General Setup.
If you do not specify any rate at that page, here will display
Auto for instead.
The horizontal axis represents time. Yet the vertical axis has different meanings. For
WAN1/WAN2/WAN3/LTE/WAN4 Bandwidth chart, the numbers displayed on vertical axis
represent the numbers of the transmitted and received packets in the past.
For Sessions chart, the numbers displayed on vertical axis represent the numbers of the NAT
sessions during the past.
or
Item Description
IPv4 / IPv6 Click one of them to display corresponding information for it.
Trace through Use the drop down list to choose the interface that you want
to ping through.
Item Description
Enable Web Syslog Check this box to enable the function of Web Syslog.
Syslog Type Use the drop down list to specify a type of Syslog to be
displayed.
Item Description
Time Display the time of the event occurred.
Log Type Display the type of the record.
Message Display the information for each event.
Item Description
Refresh Click this link to refresh this page manually.
Item Description
Details/Back Details – Click it to display detailed status about HA
configuration for the selected router.
Back – Return to previous page.
HA Setup Click it to open Applications>>High Availability for modifying
the configuration.
Renew Click it to get the newest status of other router (except the
primary router).
Refresh Click it to get the newest status of the primary router.
Status “!” means an error has occurred. Refer to Detailed
information and modify HA settings if required.
Router Name Display the name of the device.
IPv4 Display the IPv4 address of such router.
State “Down” means the function of HA is disabled.
“Primary” means such router stands for the primary router in
HA.
“Secondary” means such router stands for the secondary
router in HA.
Stable “No” means the primary router has not been determined yet.
DARP is negotiating.
“YES” means the primary router is determined.
WAN “At Least One UP” means that at least one WAN interface
connects to Internet.
“All WANs Down” means that no WAN interface connects to
Cick the link of Status, Router Name, IPv4 or Details, the following page will be displayed on
the screen.
Item Description
Enable Check the box to enable such function.
Refresh Click it to update current page.
Clear Click it to remove all of the records.
Syslog Type Specify RADIUS, 802.1X or All to display related authentication
information log.
Display Mode Choose the mode you want to display the related information
on the following table.
Stop record when fulls – when the capacity of CVM log is
full, the system will stop recording.
Always record the new event – only the newest events
will be recorded by the system.
Time Display the time the user authenticated by Vigor2925 series.
Message Display authentication information done by Vigor2925 series.
Info The icon - - means there is something wrong (e.g., attacking the
system) with that IP address.
Item Description
Blocking IP Type the IP address in this field and click add. It will be added
to the IP List and appear in the right frame.
IP list in the right frame will be blocked by Vigor system
permanatly.
Remove – It is used to remove selected IP address from the
Blocking IP List.
Refresh Click this link to refresh current page.
or
Item Description
Mode Analyze a single packet – Choose such mode to make Vigor
router analyze how a single packet will be sent by a route
policy.
Analyze multiple packets… - Choose such mode to make Vigor
router analyze how multiple packets in a specified file will be
sent by a route policy.
Packet Information Specify the nature of the packets to be analyzed by Vigor
router.
3. If not, it means that there is something wrong with the hardware status. Simply back to
“I-2 Hardware Installation” to execute the hardware installation again. And then, try
again.
Sometimes the link failure occurs due to the wrong network connection settings. After trying
the above section, if the link is stilled failed, please do the steps listed below to make sure
the network connection settings is OK.
For Windows
Info The example is based on Windows 7. As to the examples for other operation
systems, please refer to the similar steps or find support notes in
www.DrayTek.com.
3. Icons of network connection will be shown on the window. Right-click on Local Area
Connection and click on Properties.
The default gateway IP address of the router is 192.168.1.1. For some reason, you might need
to use “ping” command to check the link status of the router. The most important thing is
that the computer will receive a reply from 192.168.1.1. If not, please check the IP
address of your computer. We suggest you setting the network connection as get IP
automatically. (Please refer to the previous section IX-3)
Please follow the steps below to ping the router correctly.
For Windows
1. Open the Command Prompt window (from Start menu> Run).
2. Type command (for Windows 95/98/ME) or cmd (for Windows NT/ 2000/XP/Vista/7).
The DOS command dialog will appear.
3. Type ping 192.168.1.1 and press [Enter]. If the link is OK, the line of “Reply from
192.168.1.1:bytes=32 time<1ms TTL=255” will appear.
4. If the line does not appear, please check the IP address setting of your computer.
If WAN connection cannot be up, check if the LEDs (according to the LED explanations listed
on section 1.2) are correct or not. If the LEDs are off, please:
Change the Physical Type from Auto negotiation to other values (e.g., 100M full duplex).
Next, change the physical type of modem (e.g., DSL/FTTX(GPON)/Cable modem) offered
by ISP with the same value configured in Vigor router. Check if the LEDs on Vigor router
are on or not.
If not, please install an additional switch for connecting both Vigor router and the modem
offered by ISP. Then, check if the LEDs on Vigor router are on or not.
If the problem of LEDs cannot be solved by the above measures, please contact with the
nearest reseller, or send an e-mail to DrayTek FAE for technical support.
Check if the settings offered by ISP are configured well or not.
When the LEDs are on and correct, yet the WAN connection still cannot be up, please:
Open WAN >> Internet Access page and then check whether the ISP settings are set
correctly. Click Details Page of WAN1~WAN4 to review the settings that you configured
previously.
When you have trouble in using 3G/4G network transmission, please check the following:
USB LED lights on but the network connection does not work
Check the PIN Code of SIM card is disabled or not. Please use the utility of 3G/4G USB Modem
to disable PIN code and try again. If it still fails, it might be the compliance problem of system.
Please open DrayTek Syslog Tool to capture the connection information (WAN Log) and send
the page (similar to the following graphic) to the service center of DrayTek.
Sometimes, a wrong connection can be improved by returning to the default settings. Try to
reset the router by software or hardware. Such function is available in Admin Mode only.
Info After pressing factory default setting, you will loose all settings you did
before. Make sure you have recorded all useful settings before you pressing.
The password of factory default is null.
Software Reset
You can reset the router to factory default via Web page. Such function is available in Admin
Mode only.
Go to System Maintenance and choose Reboot System on the web page. The following screen
will appear. Choose Using factory default configuration and click Reboot Now. After few
seconds, the router will return all the settings to the factory settings.
Hardware Reset
While the router is running (ACT LED blinking), press the Factory Reset button and hold for
more than 5 seconds. When you see the ACT LED blinks rapidly, please release the button.
Then, the router will restart with the default configuration.
If the router still cannot work correctly after trying many efforts, please contact your dealer
for further help right away. For any questions, please feel free to send e-mail to
[email protected].
Virtual Local Area Network is so-called VLAN. It offers the logical grouping technique to
separate the physical ports of Ethernet switches, thus we can manage our local network
easier, more flexible and secure. For instance, you’re a networking administrator in your
company and you’re planning to isolate the visitors’ traffics from your private network for
security considerations because you cannot ensure that visitors’ computer is clean. Or you
want to separate your private network into several parts by divisions because there are too
many computers in the same network segment and it results in the local traffics heavily.
VLAN helps you to solve these situations, and DrayTek’s products support bellow two popular
types:
Port-based
It uses a matrix table of the physical ports to define the traffics how to exchange between
each port, and the traffics will be isolated from the ports are not being ticked in the same
line. It is the easiest way to setup an isolate network, but not a flexible way to maintain a
growing network. Because the idea of port-based VLAN is grouping by physical ports, but the
difficulty is how to handle the traffics between two or more Ethernet switches. Thus, VLAN is
suitable for some circumstances, for example, the rental apartment, SOHO office…and so on.
These clients may need two or three isolated networks only and setup a network in a simple
way.
Tag-based
The idea of tag-based VLAN is to identify a virtual LAN with a specific ID, therefore, VLAN ID
introduced by tag-based VLAN. Through VLAN ID, ports with different VID (VLAN ID) will be
identified as in different LANs, so the traffics also will be isolated from each of VLANs. Many
administrators who manage an enterprise network or even the internet service providers (ISP)
adopt Tag-based VLAN popularly because it is convenient to maintain and manage a
distributed network. Setting a large-scale network is easy by giving each of them with
different VID and isolating the traffics at the same time. Besides the VLAN ID, there is another
feature, Trunk, introduced. While the role of a port on an Ethernet switch is setup as a Trunk
port, it means the VLAN ID will be kept while forwarding the packets between switches. By
this feature, VLANs are able to distribute over two or more Ethernet switches easily,
moreover design a large and secured network is possible through Trunk port. When VLAN is
being enabled on Vigor routers, the LAN ports are being turned into Trunk mode automatically.
Therefore, a VLAN supported switch, like VigorSwitch G2260/P2261, or VigorSwitch G1240, is
needed.
Trunk Port can carry the packets with VID but replace the Non-VID packet as the VID of Trunk
port while forwarding the packets to another switch.
Bridge mode of WAN
P1 and P2 are doing NAT flow to access to the internet, but P3 and P4 will forward the packets
between WAN and LAN ports directly.
Tag-based mode
By above settings, there are four private networks will be created and computers attached
with each of LAN ports or SSIDs which are able to obtain a private IP address from each
DHCP server (LAN1/LAN2/LAN3/LAN4). However, the traffics of the LAN port or SSID that
are NOT being grouped in the same VLAN are unable to forward to each other. The benefit
of Port-based is able to extend the wired ports by installing a cheaper dumb switch as
many as you need, but Tag-based offers you a flexible and well-managed network. The
networks are isolated, secured and reduce the broadcasting storm effectively in each of
networks with VLAN.
Guest Network
Tag-based mode
To deploy a guest network, which serves your guests the internet accessibility, but the
traffics have to be isolated from your private network due to the security considerations,
it can be done by above settings. However, a switch support VLAN function is need if VLAN
Tag enabled.
Triple Play (Multi-WAN)
NAT mode with VLAN
Following settings, the set-top box (STB) is able to attach with any LAN port. Video
streaming which your ISP provided will be played on your monitor.
Set-top box (STB) or the other kinds of media devices are able to attach with Port4 or
Port5 of LAN. Those devices that attached with Port4 or Port5 are able to access the
services network directly which your ISP provided.
This chapter also gives you a general description for accessing telnet and describes the
firmware versions for the routers explained in this manual.
Info For Windows 7 user, please make sure the Windows Features of Telnet
Client has been turned on under Control Panel>>Programs.
Type cmd and press Enter. The Telnet terminal will be open later.
In the following window, type Telnet 192.168.1.1 as below and press Enter. Note that the IP
address in the example is the default address of the router. If you have changed the default,
enter the current IP address of the router.
Next, type admin/admin for Account/Password. Then, type ?. You will see a list of
valid/common commands depending on the router that your use.
Syntax
bpa m [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
m Available settings are 1 and 2.
-a <enable> 1/0 to enable/disable this entry
-n <UserName> contact UserName(max. 24 characters)
-p <PassWord> contact PassWord (max. 24 characters)
-s <select> It means to specify an IP address for Server.
0 : no selection.
1 : NSW(61.9.192.13)
2 : QLD(61.9.208.13),
3 : VIC(61.9.128.13)
4 : SA(61.9.224.13),
5 : WA(61.9.240.13)
-l <List> List all settings configured.
Example
> bpa 1 -a 1 -n testUser -p testPassword -s 4
> bpa -l
-------index: 1 active------
UserName[1]: testUser
PassWord[1]: testPassword
ServerIP[1]:4
-------index: 2 inactive------
UserName[2]:
PassWord[2]:
ServerIP[2]:0
>
Syntax
csm appe prof -i INDEX [-v | -n NAME|setdefault]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
INDEX It means to specify the index number of CSM profile, from 1 to 32.
-v It means to view the configuration of the CSM profile.
-n It means to set a name for the CSM profile.
NAME It means to specify a name for the CSM profile, less then 15
characters.
setdefault Reset to default settings.
Example
> csm appe prof -i 1 -n games
The name of APPE Profile 1 was setted.
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
INDEX Specify the index number of CSM profile, from 1 to 32.
-v View the IM/P2P/Protocol and Others configuration of the CSM
profile.
-e Enable to block specific application.
-d Disable to block specific application.
GROUP Specify the category of the application. Available options are: IM,
P2P, Protocol and Others.
AP_IDX Each application has independent index number for identification in
CLI command.
Specify the index number of the application here. If you have no
idea of the inex number, do the following (Take IM as an example):
Type “csm appe set –I 1 –v IM”, the system will list all of the index
numbers of the applications categorized under IM.
Example
> Vigor> csm appe set -i 1 -e 1
Profile 1 - : AIM is enabled.
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-a View the configuration status for All groups.
-i View the configuration status of IM group.
-p View the configuration status of P2P group.
-t View the configuration status of protocol group.
-m View the configuration status of Others group.
Example
>csm appe show -t
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
INDEX Specify the index number of CSM profile, from 1 to 32.
-i View the configuration status of IM group.
-p View the configuration status of P2P group.
-t View the configuration status of protocol group.
-m View the configuration status of Others group.
Example
> csm appe config -v 1 -m
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
AUTO Vigor router specifies WAN interface automatically.
WAN Specify the WAN interface for signature downloading.
Example
> csm appe interface wan1
Download interface is set as "WAN1" now.
> csm appe interface auto
Download interface is set as "auto-selected" now.
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-e Enable notification e-mail mechanism.
-d Disable notification e-mail mechanism.
-s Send an example e-mail.
Example
> csm appe email -e
Enable APPE email.
Syntax
csm ucf show
csm ucf setdefault
csm ucf msg MSG
csm ucf obj INDEX [-n PROFILE_NAME | -l [P|B|A|N] | uac | wf ]
csm ucf obj INDEX -n PROFILE_NAME
csm ucf obj INDEX -p VALUE
csm ucf obj INDEX -l P|B|A|N
csm ucf obj INDEX uac
csm ucf obj INDEX wf
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show It means to display all of the profiles.
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all of the profile.
msg MSG It means de set the administration message.
MSG means the content (less than 255 characters) of the message
itself.
obj It means to specify the object for the profile.
INDEX It means to specify the index number of CSM profile, from 1 to 8.
-n It means to set the profile name.
PROFILE_NAME It means to specify the name of the profile (less than 16 characters)
-p Set the priority (defined by the number specified in VALUE) for the
profile.
Example
> csm ucf obj 1 -n game -l B
Profile Index: 1
Profile Name:[game]
Log:[none]
Priority Select : [Bundle : Pass]
Syntax
csm ucf obj INDEX uac -v
csm ucf obj INDEX uac -e
csm ucf obj INDEX uac -d
csm ucf obj INDEX uac -a P|B
csm ucf obj INDEX uac -i E|D
csm ucf obj INDEX uac -o KEY_WORD_Object_Index
csm ucf obj INDEX uac -g KEY_WORD_Group_Index
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
INDEX It means to specify the index number of CSM profile, from 1 to 8.
Example
> csm ucf obj 1 uac -i E
Profile Index: 1
Profile Name:[game]
Log:[none]
Priority Select : [Bundle : Pass]
Syntax
csm ucf obj INDEX wf -v
csm ucf obj INDEX wf -e
csm ucf obj INDEX wf -d
csm ucf obj INDEX wf -a P|B
csm ucf obj INDEX wf -s WEB_FEATURE
csm ucf obj INDEX wf -u WEB_FEATURE
csm ucf obj INDEX wf -f File_Extension_Object_index
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
INDEX It means to specify the index number of CSM profile, from 1 to 8.
-v It means to view the protocol configuration of the CSM profile.
-e It means to enable the restriction of web feature.
-d It means to disable the restriction of web feature.
-a Set the action of web feature, P or B.
B: Block. The web access meets the web feature will be blocked.
P: Pass. The web access meets the web feature will be passed.
-s It means to enable the the Web Feature configuration.
Features available for configuration are:
c: Cookie
p: Proxy
u: Upload
-u It means to cancel the web feature configuration.
-f It means to set the file extension object index number.
File_Extension_Object_inde Type the index number (1 to 8) for the file extension object.
x
Example
> csm ucf obj 1 wf -s c
Profile Index: 1
Profile Name:[game]
Log:[none]
Priority Select : [Bundle : Pass]
Syntax
csm wcf show
csm wcf look
csm wcf cache
csm wcf server WCF_SERVER
csm wcf msg MSG
csm wcf setdefault
csm wcf obj INDEX -v
csm wcf obj INDEX -a P|B
csm wcf obj INDEX -n PROFILE_NAME
csm wcf obj INDEX -l N|P|B|A
csm wcf obj INDEX -o KEY_WORD Object Index
csm wcf obj INDEX -g KEY_WORD Group Index
csm wcf obj INDEX -w E|D|P|B
csm wcf obj INDEX -s CATEGORY|WEB_GROUP
csm wcf obj INDEX -u CATEGORY|WEB_GROUP
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show It means to display the web content filter profiles.
Look It means to display the license information of WCF.
Cache It means to set the cache level for the profile.
Server WCF_SERVER It means to set web content filter server.
Msg MSG It means de set the administration message.
MSG means the content (less than 255 characters) of the message
itself.
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all of the profile.
obj It means to specify the object profile.
INDEX It means to specify the index number of web content filter profile,
from 1 to 8.
-v It means to view the web content filter profile.
-a Set the action of web content filter profile, P or B.
B: Block. The web access meets the web feature will be blocked.
P: Pass. The web access meets the web feature will be passed.
-n It means to set the profile name.
PROFILE_NAME It means to specify the name of the profile (less than 16 characters)
-l It means the log type of the profile. They are:
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable Enable or disable DNS Filter.
ON: enable.
OFF: disable.
syslog Determine the content of records transmitting to Syslog.
P: Pass. Records for the packets passing through DNS filter will be
sent to Syslog.
B: Block. Records for the packets blocked by DNS filter will be
sent to Syslog.
A: All. Records for the packets passing through or blocked by DNS
filter will be sent to Syslog.
N: None. No record will be sent to Syslog.
service WCF_PROFILE WCF_PROFILE: Specify a WCF profile as the base of DNS filtering.
Type a number to indicate the index number of WCF profile (1 is
first profile, 2 is second profile, and so on ...).
time CACHE_TIME CACHE_TIME: It means to set the time for cache to live (available
values are 1 to 24; 1 is one hour, 2 is two hours, and so on ...) for
DNS filter.
blockpage DNS sends block page for redirect port. When a web page is
blocked by DNS filter, the router system will send a message page
to describe that the page is not allowed to be visisted.
ON: Enable the function of displaying message page.
OFF: Disable the function of displaying message page.
SHOW: Display the function of displaying message page is ON or
OFF.
profile_show Display the table of the DNS filter profile.
profile_edit Modify the content of the DNS filter profile.
-n PROFILE_NAME PROFILE_NAME: Type the name of the DNS filter profile that you
want to modify.
-l N|P|B|A Specify the log type of the profile.
P: Pass.
B: Block.
A: All.
N: None.
-w WCF_PROFILE WCF_PROFILE: Type the index number of the WCF profile.
-u UCF_PROFILE UCF_PROFILE: Type the index number of the UCF profile.
-c CACHE_TIME -c means to set the cache time for DNS filter.
CACHE_TIME: It means to set the time for cache to live (available
values are 1 to 24; 1 is one hour, 2 is two hours, and so on ...) for
DNS filter.
Example
> csm dnsf service 2
dns service set up!!!
>csm dnsf service 3
wcf profile 3 is empty.....
>csm dnsf cachetime 1
dns cache time set up!!!
Example
>ddns log
>
Syntax
ddns time <update in minutes>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Update in minutes Type the value as DDNS time. The range is from 1 to 14400.
Example
> ddns time
ddns time <update in minutes>
Valid: 1 ~ 1440
%Now: 1440
> ddns time 1000
ddns time <update in minutes>
Valid: 1 ~ 1440
%Now: 1000
Syntax
dos [-V | D | A]
dos [-s ATTACK_F [THRESHOLD][ TIMEOUT]]
dos [-a | e [ATTACK_F][ATTACK_0] | d [ATTACK_F][ATTACK_0]]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-V It means to view the configuration of DoS defense system.
-D It means to deactivate the DoS defense system.
-A It means to activate the DoS defense system.
-s It means to enable the defense function for a specific attack and set
its parameter(s).
ATTACK_F It means to specify the name of flooding attack(s) or portscan, e.g.,
synflood, udpflood, icmpflood, or postscan.
THRESHOLD It means the packet rate (packet/second) that a flooding attack will
be detected. Set a value larger than 20.
Example
>dos –A
The Dos Defense system is Activated
>dos –s synflood 50 10
Synflood is enabled! Threshold=50 <pke/sec> timeout=10 <pke/sec>
Syntax
internet -W n -M n [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-M n M means to set Internet Access Mode (Mandatory) and n means
different modes (represented by 0 – 3)
n=0: Offline
n=1: PPPoE
n=2: Dynamic IP
n=3: Static IP
<command><parameter>|…] The available commands with parameters are listed below.
[…] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-S <isp name> It means to set ISP Name (max. 23 characters).
-P <on/off> It means to enable PPPoE Service.
-u <username> It means to set username (max. 49 characters) for Internet
accessing.
-p <password> It means to set password (max. 49 characters) for Internet
accessing.
x It means to set PPP Authentication Type and n means different
types (represented by 0-1).
n=0: PAP/CHAP (this is default setting)
n=1: PAP Only
-t n It means to set connection duration and n means different
conditions.
Example
>internet -M 1 -S tcom -u username -p password -a 0 -t -1 -i 0.0.0.0
WAN1 Internet Mode set to PPPoE/PPPoA
Syntax
ip pubsubnet <Enable/Disable>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Enable Enable the function.
Disable Disable the function.
Example
> ip pubsubnet enable
public subnet enabled!
Syntax
ip pubaddr ?
ip pubaddr <public subnet IP address>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? Display an IP address which allows users set as the public subnet IP
address.
public subnet IP address Specify an IP address. The system will set the one that you specified
as the public subnet IP address.
Syntax
ip pubmask ?
ip pubmask <public subnet mask>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? Display an IP address which allows users set as the public subnet
mask.
public subnet IP address Specify a subnet mask. The system will set the one that you
specified as the public subnet mask.
Example
> ip pubmask ?
% ip pubmask <public subnet mask>
% Now: 255.255.255.0
Syntax
ip aux add [IP] [Join to NAT Pool][wanX]
ip aux remove [index]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
add It means to create a new WAN IP address.
remove It means to delete an existed WAN IP address.
IP It means the auxiliary WAN IP address.
Join to NAT Pool 0 (disable) or 1 (enable).
wanX Add or remove an address for WAN interface.
index Type the index number of the table displayed on your screen.
Example
When you type ip aux?, the current auxiliary WAN IP Address table will be shown as the
following:
Syntax
ip addr [IP address]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IP address It means the LAN IP address.
Example
>ip addr 192.168.50.1
% Set IP address OK !!!
Info When the LAN IP address is changed, the start IP address of DHCP server are
still the same. To make the IP assignment of the DHCP server being
consistent with this new IP address (they should be in the same network
segment), the IP address of the PC must be fixed with the same LAN IP
address (network segment) set by this command for accessing into the web
user interface of the router. Later, modify the start addresses for the DHCP
server.
Syntax
ip nmask [IP netmask]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IP netmask It means the netmask of LAN IP.
Example
> ip nmask 255.255.0.0
% Set IP netmask OK !!!
Syntax
ip arp add [IP address] [MAC address] [LAN or WAN]
ip arp del [IP address] [LAN or WAN]
ip arp flush
ip arp status
ip arp accept [0/1/2/3/4/5/status]
ip arp setCacheLife [time]
In which, arp add allows users to add a new IP address into the ARP table; arp del allows users
to remove an IP address; arp flush allows users to clear arp cache; arp status allows users to
review current status for the arp table; arp accept allows to accept or reject the source
/destination MAC address; arp setCacheLife allows users to configure the duration in which
ARP caches can be stored on the system. If ip arp setCacheLife is set with “60”, it means you
have an ARP cache at 0 second. Sixty seconds later without any ARP messages received, the
system will think such ARP cache is expired. The system will issue a few ARP request to see if
this cache is still valid.
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IP address It means the LAN IP address.
MAC address It means the MAC address of your router.
LAN or WAN It indicates the direction for the arp function.
0/1/2/3/4/5 0: disable to accept illegal source mac address
1: enable to accept illegal source mac address
2: disable to accept illegal dest mac address
3: enable to accept illegal dest mac address
4: Decline VRRP mac into arp table
5: Accept VRRP mac into arp table
status: display the setting status.
Time Available settings will be 10, 20, 30,....2550 seconds.
Syntax
ip dhcpc option
ip dhcpc option -h|l
ip dhcpc option -d [idx]
ip dhcpc option -e [1 or 0] -w [wan unmber] -c [option number] -v [option value]
ip dhcpc option -e [1 or 0] -w [wan unmber] -c [option number] -x "[option value]"
ip dhcpc option -u [idx unmber]
ip dhcpc release [wan number]
ip dhcpc renew [wan number]
ip dhcpc status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
option It is an optional setting for DHCP server.
-h: display usage
-l: list all custom set DHCP options
-d: delete custom dhcp client option by index number
-e: enable/disable option feature, 1:enable, 0:disable
-w: set WAN number (e.g., 1=WAN1)
-c: set option number: 0~255
-v: set option value by string
-x: set option value by raw byte (hex)
-u: update by index number
release It means to release current WAN IP address.
renew It means to renew the WAN IP address and obtain another new one.
status It displays current status of DHCP client.
Example
>ip dhcpc status
I/F#3 DHCP Client Status:
Syntax
ip ping [IP address] [WAN1 /PVC3/PVC4/PVC5]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IP address It means the WAN IP address.
WAN1/PVC3/PVC4/PVC5 It means the WAN port /PVC that the above IP address passes
through.
Example
>ip ping 172.16.3.229 WAN1
Pinging 172.16.3.229 with 64 bytes of Data:
Receive reply from 172.16.3.229, time=0ms
Receive reply from 172.16.3.229, time=0ms
Receive reply from 172.16.3.229, time=0ms
Packets: Sent = 5, Received = 5, Lost = 0 <0% loss>
Syntax
ip tracert [Host/IP address] [WAN1/WAN2] [Udp/Icmp]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IP address It means the target IP address.
WAN1/WAN2 It means the WAN port that the above IP address passes through.
Udp/Icmp It means the UDP or ICMP.
Syntax
ip telnet [IP address][Port]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IP address Type the WAN or LAN IP address of the remote device.
Port Type a port number (e.g., 23).
Available settings: 0 ~65535.
Example
> ip telnet 172.17.3.252 23
>
Syntax
ip rip [0/1/2]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
0/1/2 0 means disable; 1 means first subnet and 2 means second
subnet.
Example
> ip rip 1
%% Set RIP 1st subnet.
Syntax
ip wanrip [ifno] -e [0/1]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
ifno It means the connection interface.
1: WAN1,2: WAN2, 3: PVC3,4: PVC4,5: PVC5
Note: PVC3 ~PVC5 are virtual WANs.
-e It means to disable or enable RIP setting for specified WAN
interface.
1: Enable the function of setting RIP of WAN IP.
0: Disable the function.
Example
> ip wanrip ?
Valid ex:ip wanrip <ifno> -e <0/1>
<ifno> 1: WAN1,2: WAN2
3: PVC3,4: PVC4,5: PVC5
-e <0/1> 0: disable, 1: enable
Now status:
WAN[1] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[2] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[3] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[4] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[5] Rip Protocol disable
> ip wanrip 5 -e 1
> ip wanrip ?
Valid ex:ip wanrip <ifno> -e <0/1>
<ifno> 1: WAN1,2: WAN2
3: PVC3,4: PVC4,5: PVC5
-e <0/1> 0: disable, 1: enable
Now status:
WAN[1] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[2] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[3] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[4] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[5] Rip Protocol enable
Syntax
ip route add [dst] [netmask][gateway][ifno][rtype]
ip route del [dst] [netmask][rtype]
ip route status
ip route cnc
ip route default [wan1/wan2/off/?]
ip route clean [1/0]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
add It means to add an IP address as static route.
del It means to delete specified IP address.
status It means current status of static route.
dst It means the IP address of the destination.
netmask It means the netmask of the specified IP address.
gateway It means the gateway of the connected router.
ifno It means the connection interface.
3=WAN1 5=WAN3,6=WAN4,7=WAN5
However,
WAN3, WAN4, WAN5 are router-borne WANs
rtype It means the type of the route.
default : default route;
static: static route.
cnc It means current IP range for CNC Network.
default Set WAN1/WAN2/off as current default route.
clean Clean all of the route settings.
1: Enable the function.
0: Disable the function.
Example
> ip route add 172.16.2.0 255.255.255.0 172.16.2.4 3 static
> ip route status
Syntax
ip igmp_proxy set
ip igmp_proxy reset
ip igmp_proxy wan
ip igmp_proxy t_home[on/off/show/help]
ip igmp_proxy query
ip igmp_proxy ppp [0/1]
ip igmp_proxy status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
set It means to enable proxy server.
reset It means to disable proxy server.
wan It means to specify WAN interface for IGMP service.
t_home It means to specify t_home proxy server for using.
On/off/show/help It means to turn on/off/display or get more information of the
T_home service.
query It means to set IGMP general query interval.
The default value is 125000 ms.
ppp 0 – No need to set IGMP with PPP header.
1 – Set IGMP with PPP header.
status It means to display current status for proxy server.
Example
> ip igmp t_home on
%T-Home Setting:
%T-Home Service is turned on.
%WAN1 : Enabled, connection type: PPPoE, without tag for ADSL
%WAN5 : Enabled, connection type: DHCP, tag: 8
%: PVC4(WAN5) is bound to PVC0(WAN1), protocol=MPoA 1483 Bridge
%IGMP Proxy Interface: WAN5(PVC)
%WAN5 for Router-borne Application/ IPTV on/off: ON
> ip igmp_proxy query 130000
This command is for setting IGMP General Query Interval
The default value is 125000 ms
Current Setting is:130000 ms
>
Syntax
ip igmp_snoop enable
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable It means to enable igmp snoop function
disable It means to disable igmp snoop function.
status It means to display current igmp configuration.
table It means to display current configuration of igmp.
txquery It means to send out IGMP QUERY to LAN periodically.
mode It means to set software or hardware mode for snooping working on.
chkleave It means to check the leave status.
On: enable the IGMP snoop leave checking function.
Off: it will drop LEAVE if still clients on the same group.
separate It means to set IGMP packets being separated by NAT/Bridge.
On: The packets will be separated.
Off: The packets will not be separated by NAT/Bridge.
portchk It means to perform LAN port checking for IGMP packets.
On: Perform the LAN port checking.
Off: No perform the LAN port checking.
Example
Syntax
ip dmz [mac]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
mac It means the MAC address of the device that you want to specify
Example
>ip dmz ?
% ip dmz <mac>, now : 00-00-00-00-00-00
> ip dmz 11-22-33-44-55-66
> ip dmz ?
% ip dmz <mac>, now : 11-22-33-44-55-66
>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
off It means to turn off DMZ function.
private It means to set DMZ with private IP.
trueip It means to set DMZ with true IP.
active_trueip It means to set the DMZ with active true IP.
Example
>ip ip dmzswitch off
>
Syntax
ip session on
ip session off
ip session default [num]
ip session defaultp2p [num]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on It means to turn on session limit for each IP.
off It means to turn off session limit for each IP.
default [num] It means to set the default number of session num limit.
Defautlp2p [num] It means to set the default number of session num limit for p2p.
status It means to display the current settings.
show It means to display all session limit settings in the IP range.
timer [num] It means to set when the IP session block works.
The unit is second.
[block/unblock][IP] It means to block/unblock the specified IP address.
Block: The IP cannot access Internet through the router.
Unblock: The specified IP can access Internet through the router.
add It means to add the session limits in an IP range.
del It means to delete the session limits in an IP range.
IP1-IP2 It means the range of IP address specified for this command.
num It means the number of the session limits, e.g., 100.
p2pnum It means the number of the session limits, e.g., 50 for P2P.
Example
>ip session default 100
> ip session add 192.168.1.5-192.168.1.100 100 50
> ip session on
> ip session status
IP range:
192.168.1.5 - 192.168.1.100 : 100
Syntax
ip bandwidth on
ip bandwidth off
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on It means to turn on the IP bandwidth limit.
off It means to turn off the IP bandwidth limit.
default [tx_rate][rx_rate] It means to set default tx and rx rate of bandwidth limit. The
range is from 0 – 65535 Kpbs.
status It means to display the current settings.
show It means to display all the bandwidth limits settings within the IP
range.
add It means to add the bandwidth within the IP range.
del It means to delete the bandwidth within the IP range.
IP1-IP2 It means the range of IP address specified for this command.
tx It means to set transmission rate for bandwidth limit.
rx It means to set receiving rate for bandwidth limit.
shared It means that the bandwidth will be shared for the IP range.
Example
> ip bandwidth default 200 800
> ip bandwidth add 192.168.1.50-192.168.1.100 10 60
> ip bandwidth status
IP range:
192.168.1.50 - 192.168.1.100 : Tx:10K Rx:60K
Syntax
ip bindmac on
ip bindmac off
ip bindmac strict_on
ip bindmac show
ip bindmac add [IP][MAC][Comment]
ip bindmac del [IP]/all
Example
> ip bindmac add 192.168.1.46 00:50:7f:22:33:55 just for test
> ip bindmac show
ip bind mac function is turned ON
IP : 192.168.1.46 bind MAC : 00-50-7f-22-33-55 Comment : just
Syntax
ip maxnatuser user no
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
User no A number specified here means the total NAT users that Vigor router
supports.
0 – It means no limitation.
Example
> ip maxnatuser 100
% Max NAT user = 100
Syntax
ip policy_rt [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
<command><parameter>|…] The available commands with parameters are listed below.
[…] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
General Setup for Policy Route
-i [value] Specify an index number for setting policy route profile.
Value: 1 to 60. “-1” means to get a free policy index automatically.
-e [0/1] 0: Disable the selected policy route profile.
1: Enable the selected policy route profile.
-o [value] Determine the operation of the policy route.
Value:
add – Create a new policy rotue profile.
del – Remove an existed policy route profile.
edit – Modify an existed policy route profile.
flush – Reset policy route to default setting.
-1 [any/range] Specify the source IP mode.
Range: Indicate a range of IP addresses.
Any: It means any IP address will be treated as source IP address.
-2 Specify the destination IP mode.
[any/ip_range/ip_subnet/do Any: No need to specify an IP address for any IP address will be
main] treated as destination IP address.
ip_range: Indicates a range of IP addresses.
ip_subnet: Indicates the IP subnet.
domain: Indicates the domain name.
-3 [any/range] Specify the destination port mode.
Range: Indicate a range of port number.
Example
> ip policy_rt diagnose -s 192.168.1.100 -d any -p any -t ICMP
-------------------------------------------------
Matched Route (Priority)
-------------------------------------------------
* No_Match
-------------------------------------------------
Matched Policy (Priority)
-------------------------------------------------
* Policy_1 (200)
Syntax
ip lanDNSRes [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Parameter Description
-a <IP Address> It is used to configure IP address mapping (IPv4/IPv6 Address or
multiple subnet addresses).
IP Address: type the IP address (e.g., 192.168.1.56).
-d <address mapping index It means to delete index number with address mapping configured.
number> address mapping index number : type the index number which
represents the address mapping profile.
-e <0/1> It means to enable or disable the function of LAN DNS or DNS
Forwarding Profile.
Example
> ip lanDNSRes -i 1 -n ftp.drayTek.com
% Configure Set1's DomainName:ftp.drayTek.com
> ip lanDNSRes -i 1 -n ftp.drayTek.com
> ip lanDNSRes -i 1 -a 172.16.2.10 -s 1
> ip lanDNSRes -i 1 -a 172.16.3.10 -s 1
> ip lanDNSRes -i 1 -a 172.16.4.10 -s 1
> ip lanDNSRes -l
%
% Idx: 7
% State: Enable
% Profile: DrayTekFTP
% Domain Name: ftp.draytek.com
% -------- Address Mapping Table --------
% Idx ReplyOnlySameSubnet IP Address
% 1 Yes 172.16.2.10
% 2 Yes 172.16.3.10
% 3 Yes 172.16.4.10
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
Example
> ip dnsforward -i 1 -n ftp.drayTek.com
% Configure Set1's DomainName:ftp.drayTek.com
> ip dnsforward -i 1 -a 172.16.1.1
% Configure Set1's IP:172.16.1.1
> ip dnsforward -i 1 -l
% Idx: 1
% State: Disable
% Profile: test
% Domain Name: ftp.drayTek.com
% DNS Server IP: 172.16.1.1
>
Syntax
ip6 addr -s [prefix] [prefix-length] [LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface#]
ip6 addr -d [prefix] [prefix-length] [LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface#]
ip6 addr -a [LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface#]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-s It means to add a static ipv6 address.
-d It means to delete an ipv6 address.
-a It means to show current address(es) status.
-u It means to show only unicast addresses.
prefix It means to type the prefix number of IPv6 address.
prefix-length It means to type a fixed value as the length of the prefix.
LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface# It means to specify LAN or WAN interface for such address.
Syntax
ip6 dhcp req_opt [LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface#] [-<command> <parameter>| ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
req_opt It means option-request.
LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface# It means to specify LAN or WAN interface for such address.
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-a It means to show current DHCPv6 status.
-s It means to ask the SIP.
-S It means to ask the SIP name.
-d It means to ask the DNS setting.
-D It means to ask the DNS name.
-n It means to ask NTP.
-i It means to ask NIS.
-I It means to ask NIS name.
-p It means to ask NISP.
-P It means to ask NISP name.
-b It means to ask BCMCS.
-B It means to ask BCMCS name.
-r It means to ask refresh time.
Parameter 1: the parameter related to the request will be displayed.
0: the parameter related to the request will not be displayed.
Example
> ip6 dhcp req_opt WAN2 -S 1
> ip6 dhcp req_opt WAN2 -r 1
> ip6 dhcp req_opt WAN2 -a
% Interface WAN2 is set to request following DHCPv6 options:
% sip name
Syntax
ip6 dhcp client [WAN1|WAN2|iface#] [-<command> <parameter>| ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
client It means the dhcp client settings.
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-a It means to show current DHCPv6 status.
-p [IAID] It means to request identity association ID for Prefix Delegation.
-n [IAID] It means to request identity association ID for Non-temporary
Address.
-c [parameter] It means to send rapid commit to server.
-i [parameter] It means to send information request to server.
-e[parameter] It means to enable or disable the DHCPv6 client.
1: Enable
0: Disable
Example
> ip6 dhcp client WAN2 –p 2008::1
> ip6 dhcp client WAN2 –a
Interface WAN2 has following DHCPv6 client settings:
DHCPv6 client enabled
request IA_PD whose IAID equals to 2008
> ip6 dhcp client WAN2 –n 1023456
> ip6 dhcp client WAN2 –a
Interface WAN2 has following DHCPv6 client settings:
DHCPv6 client enabled
request IA_NA whose IAID equals to 2008
> system reboot
Syntax
ip6 dhcp server [-<command> <parameter>| ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
server It means the dhcp server settings.
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
Example
> ip6 dhcp server -d FF02::1
> ip6 dhcp server -i ff02::1
> ip6 dhcp server -x ff02::3
> ip6 dhcp server -a
% Interface LAN has following DHCPv6 server settings:
% DHCPv6 server disabled
% maximum address of the pool: FF02::3
% minimum address of the pool: FF02::1
% 1st DNS IPv6 Addr: FF02::1
Syntax
ip6 internet -W n -M n [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-W n W means to set WAN interface and n means different selections.
Default is WAN1.
n=1: WAN1
n=2: WAN2
n=3: WAN3
.
.
n=X: WANx
-M n M means to set Internet Access Mode (Mandatory) and n means
different modes (represented by 0 – 5)
n= 0: Offline,
n=1: PPP,
n=2: TSPC,
n=3: AICCU,
n=4: DHCPv6,
n=5: Static
n=6:6in4-Static
Example
> ip6 internet -W 2 -M 2 -u 88886666 -p draytek123456 –s
amsterdam.freenet6.net
This setting will take effect after rebooting.
Please use "sys reboot" command to reboot the router.
> system reboot
Syntax
ip6 neigh -s[ inet6_addr] [eth_addr] [LAN|WAN1|WAN2]
ip6 neigh -d [inet6_addr] [LAN|WAN1|WAN2]
ip6 neigh -a [inet6_addr] [-N LAN|WAN1|WAN2]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-s It means to add a neighbour.
-d It means to delete a neighbour.
-a It means to show neighbour status.
inet6_addr Type an IPv6 address
eth_addr Type submask address.
LAN|WAN1|WAN2 Specify an interface for the neighbor.
Example
> ip6 neigh -s 2001:2222:3333::1111 00:50:7F:11:ac:22:WAN2
Neighbour 2001:2222:3333::1111 successfully added!
> ip6 neigh -a
Syntax
ip6 pneigh -s inet6_addr [LAN|WAN1|WAN2]
ip6 pneigh -d inet6_addr [LAN|WAN1|WAN2]
ip6 pneigh -a [inet6_addr] [-N LAN|WAN1|WAN2]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-s It means to add a proxy neighbour.
-d It means to delete a proxy neighbour.
-a It means to show proxy neighbour status.
inet6_addr Type an IPv6 address
LAN|WAN1|WAN2 Specify an interface for the proxy neighbor.
Example
> ip6 neigh -s FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:300 LAN
% Neighbour FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:300 successfully added!
Syntax
ip6 route -s [prefix] [prefix-length] [gateway] [LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface#> [-D]
ip6 route -d [prefix] [prefix-length]
ip6 route -a [LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface#]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-s It means to add a route.
-d It means to delete a route.
-a It means to show the route status.
-D It means that such route will be treated as the default route.
prefix It means to type the prefix number of IPv6 address.
prefix-length It means to type a fixed value as the length of the prefix.
gateway It means the gateway of the router.
LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface# It means to specify LAN or WAN interface for such address.
Example
> ip6 route -s FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:500 16 FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:100 LAN
% Route FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:500/16 successfully added!
> ip6 route -a LAN
Syntax
ip6 ping [IPV6 address/Host] [LAN/WAN1/WAN2]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IPV6 address/Host It means to specify the IPv6 address or host for ping.
LAN/WAN1/WAN2 It means to specify LAN or WAN interface for such address.
Example
> ip6 ping 2001:4860:4860::8888 WAN2
Syntax
ip6 tracert [IPV6 address/Host]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IPV6 address/Host It means to specify the IPv6 address or host for ping.
Example
> ip6 tracert 2001:4860:4860::8888
traceroute to 2001:4860:4860::8888, 30 hops max through protocol ICMP
1 2001:5C0:1400:B::10B8 340 ms
2 2001:4DE0:1000:A22::1 330 ms
3 2001:4DE0:A::1 330 ms
4 2001:4DE0:1000:34::1 340 ms
5 2001:7F8:1: :A501:5169:1 330 ms
6 2001:4860::1:0:4B3 350 ms
7 2001:4860::8:0:2DAF 330 ms
E
8 2001:4860::2:0:66 340 ms
9 Request timed out. *
10 2001:4860:4860::8888 350 ms
Trace complete.
>
Syntax
ip6 tspc [ifno]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
ifno It means the connection interface.
Ifno=1 (means WAN1)
Info=2 (means WAN2)
Example
> ip6 tspc 2
Local Endpoint v4 Address : 111.243.177.223
Local Endpoint v6 Address : 2001:05c0:1400:000b:0000:0000:0000:10b9
Router DNS name : 8886666.broker.freenet6.net
Remote Endpoint v4 Address :81.171.72.11
Remote Endpoint v6 Address : 2001:05c0:1400:000b:0000:0000:0000:10b8
Tspc Prefixlen : 56
Tunnel Broker: Amsterdam.freenet.net
>
Syntax
Ip6 radvd –s [1|0] [lifetime]
ip6 radvd –V
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-s It means to enable or disable the default lifetime of the RADVD
server.
1: Enable the RADVD server.
0: Disable the RADVD server.
Lifetime It means to set the lifetime.
The lifetime associated with the default router in units of seconds.
It’s used to control the lifetime of the prefix. The maximum value
corresponds to 18.2 hours. A lifetime of 0 indicates that the router
is not a default router and should not appear on the default router
list.
Type the number (unit: second) you want.
-V It means to show the RADVD configuration.
-r It means RA default test.
-r [num] It means RA test for item [num].
Example
> ip6 radvd -s 1 1800
> ip6 radvd -V
% IPv6 Radvd Config:
Radvd : Enable, Default Lifetime : 1800 seconds
Syntax
ip6 mngt list
ip6 mngt list [add<index> <prefix> <prefix-length>|remove <index>|flush]
ip6 mngt status
ip6 mngt [http|telnet|ping|https|ssh] [on|off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
list It means to show the setting information of the access list.
status It means to show the status of IPv6 management.
Example
> ip6 mngt list add 1 FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:1010 128
> ip6 mngt list add 2 FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:1020 128
> ip6 mngt list add 3 FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:2080 128
> ip6 mngt list
% IPv6 Access List :
Index IPv6 Prefix Prefix Length
========================================
1 FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:1010 128
2 FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:1020 128
3 FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:2080 128
Syntax
ip6 online [ifno]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
ifno It means the connection interface.
0=LAN1
1=WAN1
2=WAN2
Example
> ip6 online 0
% LAN 1 online status :
% Interface : UP
% IPv6 DNS Server: :: Static
% IPv6 DNS Server: :: Static
Syntax
ip6 aiccu [ifno]
ip6 aiccu subnet [add <ifno> <prefix> <prefix-length>|remove <ifno>|show <info>]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
ifno It means the connection interface.
1=WAN1
2=WAN2
add It means to add an IPv6 address which can be used to execute
management through Internet.
prefix It means to type the IPv6 address which will be used for accessing
Internet.
prefix-length It means to type a fixed value as the length of the prefix.
remove It means to remove (delete) the specified index number with IPv6
settings.
show It means to display the AICCU status.
Example
> ip6 aiccu subnet add 2 2001:1111:0000::1111 64
> ip6 aiccu 2
Status: Connecting
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
–h It is used to display the usage of such command.
-v It is used to show the NTP state.
-p <0/1> It is used to specify NTP server for IPv6.
0 – Auto
1 – First Query IPv6 NTP Server.
Example
> ip6 ntp -p 1
% Set NTP Priority: IPv6 First
Syntax
ipf view [-VcdhrtzZ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-V It means to show the version of this IP filter.
-c It means to show the running call filter rules.
-d It means to show the running data filter rules.
-h It means to show the hit-number of the filter rules.
-r It means to show the running call and data filter rules.
-t It means to display all the information at one time.
-z It means to clear a filter rule’s statistics.
-Z It means to clear IP filter’s gross statistics.
Example
> ipf view -V -c -d
ipf: IP Filter: v3.3.1 (1824)
Kernel: IP Filter: v3.3.1
Running: yes
Log Flags: 0x80947278 = nonip
Default: pass all, Logging: available
Syntax
ipf set [Options]
ipf set [SET_NO] rule [RULE_NO] [Options]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Options There are several options provided here, such as -v, -c [SET_NO], -d
[SET_NO],… and etc.
SET_NO It means to specify the index number (from 1 to 12) of filter set.
RULE_NO It means to specify the index number (from 1 to 7) of filter rule set.
-v Type “-v” to view the configuration of general set.
-c [SET_NO] It means to setup Call Filter, e.g., -c 2. The range for the index
number you can type is “0” to “12” (0 means “disable).
-d [SET_NO] It means to setup Data Filter, e.g., -d 3. The range for the index
number you can type is “0” to “12” (0 means “disable).
-l [VALUE] It means to setup Log Flag, e.g., -l 2
Type “0” to disable the log flag.
Type “1” to display the log of passed packet.
Type “2” to display the log of blocked packet.
Type “3” to display the log of non-matching packet.
- p [VALUE] It means to setup actions for packet not matching any rule, e.g., -p
1
Type “0” to let all the packets pass;
Type “1” to block all the packets.
-M [P2P_NO] It means to configure IM/P2P for the packets not matching with any
rule, e.g., -M 1
Type “0” to let all the packets pass;
Type “1” to block all the packets.
-U [URL_NO] It means to configure URL content filter for the packets not
matching with any rule, e.g., -U 1
Type “0” to let all the packets pass;
Type “1” to block all the packets.
-a [AD_SET] It means to configure the advanced settings.
-f [VALUE] It means to accept large incoming fragmented UDP or ICMP packets.
-E [VALUE] It means to set the maximum count for session limitation.
-F [VALUE] It means to configure the load-balance policy.
-Q [VALUE] It means to set the QoS class.
Example
> ipf set -c 1 #set call filter start from set 1
Setting saved.
Syntax
ipf rule s r [-<command> <parameter> | ...
ipf rule s r -v
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
s Such word means Filter Set, range form 1~12.
r Such word means Filter Rule, range from 1~7.
<Command><parameter> The following lists all of the available commands with parameters.
-e It means to enable or disable the rule setting.
0- disable
1- enable
-s o:g <obj> It means to specify source IP object and IP group.
o - indicates “object”.
g - indicates “group”.
obj - indicates index number of object or index number of group.
Available settings range from 1-192. For example, “-s g 3" means
the third source IP group profile.
–s u <Address Type> <Start IP It means to configure source IP address including address type,
Address> <End IP Address> | start IP address, end IP address and address mask.
Example
> ipf rule 2 1 -e 1 -s "o 1" -d "o 2" -S "o 1" -F 2
> ipf rule 2 1 -v
Status : Enable
Comments: xNetBios -> DNS
Index(1-15) in Schedule Setup: <null>, <null>, <null>, <null>
Syntax
ipf flowtrack set [-re]
ipf flowtrack view [-f]
ipf flowtrack [-i][-p][-t]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-r It means to refresh the flowtrack.
-e It means to enable or disable the flowtrack.
0: Disable
1: Enable
-f It means to show the sessions state of flowtrack. If you do not
specify any IP address, then all the session state of flowtrack will be
Example
>ipf flowtrack set -r
Refresh the flowstate ok
> ipf flowtrack view -f
Start to show the flowtrack sessions state:
Syntax
log [-cfhiptwx?] [-F a| c | f | w]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-c It means to show the latest call log.
-f It means to show the IP filter log.
-F It means to show the flush log buffer.
a: flush all logs
c: flush the call log
f: flush the IP filter log
w: flush the WAN log
-h It means to show this usage help.
-p It means to show PPP/MP log.
-t It means to show all logs saved in the log buffer.
Example
> log -w
25:36:25.580 ---->DHCP (WAN-5) Len = 548XID = 0x7880fdd4
Client IP = 0.0.0.0
Your IP = 0.0.0.0
Next server IP = 0.0.0.0
Relay agent IP = 0.0.0.0
25:36:33.580 ---->DHCP (WAN-5) Len = 548XID = 0x7880fdd4
Client IP = 0.0.0.0
Your IP = 0.0.0.0
Next server IP = 0.0.0.0
Relay agent IP = 0.0.0.0
25:36:41.580 ---->DHCP (WAN-5) Len = 548XID = 0x7880fdd4
Client IP = 0.0.0.0
Your IP = 0.0.0.0
Next server IP = 0.0.0.0
Relay agent IP = 0.0.0.0
25:36:49.580 ---->DHCP (WAN-5) Len = 548XID = 0x7880fdd4
Client IP = 0.0.0.0
Your IP = 0.0.0.0
Next server IP = 0.0.0.0
Relay agent IP = 0.0.0.0
25:36:57.580 ---->DHCP (WAN-5) Len = 548XID = 0x7880fdd4
Client IP = 0.0.0.0
Your IP = 0.0.0.0
--- MORE --- ['q': Quit, 'Enter': New Lines, 'Space Bar': Next Page]
---
Syntax
ldap user [INDEX][OPTION]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
INDEX Specify the index number (1 to 8) of the LDAP profile.
OPTION
-n VALUE Setup Profile Name.
-b VALUE Setup Base Distinguished Name.
-a VALUE If you have added containers to be published, you may need to
specify additional LDAP filters for each class of objects included in
these containers.
Creating LDAP filters is a fairly complex task that should be
performed by advanced users only. LDAP filters must be
RFC2254-compliant.
For example, to exclude from publication all users who either
Example
>ldap user 1 -n LD_user_test1
Profile Name has been updated!
> ldap user 1 -v
Profile Index:1
Profile Name:LD_user_test1
Common Name Identifier:
Base Distinguished Name:
Additional Filter:
Group distinguished Name:
>ldap user 1 -b ou=People,dc=example,dc=com
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable [0-1] Enable or disable LDAP function.
0 – Disable the function.
1 – Enable the function.
type [0-2] Set the bind type as Simple(0),Anonymous(1), and Regular(2).
ssl [0-1] Enable or disable LDAP function via SSL tunnel.
0 – Disable the function.
1 – Enable the function.
IP <VALUE> Set IP address for LDAP server.
port <VALUE> Set port number for LDAP server.
dn <VALUE> Set Regular DN value
PWD <VALUE> Set Regular password value.
Example
>ldap set enable 1
>ldap enabled.
> ldap set ssl 1
LDAP with SSL has been enabled!
> ldap set IP 192.168.100.155
LDAP Server IP has been setting.
> ldap set port 389
LDAP Server Port has been setting.
Syntax
ldap view
Example
> ldap view ?
LDAP Enable:Disabled.
LDAP Bind Type:Simple
LDAP with SSL:Disabled
LDAP Regular DN:
LDAP Regular Password:
LDAP Server IP:
LDAP Server Port:389
Syntax
tacacspluse set [Options][Value]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable [0-1] Disable (0)/enable(1) the TACACS+ server.
IP <VALUE> Set the IP address of TACACS+ server.
port <VALUE> Set the port number of TACACS+ server.
shared_secret <VALUE> Set the Shared Secret value of TACACS+ Server.
Example
> tacacsplus set enable 1
TACACS+ enabled!
This setting will take effect after rebooting.
Please use "sys reboot" command to reboot the router.
Syntax
tacacspluse view
Example
> tacacsplus view
TACACS+ Enable:Enable.
TACACS+ Server IP:192.168.1.59
TACACS+ Server Port:49
TACACS+ Type:ASCII
TACACS+ Shared Secret:
Syntax
mngt ftpport [FTP port]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
FTP port It means to type the number for FTP port. The default setting is
21.
Example
> mngt ftpport 21
% Set FTP server port to 21 done.
Syntax
mngt httpport [Http port]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Http port It means to enter the number for HTTP port. The default setting is
80.
Example
> mngt httpport 80
% Set web server port to 80 done.
Syntax
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Https port It means to type the number for HTTPS port. The default setting is
443.
Example
> mngt httpsport 443
% Set web server port to 443 done.
Syntax
mngt telnetport [Telnet port]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Telnet port It means to type the number for telnet port. The default setting is
23.
Example
> mngt telnetport 23
% Set Telnet server port to 23 done.
Syntax
mngt sshport [ssh port]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
ssh port It means to type the number for SSH port. The default setting is
22.
Example
> mngt sshport 23
% Set ssh port to 23 done.
Syntax
mngt noping [on]
mngt noping [off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on All PING packets will be forwarded from LAN PC to Internet.
off All PING packets will be blocked from LAN PC to Internet.
viewlog It means to display a log of ping action, including source MAC and
source IP.
clearlog It means to clear the log of ping action.
Example
> mngt noping off
No Ping Packet Out is OFF!!
Syntax
mngt defenseworm [on]
mngt defenseworm [off]
mngt defenseworm [add port]
mngt defenseworm [del port]
mngt defenseworm [viewlog]
mngt defenseworm [clearlog]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on It means to activate the function of defense worm packet out.
off It means to inactivate the function of defense worm packet out.
add port It means to add a new TCP port for block.
del port It means to delete a TCP port for block.
viewlog It means to display a log of defense worm packet, including source
MAC and source IP.
clearlog It means to remove the log of defense worm packet.
Example
> mngt defenseworm add 21
Add TCP port 21
Block TCP port list: 135, 137, 138, 139, 445, 21
> mngt defenseworm del 21
Delete TCP port 21
Block TCP port list: 135, 137, 138, 139, 445
Syntax
mngt rmtcfg [status]
mngt rmtcfg [enable]
mngt rmtcfg [disable]
mngt rmtcfg [http/https/ftp/telnet/ssh/tr069] [on/off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
status It means to display current setting for your reference.
enable It means to allow the system administrators to login from the
Internet.
disable It means to deny the system administrators to login from the
Internet.
http/https/ftp/telnet/ssh/t It means to specify one of the servers/protocols for enabling or
r069 disabling.
on/off on – enable the function.
off – disable the function.
Example
> mngt rmtcfg ftp on
Enable server fail
Remote configure function has been disabled
please enable by enter mngt rmtcfg enable
Syntax
mngt lanaccess -e [0/1] –s [value] –i [value]
mngt lanaccess –f
mngt lanaccess –d
mngt lanaccess –v
mngt lanaccess –h
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-e[0/1] It means to enable/disable the function.
0-disable the function.
1-enable the function.
Example
> mngt lanaccess -e 1
> mngt lanaccess -s FTP,TELNET
> mngt lanaccess -i LAN3
> > mngt lanaccess -v
Current LAN Access Control Setting:
* Enable:Yes
* Service:
- FTP:Yes
- HTTP:No
- HTTPS:No
- TELNET:Yes
- SSH:No
* Subnet:
- LAN 2: disabled
- LAN 3: enabled
- LAN 4: disabled
- LAN 5: disabled
- LAN 6: disabled
- DMZ: disabled
- IP Routed Subnet: disabled
Note: the settings do NOT apply to LAN1, LAN1 is always allowed to access
the router
Syntax
mngt echoicmp [enable]
mngt echoicmp [disable]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable It means to accept the echo ICMP packet.
disable It means to drop the echo ICMP packet.
Syntax
mngt accesslist list
mngt accesslist add [index][ip addr][mask]
mngt accesslist remove [index]
mngt accesslist flush
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
list It can display current setting for your reference.
add It means adding a new entry.
index It means to specify the number of the entry.
ip addr It means to specify an IP address.
mask It means to specify the subnet mask for the IP address.
remove It means to delete the selected item.
flush It means to remove all the settings in the access list.
Example
> mngt accesslist add 1 192.168.1.89 255.255.255.0
%% Set OK.
> mngt accesslist list
%% Access list :
Index IP address Subnet mask
==========================================
1 192.168.1.89 255.255.255.0
Syntax
mngt snmp [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-e <1/2> 1: Enable the SNMP function.
2: Disable the SNMP function.
Example
> mngt snmp -e 1 -g draytek -s DK -m 192.168.1.1 -t trapcom -n 10.20.3.40
-T 88
SNMP Agent Turn on!!!
Get Community set to draytek
Set Community set to DK
Manager Host IP set to 192.168.1.1
Trap Community set to trapcom
Notification Host IP set to 10.20.3.40
Trap Timeout set to 88 seconds
Syntax
msubnet switch [2/3/4/5][On/Off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
On/Off On means turning on the subnet for the specified LAN interface.
Off means turning off the subnet.
Example
> msubnet switch 2 On
% LAN2 Subnet On!
Syntax
msubnet addr [2/3/4/5][IP address]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
IP address Type the private IP address for the specified LAN interface.
Example
> msubnet addr 2 192.168.5.1
% Set LAN2 subnet IP address done !!!
Syntax
msubnet nmask [2/3/4/5][IP address]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
IP address Type the subnet mask address for the specified LAN interface.
Example
> msubnet nmask 2 255.255.0.0
% Set LAN2 subnet mask done !!!
Syntax
msubnet status [2/3/4/5]
Example
> msubnet status 2
% LAN2 Off: 0.0.0.0/0.0.0.0, PPP Start IP: 0.0.0.60
% DHCP server: Off
% Dhcp Gateway: 0.0.0.0, Start IP: 0.0.0.10, Pool Count: 50
Syntax
msubnet dhcps [2/3/4/5][On/Off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
On/Off On means enabling the DHCP server for the specified LAN interface.
Off means disabling the DHCP server.
Example
> msubnet dhcps 3 off
% LAN3 Subnet DHCP Server disabled!
Syntax
msubnet nat [2/3/4/5] [On/Off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
Example
> > msubnet nat 2 off
% LAN2 Subnet is for Routing usage!
%Note: If you have multiple WAN connections, please be reminded to setup
a Load-Balance policy so that packets from this subnet will be forwarded
to the right WAN interface!
Syntax
msubnet gateway [2/3/4/5] [Gateway IP]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
Gateway IP Specify an IP address as the gateway IP.
Example
> msubnet gateway 2 192.168.1.13
% Set LAN2 Dhcp Gateway IP done !!!
Syntax
msubnet ipcnt [2/3/4/5] [IP counts]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
Example
> msubnet ipcnt 2 15
This setting will take effect after rebooting.
Please use "sys reboot" command to reboot the router.
Syntax
msubnet talk [1/2/3/4/5] [1/2/3/4/5] [On/Off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
1/2/3/4/5 It means LAN interface.
1=LAN1
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
On/Off On – It means
Off - It means
Example
> msubnet talk 1 2 on
% Enable routing between LAN1 and LAN2 !
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
Gateway IP Type an IP address as the starting IP address for a subnet.
Example
> msubnet startip 2 192.168.2.90
%Set LAN2 Dhcp Start IP done !!!
Syntax
msubnet pppip [2/3/4/5] [Start IP]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
Start IP Type an IP address as the starting IP address for PPP connection.
Example
> msubnet pppip 2 192.168.2.250
% Set LAN2 PPP(IPCP) Start IP done !!!
Syntax
msubnet nodetype [2/3/4/5][count]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
count Choose the following number for specifying different node type.
1= B-node
2= P-node
4= M-node
8= H-node
0= Not specify any type for node.
Example
> msubnet nodetype ?
% msubnet nodetype <2/3/4/5> <count>
% Now: LAN2 0; LAN3 0; LAN4 0; LAN5 0
Syntax
msubnet primWINS [2/3/4/5] [WINS IP]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
Example
> > msubnet primWINS ?
% msubnet primWINS <2/3/4/5> <WINS IP>
% Now: LAN2 0.0.0.0; LAN3 0.0.0.0; LAN4 0.0.0.0; LAN5 0.0.0.0; LAN6
0.0.0.0
Syntax
msubnet secWINS [2/3/4/5] [WINS IP]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
WINS IP Type the IP address as the WINS IP.
Example
> > msubnet secWINS 2 192.168.3.89
% Set LAN2 Dhcp Secondary WINS IP done !!!
Syntax
msubnet tftp [2/3/4/5] [TFTP server name]
Example
> msubnet tftp ?
% msubnet tftp <2/3/4/5> <TFTP server name>
% Now: LAN2
LAN3
LAN4
LAN5
LAN6
Syntax
msubnet mtu [interface][value]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
interface Available settings include LAN1~LAN6, IP_Routed_Subnet, and DMZ.
value 1000 ~ 1508 (Bytes), default: 1500 (Bytes)
Example
> msubnet mtu ?
Usage:
<interface>: LAN1~LAN5,IP_Routed_Subnet,DMZ
<value>: 1000 ~ 1496 (Bytes), default: 1500 (Bytes)
Current Settings:
Syntax
object ip obj setdefault
object ip obj INDEX -v
object ip obj INDEX -n NAME
object ip obj INDEX -i INTERFACE
object ip obj INDEX -s INVERT
object ip obj INDEX -a TYPE [START_IP] [END/MASK_IP]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
INDEX It means the index number of the specified object profile.
-v It means to view the information of the specified object profile.
Example: object ip obj 1 -v
-n NAME It means to define a name for the IP object.
NAME: Type a name with less than 15 characters.
Example: object ip obj 9 -n bruce
-i INTERFACE It means to define an interface for the IP object.
INTERFACE=0, means any
INTERFACE=1, means LAN
INTERFACE=3, means WAN
Example: object ip obj 8 -i 0
-s INVERT It means to set invert seletion for the object profile.
INVERT=0, means disableing the function.
INVERT=1, means enabling the function.
Example: object ip obj 3 -s 1
-a TYPE It means to set the address type and IP for the IP object profile.
TYPE=0, means Mask
TYPE=1, means Single
TYPE=2, means Any
Example
> object ip obj 1 -n marketing
> object ip obj 1 -a 1 192.168.1.45
> object ip obj 1 -v
IP Object Profile 1
Name :[marketing]
Interface:[Any]
Address type:[single]
Start ip address:[192.168.1.45]
End/Mask ip address:[0.0.0.0]
Invert Selection:[0]
Syntax
object ip grp setdefault
object ip grp INDEX -v
object ip grp INDEX -n NAME
object ip grp INDEX -i INTERFACE
object ip grp INDEX -a IP_OBJ_INDEX
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
INDEX It means the index number of the specified group profile.
-v It means to view the information of the specified group profile.
Example: object ip grp 1 -v
-n NAME It means to define a name for the IP group.
NAME: Type a name with less than 15 characters.
Example: object ip grp 8 -n bruce
-i INTERFACE It means to define an interface for the IP group.
INTERFACE=0, means any
INTERFACE=1, means LAN
INTERFACE=2, means WAN
Example: object ip grp 3 -i 0
-a IP_OBJ_INDEX It means to specify IP object profiles for the group profile.
Example: :object ip grp 3 -a 1 2 3 4 5
The IP object profiles with index number 1,2,3,4 and 5 will be group
under such profile.
Syntax
object ip obj setdefault
object ip obj INDEX -v
object ip obj INDEX -n NAME
object ip obj INDEX -i INTERFACE
object ip obj INDEX -s INVERT
object ip obj INDEX -a TYPE [START_IP] [END/MASK_IP]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
INDEX It means the index number of the specified object profile.
-v It means to view the information of the specified object profile.
Example: object ip obj 1 -v
-n NAME It means to define a name for the IP object.
NAME: Type a name with less than 15 characters.
Example: object ip obj 9 -n bruce
-i INTERFACE It means to define an interface for the IP object.
INTERFACE=0, means any
INTERFACE=1, means LAN
INTERFACE=3, means WAN
Example: object ip obj 8 -i 0
-s INVERT It means to set invert seletion for the object profile.
INVERT=0, means disableing the function.
INVERT=1, means enabling the function.
Example: object ip obj 3 -s 1
-a TYPE It means to set the address type and IP for the IP object profile.
TYPE=0, means Mask
TYPE=1, means Single
TYPE=2, means Any
TYPE=3, means Rang
Example: object ip obj 3 -a 2
[START_IP] When the TYPE is set with 2, you have to type an IP address as a
starting point and another IP address as end point.
Type an IP address.
[END/MASK_IP] Type an IP address (different with START_IP) as the end IP address.
Example
> object ip obj 1 -n marketing
> object ip obj 1 -a 1 192.168.1.45
> object ip obj 1 -v
IP Object Profile 1
Name :[marketing]
Syntax
object ip grp setdefault
object ip grp INDEX -v
object ip grp INDEX -n NAME
object ip grp INDEX -i INTERFACE
object ip grp INDEX -a IP_OBJ_INDEX
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
INDEX It means the index number of the specified group profile.
-v It means to view the information of the specified group profile.
Example: object ip grp 1 -v
-n NAME It means to define a name for the IP group.
NAME: Type a name with less than 15 characters.
Example: object ip grp 8 -n bruce
-i INTERFACE It means to define an interface for the IP group.
INTERFACE=0, means any
INTERFACE=1, means LAN
INTERFACE=2, means WAN
Example: object ip grp 3 -i 0
-a IP_OBJ_INDEX It means to specify IP object profiles for the group profile.
Example: :object ip grp 3 -a 1 2 3 4 5
The IP object profiles with index number 1,2,3,4 and 5 will be group
under such profile.
Example
> > object ip grp 2 -n First
IP Group Profile 2
Name :[First]
Interface:[Any]
Included ip object index:
[0:][0]
[1:][0]
[2:][0]
[3:][0]
[4:][0]
[5:][0]
[6:][0]
Set ok!
Syntax
object service obj setdefault
object service obj INDEX -v
object service obj INDEX -n NAME
object service obj INDEX -p PROTOCOL
object service obj INDEX -s CHK [START_P] [END_P]
object service obj INDEX -d CHK [START_P] [END_P]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
INDEX It means the index number of the specified service object profile.
-v It means to view the information of the specified service object
profile.
Example: object service obj 1 -v
-n NAME It means to define a name for the IP object.
NAME: Type a name with less than 15 characters.
Example: object service obj 9 -n bruce
-i PROTOCOL It means to define a PROTOCOL for the service object profile.
PROTOCOL =0, means any
PROTOCOL =1, means ICMP
PROTOCOL =2, means IGMP
PROTOCOL =6, means TCP
PROTOCOL =17, means UDP
PROTOCOL =255, means TCP/UDP
Other values mean other protocols.
Example: object service obj 8 -i 0
CHK It means the check action for the port setting.
0=equal(=), when the starting port and ending port values are the
same, it indicates one port; when the starting port and ending port
values are different, it indicates a range for the port and available
for this service type.
1=not equal(!=), when the starting port and ending port values are
the same, it indicates all the ports except the port defined here;
when the starting port and ending port values are different, it
indicates that all the ports except the range defined here are
available for this service type.
2=larger(>), the port number greater than this value is available..
3=less(<), the port number less than this value is available for this
Example
> object service obj 1 -n limit
> object service obj 1 -p 255
> object service obj 1 -s 1 120 240
> object service obj 1 -d 1 200 220
> object service obj 1 -v
Service Object Profile 1
Name :[limit]
Protocol:[255]
Source port check action:[!=]
Source port range:[120~240]
Destination port check action:[!=]
Destination port range:[200~220]
Syntax
object service grp setdefault
object service grp INDEX -v
object service grp INDEX -n NAME
object service grp INDEX -a SER_OBJ_INDEX
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
INDEX It means the index number of the specified group profile.
-v It means to view the information of the specified group profile.
Example: object service grp 1 -v
-n NAME It means to define a name for the service group.
NAME: Type a name with less than 15 characters.
Example: object service grp 8 -n bruce
-a SER_OBJ_INDEX It means to specify service object profiles for the group profile.
Example: :object service grp 3 -a 1 2 3 4 5
The service object profiles with index number 1,2,3,4 and 5 will be
group under such profile.
Example
Syntax
object kw obj setdefault
object kw obj show PAGE
object kw obj INDEX -v
object kw obj INDEX -n NAME
object kw obj INDEX -a CONTENTS
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
show PAGE It means to show the contents of the specified profile.
PAGE: type the page number.
show It means to show the contents for all of the profiles.
INDEX It means the index number of the specified keyword profile.
-v It means to view the information of the specified keyword profile.
-n NAME It means to define a name for the keyword profile.
NAME: Type a name with less than 15 characters.
-a CONTENTS It means to set the contents for the keyword profile.
Example: object kw obj 40 -a test
Syntax
object fe show
object fe setdefault
object fe obj INDEX -v
object fe obj INDEX -n NAME
object fe obj INDEX -e CATEGORY|FILE_EXTENSION
object fe obj INDEX -d CATEGORY|FILE_EXTENSION
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show It means to show the contents for all of the profiles.
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
INDEX It means the index number (from 1 to 8) of the specified file
extension object profile.
-v It means to view the information of the specified file extension
object profile.
-n NAME It means to define a name for the file extension object profile.
NAME: Type a name with less than 15 characters.
-e It means to enable the specific CATEGORY or FILE_EXTENSION.
-d It means to disable the specific CATEGORY or FILE_EXTENSION
CATEGORY|FILE_EXTENSION CATEGORY:
Image, Video, Audio, Java, ActiveX, Compression, Executation
Example: object fe obj 1 -e Image
FILE_EXTENSION:
".bmp", ".dib", ".gif", ".jpeg", ".jpg", ".jpg2", ".jp2", ".pct",
".pcx", ".pic", ".pict", ".png", ".tif", ".tiff", ".asf", ".avi",
".mov", ".mpe", ".mpeg", ".mpg", ".mp4", ".qt", ".rm", ".wmv",
".3gp", ".3gpp", ".3gpp2", ".3g2", ".aac", ".aiff", ".au", ".mp3",
".m4a", ".m4p", ".ogg", ".ra", ".ram", ".vox", ".wav", ".wma",
Example
> object fe obj 1 -n music
> object fe obj 1 -e Audio
> object fe obj 1 -v
Profile Index: 1
Profile Name:[music]
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
Image category:
[ ].bmp [ ].dib [ ].gif [ ].jpeg [ ].jpg [ ].jpg2 [ ].jp2 [ ].pct
[ ].pcx [ ].pic [ ].pict [ ].png [ ].tif [ ].tiff
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
Video category:
[ ].asf [ ].avi [ ].mov [ ].mpe [ ].mpeg [ ].mpg [v].mp4 [ ].qt
[ ].rm [v].wmv [ ].3gp [ ].3gpp [ ].3gpp2 [ ].3g2
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
Audio category:
[v].aac [v].aiff [v].au [v].mp3 [v].m4a [v].m4p [v].ogg [v].ra
[v].ram [v].vox [v].wav [v].wma
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
Java category:
[ ].class [ ].jad [ ].jar [ ].jav [ ].java [ ].jcm [ ].js [ ].jse
[ ].jsp [ ].jtk
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
ActiveX category:
[ ].alx [ ].apb [ ].axs [ ].ocx [ ].olb [ ].ole [ ].tlb [ ].viv
[ ].vrm
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
Compression category:
[ ].ace [ ].arj [ ].bzip2 [ ].bz2 [ ].cab [ ].gz [ ].gzip [ ].rar
[ ].sit [ ].zip
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
Executation category:
[ ].bas [ ].bat [ ].com [ ].exe [ ].inf [ ].pif [ ].reg [ ].scr
Syntax
port [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, wan1, wan2, all] [AN, 1000F, 100F, 100H, 10F, 10H, status]
port[enable,disable] [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, all] [
port status
port sniff [on,off,port,txrx,restart,status]
port 802.1x[enable,disable,status,addport,delport]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, wan1, wan2, all It means the number of LAN port and WAN port.
AN… 10H It means the physical type for the specific port.
AN: auto-negotiate.
1000F: 1000M Full Duplex.
100F: 100M Full Duplex.
100H: 100M Half Duplex.
10F: 10M Full Duplex.
10H: 10M Half Duplex.
status It means to view the Ethernet port status.
wanfc It means to set WAN flow control.
Example
> port 1 100F
%Set Port 1 Force speed 100 Full duplex OK !!!
Syntax
portmaptime [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-t <sec> It means “TCP” protocol.
<sec>: Type a number to set the TCP session timeout.
-u <sec> It means “UDP” protocol.
<sec>: Type a number to set the UDP session timeout.
-i <sec> It means “IGMP” protocol.
<sec>: Type a number to set the IGMP session timeout.
-w <sec> It means “TCP WWW” protocol.
<sec>: Type a number to set the TCP WWW session timeout.
-s <sec> It means “TCP SYN” protocol.
<sec>: Type a number to set the TCP SYN session timeout.
-f It means to flush all portmaps (useful for diagnostics).
-l <List> List all settings.
Example
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-m <mode> Specify a mode.
1=auto
2=manual(traffic)
3=manual(qos)
4=manual(specific hosts)
0=disable
-p <proto> Specify a protocol.
proto - 1-TCP; 2-UDP; 3-Both.
-b 1/0 Enable/disable TWO-way hardware acceleration.
-M enable/disable Enable/disable the multicast hardware acceleration.
-v Show PPA_WAN_Table and PPA_LAN_Table for reference.
-c Clean all settings.
ppa n – used in QoS or specific host
-l <rule> Specify an index number of rule profile for QoS mode.
-h <host> Type an IP address for Specific Host mode.
-s <start port> Specify a starting port number for Specific Host mode.
-e <end port> Specify an ending port number for Specific Host mode
Example
> ppa -m 1 -p 1 -b 0
Set ok! The PPA mode is Auto
> ppa -v
% PPA mode is Auto
%PPA Protocol TCP 1, UDP 0
Syntax
prn status
prn debug
Example
> prn status
Interface: USB bus 2.0
Printer: NotReady
usblp_ptr=0
UsbPrintReady=0, UsbIsPrinting=0
Syntax
qos setup [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-h Type it to display the usage of this command.
-m <mode> It means to define which traffic the QoS control settings will apply
to and eable QoS control.
0: disable.
1: in, apply to incoming traffic only.
2: out, apply to outgoing traffic only.
3: both, apply to both incoming and outgoing traffic.
Example
> qos setup -m 3 -i 9500 -o 8500 -r 3:20 -u 1 -p 50 -t 1
Syntax
qos class -c [no] –[a|e|d] [no][-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-h Type it to display the usage of this command.
-c <no> Specify the inde number for the class.
Available value for <no> contains 1, 2 and 3. The default setting is
class 1.
-n <name> It means to type a name for the class.
Example
> qos class -c 2 -n draytek -a -m 1 -l 192.168.1.50:192.168.1.80
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-a <name> It means to add rule.
-e <no> It means to edit user defined service type. “no” means the index
number. Available numbers are 1~40.
-d <no> It means to delete user defined service type. “no” means the index
number. Available numbers are 1~40.
-n <name> It means the name of the service.
-t <type> It means protocol type.
6: tcp(default)
17: udp
0: tcp/udp
<1~254>: other
-p <port> It means service port. The typing format must be [start:end] (ex.,
510:330).
-l List user defined types. “no” means the index number. Available
numbers are 1~40.
Syntax
qos voip [on/off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on/off On – Enable the QoS for VoIP.
Off – Disable th QoS for VoIP.
Example
> qos voip off
QoS for VoIP: Disable; SIP Port: 5060
Example
> show lan
The LAN settings:
ip mask dhcp star_ip pool gateway
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
-----
[V]LAN1 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0 [V] 192.168.1.10 200
192.168.1.1
[X]LAN2 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0 [V] 192.168.2.10 100
192.168.2.1
[X]LAN3 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0 [V] 192.168.3.10 100
192.168.3.1
[X]LAN4 192.168.4.1 255.255.255.0 [V] 192.168.4.10 100
192.168.4.1
[X]LAN5 192.168.5.1 255.255.255.0 [V] 192.168.5.10 100
192.168.5.1
[X]LAN6 192.168.6.1 255.255.255.0 [V] 192.168.6.10 100
192.168.6.1
[X]Route 192.168.0.1 255.255.255.0 [V] 0.0.0.0 0 192.168.0.1
Example
> show dmz
% WAN1 DMZ mapping status:
Index Status WAN1 aux IP Private IP
----------------------------------------------------
1 Disable 172.16.3.221
2 Disable 192.168.1.65
Example
> show dns
%% Domain name server settings:
% Primary DNS: [Not set]
% Secondary DNS: [Not set]
Example
> show openport
%% Openport settings:
Index Status Comment Local IP Address
********************************************************
No data entry.
Example
> show nat
Port Redirection Running Table:
Example
> show portmap
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Private_IP:Port Pseudo_IP:Port Peer_IP:Port [Timeout/Protocol/Flag]
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Example
> show pmtime
Level0 TCP=86400001 UDP=300001 ICMP=10001
Level1 TCP=600000 UDP=90000 ICMP=7000
Level2 TCP=60000 UDP=30000 ICMP=5000
Example
> show session
% Maximum Session Number: 10000
% Maximum Session Usage: 49
% Current Session Usage: 0
% Current Session Used(include waiting for free): 0
% WAN1 Current Session Usage: 0
Example
> show status
System Uptime:71:2:7
LAN Status
Primary DNS:8.8.8.8 Secondary DNS:8.8.4.4
IP Address:192.168.1.1 Tx Rate:61614 Rx Rate:45219
Syntax
show traffic [wan1/wan2] [tx/rx] [weekly]
show traffic session [weekly]
Example
> show traffic session weekly0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,
0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0
,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0
,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,
,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0
,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,
,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0
,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,2 ,1 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,
,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,1 ,3 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,2 ,15 ,5 ,4 ,1 ,0 ,0 ,
,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 0 ,0 ,0 ,0
> show traffic wan1 tx weekly0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,
0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0
,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0
,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,
0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0
,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0
,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,
0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0
,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0
,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,0 ,
Syntax
show statistic
show statistic reset [interface]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
reset It means to reset the transmitted/received bytes to Zero.
interface It means to specify WAN1 ~WAN5 (including multi-PVC) interface for
displaying related statistics.
Example
> show statistic
WAN1 total TX: 0 Bytes ,RX: 0 Bytes
WAN2 total TX: 0 Bytes ,RX: 0 Bytes
WAN3 total TX: 0 Bytes ,RX: 0 Bytes
WAN4 total TX: 0 Bytes ,RX: 0 Bytes
WAN5 total TX: 0 Bytes ,RX: 0 Bytes
>
Syntax
smb setting [enable/disable]
smb setting show status
smb setting set workgroup [Workgroup name]
smb setting set host [host name]
smb setting set access [LAN or LANWAN]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable/disable Enable or disable the SMB service.
show status Display current status of SMB service.
Set workgroup [Workgroup Set a name of workgroup for SMB service.
name]
set host [host name] Set a name of the host for SMB service.
set access [LAN or LANWAN] Allow to access into SMB server by LAN or borth LAN and WAN.
Example
> smb setting enable
SMB service is enabled.
Syntax
srv dhcp dhcp2 [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-l<enable> It menas to enable the LAN port to public DHCP.
0: Disenable
1: Enable
-m<enable> It menas to enable MAC address to public DHCP.
0: Disenable
1: Enable
-e<id> It menas to turn on the flag of LAN port 1/2/3/4.
-d<id> It menas to turn off the flag of LAN port 1/2/3/4.
-v It menas to view current status.
Example
> srv dhcp dhcp2 -l 1 -e 1
> srv dhcp dhcp2 -v
2nd DHCP server flag status --
Server works on specified MAC address: ON
Server works on specified LAN port: ON
Port 1 flag: ON
Port 2 flag: ON
Port 3 flag: OFF
Port 4 flag: OFF
Syntax
srv dhcp public start [IP address]
srv dhcp public cnt [IP counts]
srv dhcp public status
srv dhcp public add [MAC Addr XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX]
srv dhcp public del [MAC Addr XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX/all/ALL]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
start It means the starting point of the IP address pool for the DHCP
server.
IP address It means to specify an IP address as the starting point in the IP
Example
Vigor> ip route add 192.168.1.56 255.255.255.0 192.168.1.12 3 default
Vigor> srv dhcp public status
Index MAC Address
Syntax
srv dhcp dns1 [?]
srv dhcp dns1 [DNS IP address]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? It means to display current IP address of DNS 1 for the DHCP server.
DNS IP address It means the IP address that you want to use as DNS1.
Note: The IP Routed Subnet DNS must be the same as NAT Subnet
DNS).
Example
> srv dhcp dns1 168.95.1.1
% srv dhcp dns1 <DNS IP address>
% Now: 168.95.1.1
(IP Routed Subnet dns same as NAT Subnet dns)
Syntax
srv dhcp dns2 [?]
srv dhcp dns2 [DNS IP address]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? It means to display current IP address of DNS 2 for the DHCP server.
DNS IP address It means the IP address that you want to use as DNS2.
Note: The IP Routed Subnet DNS must be the same as NAT Subnet
DNS).
Example
> srv dhcp dns2 10.1.1.1
% srv dhcp dns2 <DNS IP address>
% Now: 10.1.1.1
(IP Routed Subnet dns same as NAT Subnet dns)
Syntax
srv dhcp frcdnsmanl [on]
srv dhcp frcdnsmanl [off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? It means to display the current status.
on It means to use manual setting for DNS setting.
Off It means to use auto settings acquired from ISP.
Example
Syntax
srv dhcp gateway [?]
srv dhcp gateway [Gateway IP]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? It means to display current gateway that you can use.
Gateway IP It means to specify a gateway address used for DHCP server.
Example
> srv dhcp gateway 192.168.2.1
This setting will take effect after rebooting.
Please use "sys reboot" command to reboot the router.
Syntax
srv dhcp ipcnt [?]
srv dhcp ipcnt [IP counts]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? It means to display current used IP count number.
IP counts It means the number that you have to specify for the DHCP server.
Example
> srv dhcp ipcnt ?
% srv dhcp ipcnt <IP counts>
% Now: 150
Syntax
srv dhcp relay servip [server ip]
srv dhcp relay subnet [index]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
server ip It means the IP address that you want to used as DHCP server.
Index It means subnet 1 or 2. Please type 1 or 2. The router will invoke
this function according to the subnet 1 or 2 specified here.
Example
> srv dhcp relay servip 192.168.1.46
> srv dhcp relay subnet 2
> srv dhcp relay servip ?
% srv dhcp relay servip <server ip>
% Now: 192.168.1.46
Syntax
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? It means to display current used start IP address.
IP address It means the IP address that you can specify for the DHCP server as
the starting point.
Example
> srv dhcp startip 192.168.1.53
This setting will take effect after rebooting.
Please use "sys reboot" command to reboot the router.
Example
> srv dhcp status
DHCP server: Relay Agent
Default gateway: 192.168.1.1
Index IP Address MAC Address Leased Time HOST ID
1 192.168.1.113 00-05-5D-E4-D8-EE 17:20:08 A1000351
Syntax
srv dhcp leasetime [?]
srv dhcp leasetime [Lease Time (sec)]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? It means to display current leasetime used for the DHCP server.
Lease Time (sec) It means the lease time that DHCP server can use. The unit is
second.
Example
> srv dhcp leasetime ?
% srv dhcp leasetime <Lease Time (sec.)>
% Now: 86400
>
Syntax
srv dhcp nodetype <count>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
count It means to specify a type for node.
1. B-node
2. P-node
4. M-node
8. H-node
Example
> srv dhcp nodetype 1
> srv dhcp nodetype ?
%% srv dhcp nodetype <count>
%% 1. B-node 2. P-node 4. M-node 8. H-node
% Now: 1
Syntax
srv dhcp primWINS [WINS IP address]
srv dhcp primWINS clear
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
WINS IP address It means the IP address of primary WINS server.
clear It means to remove the IP address settings of primary WINS server.
Example
> srv dhcp primWINS 192.168.1.88
> srv dhcp primWINS ?
%% srv dhcp primWINS <WINS IP address>
%% srv dhcp primWINS clear
% Now: 192.168.1.88
Syntax
srv dhcp secWINS [WINS IP address]
srv dhcp secWINS clear
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
WINS IP address It means the IP address of secondary WINS server.
clear It means to remove the IP address settings of second WINS server.
Example
> srv dhcp secWINS 192.168.1.180
> srv dhcp secWINS ?
%% srv dhcp secWINS <WINS IP address>
%% srv dhcp secWINS clear
% Now: 192.168.1.180
Syntax
srv dhcp expRecycleIP <sec time>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
sec time It means to set the time (5~300 seconds) for checking if the IP can be
assigned again or not.
Example
Vigor> srv dhcp expRecycleIP 250
% DHCP expired_RecycleIP = 250
Syntax
srv dhcp tftp <TFTP server name>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
TFTP server name It means to type the name of TFTP server.
Example
> srv dhcp tftp TF123
> srv dhcp tftp ?
%% srv dhcp tftp <TFTP server name>
% Now: TF123
Syntax
srv dhcp tftpdel
Example
> srv dhcp tftp TF123
> srv dhcp tftp ?
%% srv dhcp tftp <TFTP server name>
% Now: TF123
> srv dhcp tftpdel
% The TFTP Server Name had been deleted !!!
Syntax
srv dhcp option -h
srv dhcp option -l
srv dhcp option -d [idx]
srv dhcp option -e [1 or 0] -c [option number] -v [option value]
srv dhcp option -e [1 or 0] -c [option number] -a [option value]
srv dhcp option -e [1 or 0] -c [option number] -x [option value]
srv dhcp option -u [idx unmber]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-h It means to display usage of this command.
-l It means to display all the user defined DHCP options.
-d[idx] It means to delete the option number by specifying its index number.
-e [1 or 0] It means to enable/disable custom option feature.
1:enable
0:disable
-c It means to set option number. Available number ranges from 0 to 255.
-v It means to set option number by typing string.
-a It means to set the option value by specifying the IP address.
-x It means to set option number with the format of Hexadecimal characters.
-u It means to update the option value of the sepecified index.
idx number It means the index number of the option value.
Example
> srv dhcp option -e 1 -c 18 -v /path
> srv dhcp option -l
% state idx interface opt type data
Syntax
srv nat dmz n m [-<command> <parameter> | … ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
n It means to map selected WAN IP to certain host.
1: wan1
2: wan2
m It means the index number of the DMZ host.
Default setting is “1” (WAN 1). It is only available for Static IP
mode. If you use other mode, you can set 1 ~ 8 in this field. If WAN
IP alias has been configured, then the number of DMZ host can be
added more.
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-e It means to enable/disable such feature.
1:enable
0:disable
-i It means to specify the private IP address of the DMZ host.
-r It means to remove DMZ host setting.
-v It means to display current status.
Example
> srv nat dmz 1 1 -i 192.168.1.96
> srv nat dmz -v
% WAN1 DMZ mapping status:
Index Status WAN1 aux IP Private IP
----------------------------------------------------
1 Disable 0.0.0.0 192.168.1.96
Syntax
srv nat ipsecpass [options]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[options] The available commands with parameters are listed below.
on It means to enable IPSec ESP tunnel passthrough and IKE source port
(500) preservation.
off It means to disable IPSec ESP tunnel passthrough and IKE source
port (500) preservation.
Example
> srv nat ipsecpass status
%% Status: IPsec ESP pass-thru and IKE src_port:500 preservation is
OFF.
Syntax
srv nat openport n m [-<command> <parameter> | … ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
n It means the index number for the profiles. The range is from 1 to
20.
m It means to specify the sub-item number for this profile. The range
is from 1 to 10.
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-a <enable> It means to enable or disable the open port rule profile.
0: disable
1:enable
-c <comment> It means to type the description (less than 23 characters) for the
defined network service.
-i <local ip> It means to set the IP address for local computer.
Local ip: Type an IP address in this field.
-w <idx> It means to specify the public IP.
1: WAN1 Default,
2: WAN1 Alias 1,
…and so on.
-p <protocol> Specify the transport layer protocol.
Available values are TCP, UDP and ALL.
-s<start port> It means to specify the starting port number of the service offered
by the local host. The range is from 0 to 65535.
-e<end port> It means to specify the ending port number of the service offered by
the local host.
The range is from 0 to 65535.
-v It means to display current settings.
-r <remove> It means to delete the specified open port setting.
remove: Type the index number of the profile.
-f <flush> It means to return to factory settings for all the open ports profiles.
Example
> srv nat openport 1 1 -a 1 -c games -i 192.168.1.100 -w 1 -p TCP -s
23 -e 83
> srv nat openport -v
%% Status: Disable
%% Comment:
%% Private IP address: 0.0.0.0
Index Protocal Start Port End Port
*****************************************************************
%% Status: Disable
%% Comment:
%% Private IP address: 0.0.0.0
Index Protocal Start Port End Port
*****************************************************************
>
Syntax
srv nat portmap add [idx][serv name][proto][pub port][pri ip][pri port][wan1/wan2]
srv nat portmap del [idx]
srv nat portmap disable [idx]
srv nat portmap enable [idx] [proto]
srv nat portmap flush
srv nat portmap table
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Add[idx] It means to add a new port redirection table with an index number.
Available index number is from 1 to 10.
serv name It means to type one name as service name.
proto It means to specify TCP or UDP as the protocol.
pub port It means to specify which port can be redirected to the specified
Private IP and Port of the internal host.
pri ip It means to specify the private IP address of the internal host
providing the service.
pri port It means to specify the private port number of the service offered
by the internal host.
wan1/wan2 It means to specify WAN interface for the port redirection.
del [idx] It means to remove the selected port redirection setting.
disable [idx] It means to inactivate the selected port redirection setting.
enable [idx] It means to activate the selected port redirection setting.
flush It means to clear all the port mapping settings.
Example
> srv nat portmap add 1 game tcp 80 192.168.1.11 100 wan1
> srv nat portmap table
19 0 0 0 -2
20 0 0 0 -2
Example
> srv nat status
NAT Port Redirection Running Table:
20 0 0 0.0.0.0 0
--- MORE --- ['q': Quit, 'Enter': New Lines, 'Space Bar': Next Page]
---
Example
> srv nat showall ?
Index Proto WAN IP:Port Private IP:Port Act
*************************************************************************
****
R01 TCP 0.0.0.0:80 192.168.1.11:100 Y
Syntax
switch -i [switch idx_no] [option]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
switch idx_no It means the index number of the switch profile.
option The available commands with parameters are listed below.
cmd
acc
traffic [on/off/status/tx/rx]
Example
> switch -i 1 traffic on
External Device NO. 1 traffic statistic function is enable
Example
Syntax
switch not_respond 0
switch not_respond 1
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
0 Disable the option of "No Respond to External Device packets".
1 Enable the option of "No Respond to External Device packets".
Example
> switch not_respond 1
slave not respond!
>
Example
> switch on
Enable Extrnal Device auto discovery!
Example
Example
> switch list?
No. Mac IP status Dur Time Model_Name
------------------------------------------------------------------
---------
[1] 00-50-7f-cd-07-48 192.168.1.3 On-Line 00:01:01
Vigor2920 Series
Syntax
switch clear [idx]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
idx It means the index number of each item shown on the table.
The range is from 1 to 8.
-f It means to clear all of the data.
Example
> switch clear 1
Switch Data clear successful
Example
> switch query on
Extern Device status query is Enable
> switch query off
Extern Device status query is Disable
Syntax
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
option Available options includes:
Local [0-1]
LDAP [0-1]
edit [INDEX]
delete [INDEX]
view [INDEX]
Local [0-1] 0 – Disable the local user.
1 – Enable the local user.
LDAP [0-1] 0 – Disable the LDAP.
1 – Enable the LDAP.
edit [INDEX] username Edit an existed user account or create a new local user account.
password [INDEX] – 1 ~8. There are eight profiles to be added / edited.
Username – Type a new name for local user.
Password – Type a password for local user.
delete [INDEX] Delete a local user account.
view [INDEX] Show the user account/password detail information.
Example
> sys adminuser Local 1
Local User has enabled!
> sys adminuser LDAP 1
LDAP has enabled!
>> sys adminuser edit 1 carrie test123
Updated!
>> sys adminuser view 1
Index:1
User Name:carrie
User Password:test123
Syntax
sys bonjour [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-e <enable> It is used to disable/enable bonjour service (0: disable, 1: enable).
-h <enable> It is used to disable/enable http (web) service (0: disable, 1:
enable).
-t <enable> It is used to disable/enable telnet service (0: disable, 1: enable).
Example
> sys bonjour -s 1
>
Syntax
sys cfg default
sys cfg status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
default It means to reset current settings with default values.
status It means to display current profile version and status.
Example
> sys cfg status
Profile version: 3.0.0 Status: 1 (0x491e5e6c)
> sys cfg default
>
Example
> sys cmdlog
% Commands Log: (The lowest index is the newest !!!)
[1] sys cmdlog
[2] sys cmdlog ?
[3] sys ?
[4] sys cfg status
[5] sys cfg ?
Syntax
sys ftpd on
sys ftpd off
Example
> sys ftpd on
% sys ftpd turn on !!!
Syntax
sys domainname [wan1/wan2] [Domain Name Suffix]
sys domainname [wan1/wan2] clear
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
wan1/wan2 It means to specify WAN interface for assigning a name for it.
Domain Name Suffix It means the name for the domain of the system. The maximum
number of characters that you can set is 40.
clear It means to remove the domain name of the system.
Example
> sys domainname wan1 clever
> sys domainname wan2 intellegent
> sys domainname ?
% sys domainname <wan1/wan2> <Domain Name Suffix (max. 40 characters)>
% sys domainname <wan1/wan2> clear
% Now: wan1 == clever, wan2 ==intelligent
>
Example
> sys iface
Interface 0 Ethernet:
Status: UP
IP Address: 192.168.1.1 Netmask: 0xFFFFFF00 (Private)
IP Address: 0.0.0.0 Netmask: 0xFFFFFFFF
MAC: 00-50-7F-00-00-00
Interface 4 Ethernet:
Status: DOWN
Interface 9 Ethernet:
Status: DOWN
IP Address: 0.0.0.0 Netmask: 0x00000000
MAC: 00-50-7F-00-00-07
--- MORE --- ['q': Quit, 'Enter': New Lines, 'Space Bar': Next Page]
---
>
Syntax
sys name [wan1] [ASCII string]
sys name [wan1] clear
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
wan1 It means to specify WAN interface for assigning a name for it.
ASCII string It means the name for router. The maximum character that you can
set is 20.
Example
> sys name wan1 drayrouter
> sys name ?
% sys name <wan1/wan2> <ASCII string (max. 20 characters)>
% sys name <wan1/wan2> clear
% Now: wan1 == drayrouter, wan2 ==
Note: Such name can be used to recognize router’s identification in SysLog dialog.
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
ASCII string It means the password for administrator. The maximum character
that you can set is 23.
Example
> sys passwd admin123
>
Example
> sys reboot
>
Syntax
sys autoreboot [on/off/hour(s)]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on/off On – It means to enable the function of auto-reboot.
Off – It means to disable the function of auto-reboot.
hours It means to set the time schedule for router reboot.
For example, if you type “2” in this field, the router will reboot
with an interval of two hours.
Example
> sys autoreboot on
autoreboot is ON
> sys autoreboot 2
autoreboot is ON
autoreboot time is 2 hour(s)
Example
> sys commit
Example
> sys tftpd
% TFTP server enabled !!!
Example
> sys version
Router Model: Vigor2925Vn+ Version: 3.7.4.1 English
Profile version: 3.0.0 Status: 1 (0x49165e6c)
Router IP: 192.168.1.1 Netmask: 255.255.255.0
Firmware Build Date/Time: Mar 20 2014 14:09:50
Router Name: drayrouter
Revision: 40055 2860_374
VDSL2 Firmware Version: 05-04-08-00-00-06
Example
> sys qrybuf
System Memory Status and Leakage List
Syntax
sys pollbuf [on]
sys pollbuf [off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on It means to turn on pulling buffer.
off It means to turn off pulling buffer.
Example
> sys pollbuf on
% Buffer polling is on!
Syntax
sys britask [on]
sys britask [off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on It means to turn on the bridge task for improving the triple play
quality.
off It means to turn off the bridge task.
Example
> sys britask on
% bridge task is ON, now
Syntax
sys tr069 get [parm] [option]
sys tr069 set [parm] [value]
sys tr069 getnoti [parm]
sys tr069 setnoti [parm] [value]
sys tr069 log
sys tr069 debug [on/off]
sys tr069 save
sys tr069 inform [event code]
sys tr069 port [port num]
sys tr069 cert_auth [on/off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
get [parm] [option] It means to get parameters for tr-069.
option=<nextlevel>: only gets nextlevel for GetParameterNames.
set [parm] [value] It means to set parameters for tr-069.
getnoti [parm] It means to get parameter notification value.
setnoti [parm] [value] It means to set parameter notification value.
log It means to display the TR-069 log.
debug [on/off] on: turn on the function of sending debug message to syslog.
off: turn off the function of sending debug message to syslog.
save It means to save the parameters to the flash memory of the router.
Inform [event code] It means to inform parameters for tr069 with different event codes.
[event code] includes:
0-"0 BOOTSTRAP",
1-"1 BOOT",
2-"2 PERIODIC",
3-"3 SCHEDULED",
4-"4 VALUE CHANGE",
5-"5 KICKED",
6-"6 CONNECTION REQUEST",
7-"7 TRANSFER COMPLETE",
8-"8 DIAGNOSTICS COMPLETE",
9-"M Reboot"
port [port num] It means to change tr069 listen port number.
cert_auth [on/off] on: turn on certificate-based authentication.
off: turn off certificate-based authentication.
Example
> sys tr069 get Int. nextlevel
Total number of parameter is 24
InternetGatewayDevice.X_00507F_Diagnostics.
--- MORE --- ['q': Quit, 'Enter': New Lines, 'Space Bar': Next Page]
---
Syntax
sys sip_alg [1]
sys sip_alg [0]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
1 It means to turn on SIP ALG.
0 It means to turn off SIP ALG.
Example
> sys sip_alg ?
usage: sys sip_alg [value]
0 - disable SIP ALG
1 - enable SIP ALG
current SIP ALG is disabled
Syntax
sys license licmsg
sys license licauth
sys license regser
sys license licera
sys license licifno
sys license lic_wiz [set/reg/qry]
sys license dev_chg
sys license dev_key
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
licmsg It means to display license message.
licauth It means the license authentication time setting.
regser It means the license register server setting.
licera It means to erase license setting.
licifno It means license and signature download interface setting.
lic_wiz [set/reg/qry] It means the license wizard setting.
qry: query service support status
set [idx] [trial] [service type] [sp_id] [start_date] [License Key]
reg: register service in portal
dev_chg It means to change the device key.
dev_key It means to show device key.
Example
> sys license licifno
Syntax
sys diag_log [status| enable| disable| flush| lineno [w] | level [x] | feature [on|off] [y]|
log]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
status It means to show the status of diagnostic log.
enable It means to enable the function of diag_log.
disable It means to disenable the function of diag_log.
flush It means the flush log buffer.
lineno [w] It means the total lines for displaying message.
w - Available value ranges from 100 to 50000.
level[x] It determines the level of data displayed.
x – Available value ranges from 0 to 12. The larger the number is,
the detailed the data is displayed.
feature [on/off][y] It is used to specify the function of the log. Supported features
include SYS and DSL (Case-Insensitive). Default setting is “on” for
“DSL”.
voip_feature It means VoIP feature. Type on to enable the feature or type off to
[on/off][vf_name] disable the feature.
vf_name: available settings include DRVTAPI, DRVVMMC, DRVMPS,
DRVFXO, DRVHAL, PSMPHONE, PSMSUPP, PSM, FXO, PSMISDN,
DTMFPSER, CALLERID (Case-Insensitive).
log It means the dump log buffer.
Example
> sys diag_log status
Status:
diag_log is Enabled.
lineno : 10000.
level : 3.
Enabled feature: SYS DSL
> sys diag_log log
0:00:02 [DSL] Current modem firmware: AnnexA_548006_544401
0:00:02 [DSL] Modem firmware feature: 5, ADSL_A, VDSL2
0:00:02 [DSL] xtseCfg=04 00 04 00 0c 01 00 07
0:00:02 [DSL] don't have last showtime mode!! set next mode to VDSL!!
0:00:02 [DSL] Status has changed: Stopped(0) -> FwWait(3)
0:00:02 [DSL] Status has changed: FwWait(3) -> Starting(1)
0:00:02 [DSL] Status has changed: Starting(1) -> Running(2)
0:00:02 [DSL] Status was switched: firmwareReady(3) to Init(5)
0:00:02 [DSL] Status was switched: Init(5) to Restart(10)
0:00:02 [DSL] Status was switched: Restart(10) to
FirmwareRequest(1)
0:00:02 [DSL] Line state has changed: 00000000 -> 000000FF
0:00:02 [DSL] Entering VDSL2 mode
Syntax
sys daylightsave [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[<command><parameter>|… The available commands with parameters are listed below.
] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-v Display the daylight saving settings.
-r Set to factory default setting.
-e [1/0] Enable (1) / disable (0) daylight saving.
-t [0/1/2] Specify the saving type for daylight setting.
0 – Default
1 – Time range
2 - Yearly
-s <year> <month> <day> Set the detailed settings of the starting day for time range type.
<hour> year – must be the year after 2013.
month - 1 ~ 12
day – 1 ~ 31
hour – 0 ~ 23
e.g., sys daylightsave -s 2014 3 10 12
-d <year> <month> <day> Set the detailed settings of the ending day for time range type.
<hour> year – After 2013.
month - 1 ~ 12
day – 1 ~ 31
hour – 0 ~ 23
e.g., sys daylightsave -d 2014 9 10 12
-y <month> <th weekday> Set the detailed settings of the starting day for yearly type.
<day in week> <hour> month - 1 ~ 12
th weekday – 1 ~ 5, 9: last week
day in week - 0:Sun, 1:Mon, 2:Tue, 3:Wed, 4:Thu, 5: Fri, 6:Sat
hour – 0 ~ 23
e.g, sys daylightsave -y 9 1 0 14
-z <month> <th weekday> Set the detailed settings of the ending day for yearly type.
<day in week> <hour> month - 1 ~ 12
Example
> sys daylightsave -y 9 1 0 14
% Start: Yearly on Sep 1th Sun 14:00
Syntax
sys dnsCacheTbl [<command><parameter>|…]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[<command><parameter>|… The available commands with parameters are listed below.
] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-l Display DNS IPv4 entry in the DNS cache table.
-s Display DNS IPv6 entry in the DNS cache table.
-v Display the TTL limit value in the DNS cache table.
-t < 0/n > Set the TTL limit value in the DNS cache table.
0- No limit
N – Greater than or equal to 5.
-c Clear the DNS cache table.
Example
> sys dnsCacheTbl -l
%DNS Cache Table List
> sys dnsCacheTbl -t 65
% Set TTL limit: 65 seconds.
% When TTL larger than 65s , delete the DNS entry in the router's DNS cache
tabl
e.
>
Syntax
sys syslog -a <enable> [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[<command><parameter>|… The available commands with parameters are listed below.
] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-a <1/0> Enable (1) or disable (0) Syslog Access Setup.
Example
> sys syslog -a 1 -s 1 -i 192.168.1.25 -d 514
>
Syntax
sys time server [domain]
sys time inquire
sys time show
sys time zone [index]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
domain Type the domain name of the time server. The maximum length is
39 characters.
index Different number means different time zone.
1 - GMT-12:00 Eniwetok, Kwajalein
2 - GMT-11:00 Midway Island, Samoa
3 - GMT-10:00 Hawaii
4 - GMT-09:00 Alaska
5 - GMT-08:00 Pacific Time (US & Canada)
6 - GMT-08:00 Tijuana
7 - GMT-07:00 Mountain Time (US & Canada)
8 - GMT-07:00 Arizona
9 - GMT-06:00 Central Time (US & Canada)
10 - GMT-06:00 Saskatchewan
11 - GMT-06:00 Mexico City, Tegucigalpa
12 - GMT-05:00 Eastern Time (US & Canada)
13 - GMT-05:00 Indiana (East)
14 - GMT-05:00 Bogota, Lima, Quito
15 - GMT-04:00 Atlantic Time (Canada)
16 - GMT-04:00 Caracas, La Paz
17 - GMT-04:00 Santiago
18 - GMT-03:30 Newfoundland
19 - GMT-03:00 Brasilia
Example
> sys time zone 8
Set Time Zone OK
Syntax
sys eap_tls set [0/1]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
0 Disable EAP-TLS compatibility!
1 Enable EAP-TLS compatibility!
Example
> sys eap_tls set 1
Enable EAP_TLS compatibility!
Example
> testmail
Send out test mail
Mail Alert:[Disable]
SMTP_Server:[0.0.0.0]
Mail to:[]
Return-Path:[]
Example
>upnp off
UPNP say bye-bye
Example
>upnp on
UPNP start.
Example
> upnp nat ?
****************** IGD NAT Status ****************
((0))
InternalClient >>192.168.1.10<<, RemoteHost >>0.0.0.0<<
InternalPort >>21<<, ExternalPort >>21<<
PortMapProtocol >>TCP<<
The tmpvirtual server index >>0<<
PortMapLeaseDuration >>0<<, PortMapEnabled >>0<<
Ftp Example [MICROSOFT]
((1))
InternalClient >>0.0.0.0<<, RemoteHost >>0.0.0.0<<
InternalPort >>0<<, ExternalPort >>0<<
PortMapProtocol >><NULL><<
The tmpvirtual server index >>0<<
PortMapLeaseDuration >>0<<, PortMapEnabled >>0<<
PortMapProtocol >><NULL><<
The tmpvirtual server index >>0<<
PortMapLeaseDuration >>0<<, PortMapEnabled >>0<<
0<<
--- MORE --- ['q': Quit, 'Enter': New Lines, 'Space Bar': Next Page] ---
Example
> upnp on
UPNP start.
Example
> upnp on
UPNP start.
> upnp subscribe
Vigor> upnp subscribe
>>>> (1) serviceType urn:schemas-microsoft-com:service:OSInfo:1
sid = 7a2bbdd0-0047-4fc8-b870-4597b34da7fb
expireTime =6926
active =1
DeliveryURLs
=<http://192.168.1.113:2869/upnp/eventing/twtnpnsiun>
sid = d9cd47a5-d9c9-4d3d-8043-d03a82f27983
Example
Vigor> upnp tmpvs
****************** Temp virtual server status ****************
((0))
real_addr >>192.168.1.10<<, pseudo_addr >>172.16.3.229<<
real_port >>0<<, pseudo_port >>0<<
hit_portmap_index >>0<<
The protocol >>TCP<<
time >>0<<
Syntax
upnp wan [n]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
n It means to specify WAN interface to apply UPnP.
n=0, it means to auto-select WAN interface.
n=1, WAN1
n=2, WAN2 ……….
Example
> upnp wan 1
use wan1 now.
Example
> usb list ?
Brand Module Standard
------------------------ --------
Aiko Aiko 83D 3.5G Y
BandRich Bandluxe C170 3.5G Y
BandRich Bandluxe C270 3.5G Y
BandRich Bandluxe C321 3.5G Y
BandRich Bandluxe C330 3.5G Y
BandRich Bandluxe C331 3.5G Y
BandRich Bandluxe C502 3.5G Y
Huawei Huawei E169u 3.5G Y
Huawei Huawei E220 3.5G Y
Huawei Huawei E303D 3.5G Y
Huawei Huawei E392 3.5G Y
Huawei Huawei E398 3.5G Y
Sony Erics Sony Ericsson MD30 3.5G Y
TP-LINK TP-LINK MA180 3.5G Y
TP-LINK TP-LINK MA260 3.5G Y
Vodafone Vodafone K3765-Z 3.5G Y
Vodafone Vodafone K4605 3.5G Y
ZTE ZTE MF626 3.5G Y
ZTE ZTE MF627 plus 3.5G Y
ZTE ZTE MF633 3.5G Y
ZTE ZTE MF636 3.5G Y
Syntax Description
usb user add [Index] [Username] [Password] [Permission] [Home path]
usb user rm [Index]
usb user enable [Index]
usb user disable [Index]
usb user list
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
add Add a new user profile.
Rm Delete an existed user profile.
enable Enable a user profile.
disable Disable a user profile.
list Display all of the user profile.
index It means the index number of the user profile. There are 16 profiles
allowed to be configured. So the range of such option is 1 ~ 16.
Username Type a text (maximum 11 characters) as the username for the user
profile.
Password Type a text (maximum 11 characters) as the password for the user
profile.
Permission Specify the action (RWDLCR) permitted. If one of the actions is not
allowed, simple type “-” instead.
R – Read File.
W – Write File.
D – Delete File.
L – List directory.
C – Create directory.
R – Remove selected directory.
Home path Set the path (maximum 159 characters) for the USB user profile.
Example
> usb user add 1 root 1234 R-DLCR /usr
Syntax Description
vigbrg set -v [IP version] -w [WAN_idx] -l [LAN_idx] -e [0/1] -f [0/1]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Example
> vigbrg set -v 4 -w 1 -l 1 -e 1
[WAN1] IPv4 bridge is enable. Set subnet[LAN1]
Example
> vigbrg status
%Vigor Bridge Function is enable!
Syntax
vigbrg cfgip [IP Address]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IP Address It means to type an IP address for users to manage the router.
Example
> vigbrg cfgip 192.168.1.15
> vigbrg cfgip ?
% Vigor Bridge Config IP,
% Now: 192.168.1.15
Example
> vigbrg wanstatus
Vigor Bridge: Running
WAN mac table:
Index MAC Address Stamp Time PVC VLan
Port
Example
> vigbrg wlanstatus
Vigor Bridge: Running
WAN mac table:
Index MAC Address Stamp Time PVC VLan Port
Syntax
vlan group id [set/set_ex] [p1/p2/p3/p4/s1/s2/s3/s4
Syntax Description
Example
> vlan group 3 set p1 s3 s4
VLAN p1 p2 p3 p4 s1 s2 s3 s4
-----------------------------------------------
3 V V V
>
Syntax
vlan off
Example
> vlan off
VLAN is Disable!
Force subnet LAN2/3/4 to be disabled!!
Syntax
vlan on
Example
> vlan on
VLAN is Enable!
Syntax
vlan pri n pri_no
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
n It means VLAN ID number.
n=VLAN ID number (from 0 to 7).
Example
> vlan pri 1 2
VLAN1: Priority=2
Syntax
vlan restart
Example
> vlan restart ?
VLAN restarts!!!
Syntax
vlan status
Example
> vlan status
VLAN is Enable :
------------------------------------------------------
VLAN Enable VID Pri p1 p2 p3 p4 s1 s2 s3 s4 subnet
------------------------------------------------------
0 OFF 0 0 1:LAN1
1 OFF 0 2 1:LAN1
2 OFF 0 0 1:LAN1
3 OFF 0 0 V V V 1:LAN1
4 OFF 0 0 1:LAN1
5 OFF 0 0 1:LAN1
6 OFF 0 0 1:LAN1
7 OFF 0 0 1:LAN1
------------------------------------------------------
Note: they are only untag for s1/s2/s3/s4, but they can join tag vlan
with lan
ports.
Permit untagged device in P1 to access router: ON.
Syntax
vlan subnet group_id [1/2/3/4]
Syntax Description
Example
> vlan subnet group_id 2
% Vlan Group-0 using LAN2 !
Syntax
vlan submode [on|off|status]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on It means to enable the promiscuous mode.
off It means to enable the normal mode.
status It means to display if submode is normal mode or promiscuous
mode.
Example
> vlan submode status
% vlan subnet mode : normal mode
> vlan submode on
% vlan subnet mode modified to promiscuous mode.
> vlan submode status
% vlan subnet mode : promiscuous mode
Syntax
vlan tagged [n] [on/off]
vlan tagged [unlimited] [on/off]
vlan tagged [p1_untag] [on/off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
n It means VLAN channel.
The ranage is from 0 to 7.
on/off It means to enable/disable the tagged VLAN.
[unlimited] [on/off] unlimited on: It allows the incoming of untagged packets even all
VLAN are tagged.
unlimited off: It does not allows the incoming of untagged packets.
Example
> vlan tagged unlimited on
unlimited mode is ON
Syntax
vlan vid n vid_no
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
n It means VLAN channel.
The ranage is from 0 to 7.
vid_no It means the value of VLAN ID. Type the value as the VLAN ID
number. The range is form 0 to 4095.
Example
> vlan vid 1 4095
VLAN1, vid=4095
Syntax
vlan sysvid [show | n]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show It means to show the scope of VLAN ID used internally.
n It means the value to be set as VLAN ID.
The range is from 0 to 4018.
Example
> vlan sysvid 100
You have set system VLAN ID to range: 100 ~ 177,
We recommend that you reboot the system now.
Syntax
voip debug [flush]
voip debug [showmsg]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
flush It means to clear current log.
showmsg It means to show current log.
Example
> voip debug showmsg
-->Send Message to 192.168.1.2:5060 <02:35:16>
INVITE sip:192.168.1.2 SIP/2.0
Via: SIP/2.0/UDP 192.168.1.1:5060;branch=z9hG4bK-YMa-3630;rport
From: <sip:[email protected]>;tag=WLJ-11782
To: <sip:192.168.1.2>
Call-ID: [email protected]
CSeq: 1 INVITE
Contact: <sip:[email protected]>
Max-Forwards: 70
supported: 100rel, replaces
User-Agent: DrayTek UA-1.2.3 DrayTek Vigor2910
Allow: INVITE, ACK, CANCEL, OPTIONS, BYE, INFO, REFER, NOTIFY, PRACK
Content-Type: application/sdp
Content-Length: 264
v=0
o=change_me 5972727 56415 IN IP4 192.168.1.1
Syntax
voip dialplan block n [-<command><parameter>]
voip dialplan phonebook n [-<command><parameter>]
voip dialplan region [-<command><parameter>]
voip dialplan local [1/0]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
voip dialplan block
n It means the index number of the VoIP settings.
n=1 ~ 20
-<command><parameter> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
-m 0/1 It means to enable or disable the block mode.
Example
> voip dialplan phonebook 1 -d 1125
> voip dialplan region -l 8
> voip dialplan region -v
Your Setting for Regional
Regional Function is: Enable
Return the Last Miss Call: 20
Return the Last Incoming Call: *12
Return the Last Outgoing Call: 1
Hotkey to enable call forwarding (all) function: 0
Hotkey to enable call forwarding (busy) function: *90
Hotkey to enable call forwarding (no answer) function: *92
Hotkey to disable call forwarding function: 12
Hotkey to Enable Call Waiting Function: *56
Hotkey to Disable Call Waiting Function: *57
Hotkey to Enable Hide Caller ID Function: *67
Hotkey to Disable Hide Caller ID Function: *68
Hotkey to Enable DND Function: *78
Hotkey to Disable DND Function: *79
Hotkey to Enable Block Anonymous Calls Function: *77
Hotkey to Disable Block Anonymous Calls Function: *87
Hotkey to Enable Block Unknow Domain Calls Function: *40
Hotkey to Disable Block Unknow Domain Calls Function: *04
Hotkey to Enable Block IP Calls Function: *50
Hotkey to Disable Block IP Calls Function: *05
Hotkey to Disable Block The Last Incoming Call Function: 8
Syntax
voip dsp countrytone [channel] [value]
voip dsp dialtonepwr [channel] [AbsoluteValue]
voip dsp EchoCanceller [type] [w_size] [nlp]
voip dsp cidtype [channel] [value]
voip dsp micgain [channel] [value/(1~10)]
voip dsp spkgain [channel] [value/(1~10)]
voip dsp jitterBuffer [port] [mode] [value]
voip dsp dtmfDetset [nLevel] [nTwist]
voip dsp dtmftonepwr [Level]
voip dsp cwtonepwr [ch] [value]
voip dsp pstnringfxs [1|2] [on|off]
voip dsp relaydbounce [on|off]
voip dsp setRingPat [ring_pattern_index] [patten_num]
voip dsp setDtmfCidlevel –l [value]
voip dsp setDtmfCidlevel –h [value]
voip dsp setDtmfCidlevel –r 0
voip dsp cidplusdigit [1/0] [channel] [value]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
voip dsp countrytone
[channel] [value] This command allows users to set the region for the tone settings.
Different regions usually need different tone settings.
Channel – 1 or 2.
Value – displayed as follows:
[2] UK, [3] USA, [4] Denmark, [5] Italy, [6] Germany,
[7] Netherlands, [8] Portugal, [9] Sweden, [10] Australia,
[11] Slovenia, [12] Czech, [13] Slovakia, [14] Hungary,
[15] Switzerland , [16] France , [17] Malta
voip dsp dialtonepwr
channel This setting is used to adjust the loudness of the dial tone. The
smaller the number is, the louder the dial tone is. It is
recommended for you to use the default setting.
Channel - Available channel number: 1 – 2
AbsoluteValue AbsoluteValue - In -1 dB increments, with 1 corresponding to 6 dBm.
Range - 1 to 30
voip dsp EchoCanceler
type This command is used to set the type of echo reduction.
0 - Disable the LEC processing.
1 - Cancel using the fixed window.
2 - Cancel using the fixed and moving window.
3 - Cancel using fixed window + Echo Suppressor.
Example
> voip dsp countrytone ?
VoIP has been disable. Please enable VoIP first.
> voip sip misc –D 0
System reboot now!
> voip dsp countrytone ?
> Vigor> voip dsp countrytone?
usage:
voip dsp countrytone [channel][value]
[channel]: 1-2
[value]: ( [2] UK, [3] USA, [4] Denmark, [5] Italy, [6] Germany, [7] Netherland
s, [8] Portugal, [9] Sweden, [10] Australia, [11] Slovenia, [12] Czech, [13]
Slovakia, [14] Hungary, [15] Switzerland , [16] France , [17] Malta)
============ Channel=1 ===================
current country tone: user defined
Syntax
voip rtp codec [sip acc index][type|size|vad|one][value]
voip rtp dtmf [index] [mode|payloadtype][value]
voip rtp port [start|end] [value]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
voip rtp codec
[sip acc Set the voice coding.
index][type|size|vad|one][v sip acc index –SIP account index number. Available number, 1 ~ 12.
alue]
type – Available settings include
0. G.711MU
1. G.711A
2. G.729A/B
3. G.723
4. G.726_32
size - Five options,
0 means 10ms
1 means 20ms
2 means 30ms
3 means 40ms
5 means 60ms
Vad - 0 means to Disable the function of Voice Active Detector
(vad); 1 means to Enable the function of Voice Active Detector
(vad).
One – 0 means to Disable the function of single codec; 1 means to
Enable the function of single codec.
voip rtp dtmf
[index] [mode | Set the DTMF mode and Payload type for DTMF.
payloadtype][value] Index – SIP account index number. Available number, 1 ~ 12.
Mode – Four options to be selected.
0. Inband
1. Outband
2. SIP INFO (cisco)
3. SIP INFO (nortel)
Payloadtype – Available settings 96~127.
Value – Type 0~3 or 96~127 based on the mode specified.
For example,
> voip rtp dtmf 1 mode 1
voip rtp port
start|end Specifies the start/end port for RTP stream.
value The default value is 10050/15000.
voip rtp symmetric
value Make the data transmission going through on both ends of local
router and remote router not misleading due to IP lost.
1 – Enable
0 - Disable
voip rtp tos
value Set the type of service (TOS) setting for RTP packets.
For example,
> voip rtp tos 0x899
Set TOS: 0x899
Syntax
voip sip acc n [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
voip sip calllog
voip sip ep n [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
voip sip misc[-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
voip sip nat [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
voip sip acc - Allows users to set SIP account.
n n = 1 to 12
It means the index number of the VoIP settings.
-P [profile] It means the name of the account profile (maximum 11 characters).
-r [reg mode] Set registration mode for SIP account.
0 – none
1 – auto
2 - wan1 only
3 - wan2 only
4 - lan/vpn
5 – PVC
6 - wan3 only
7 - wan4 only
8 - wan1 first
9 - wan2 first
10 - wan3 first
11 - wan4 first
-o [port] Set the port number for sending/receiving SIP message for building
a session. The default value is 5060.
-d [domain] Set the domain name or IP address of the SIP Registrar server. The
maximum is 63 characters.
-y [proxy] Set domain name or IP address of SIP proxy server. The maximum is
63 characters.
-b [enable] Enable / disable outbound proxy by SIP account.
0 – disable
1 - enable
-s [enable] Enable / disable to locate SIP server (rfc 3263).
Example
> voip sip misc -t 1
includes User-Agent header
Syntax
voip secure general [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
voip secure general -e Enable / disable secure phone feature.
0 - disable
1 - enable
voip secure general -p Enable /disable SAS voice prompt.
0 - disable
1 - enable
voip secure general -v view only secure phone general settings
Example
> voip secure general -v
secure phone feature is disabled
SAS voice prompt is enabled
> voip secure general -p 0
SAS voice prompt is disabled
Syntax
vpn l2lset [list index] peerid [peerid]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
list index It means the index number of L2L (LAN to LAN) profile.
peerid It means the peer identity for aggressive mode.
localid It means the local identity for aggressive mode.
main It means to choose proposal for main mode.
auto index It means to choose default proposals.
proposal index It means to choose specified proposal.
aggressive It means the chosen DH group for aggressive mode
pfs It means “perfect forward secrete”.
on/off It means to turn on or off the PFS function.
phase1 It means phase 1 of IKE.
lifetime It means the lifetime value (in second) for phase 1 and phase 2.
phase2 It means phase 2 of IKE.
Example
> VPN l2lset 1 peerid 10226
Syntax
vpn dinset <list index>
vpn dinset <list index> <on/off>
vpn dinset <list index> motp <on/off>
vpn dinset <list index> pin_secret <pin> <secret>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
<list index> It means the index number of the profile.
<on/off> It means to enable or disable the profile.
on – Enable.
off – Disable.
motp <on/off> It means to enable or disable the authentication with mOTP
function.
on – Enable.
Example
> vpn dinset 1
Password:
PIN: 1234
Secret: e759bb6f0e94c7ab4fe6
Syntax
vpn subnet [index] [1/2/3/4/5]
Syntax Description
Example
> vpn subnet 1 2
>
Syntax
Command of PPTP Dial-Out
vpn setup <index> <name> pptp_out <ip> <usr> <pwd> <nip> <nmask>
Command of IPSec Dial-Out
vpn setup <index> <name> ipsec_out <ip> <key> <nip> <nmask>
Command of L2Tp Dial-Out
vpn setup <index> <name> l2tp_out <ip> <usr> <pwd> <nip> <nmask>
Command of Dial-In
vpn setup <index> <name> dialin <ip> <usr> <pwd> <key> <nip> <nmask>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
For PPTP Dial-Out
<index> It means the index number of the profile.
<name> It means the name of the profile.
<ip> It means the IP address to dial to.
<usr> <pwd> It means the user and the password required for the PPTP
connection.
<nip> <nmask> It means the remote network IP and the mask.
e.g.,
vpn setup 1 name1 pptp_out 1.2.3.4 vigor 1234 192.168.1.0
255.255.255.0
For IPsec Dial-Out
<index> It means the index number of the profile.
<name> It means the name of the profile.
<ip> It means the IP address to dial to.
<key> It means the value of IPsec Pre-Shared Key.
<nip> <nmask> It means the remote network IP and the mask.
e.g.,
vpn setup 1 name1 ipsec_out 1.2.3.4 1234 192.168.1.0
Example
> vpn setup 1 name1 dialin 1.2.3.4 vigor 1234 abc 192.168.1.0
255.255.255.0
% Profile Change Log ...
% Profile Index : 1
% Profile Name : name1
% Username : vigor
% Password : 1234
% Pre-share Key : abc
% Call Direction : Dial-In
% Type of Server : ISDN PPTP IPSec L2TP
% Dial from : 1.2.3.4
% Remote NEtwork IP : 192.168.1.0
% Remote NEtwork Mask : 255.255.255.0
>
Syntax
vpn option <index> <cmd1>=<param1> [<cmd2>=<para2> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Example
> vpn option 1 idle=250
% Change Log..
Syntax
vpn mroute <index> list
vpn mroute <index> add <network ip>/<mask>
vpn mroute <index> del <network ip>/<mask>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
list It means to display all of the route settings.
add It means to add a new route.
del It means to delete specified route.
<index> It means the index number of the profile.
Available index numbers:
1 ~ 32
<network ip>/<mask> Type the IP address with the network mask address.
Syntax
vpn list <index> all
vpn list <index>com
vpn list<index>out
vpn list <index> in
vpn list<index>net
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
all It means to list configuration of the specified profile.
com It means to list common settings of the specified profile.
out It means to list dial-out settings of the specified profile.
in It means to list dial-in settings of the specified profile.
net It means to list Network Settings of the specified profile.
<index> It means the index number of the profile.
Available index numbers:
1 ~ 32
Example
> vpn list 32 all
% Common Settings
% Dial-out Settings
% Dial-In Settings
--- MORE --- ['q': Quit, 'Enter': New Lines, 'Space Bar': Next Page] ---
> vpn list 1 com
% Common Settings
Syntax
vpn remote [PPTP/IPSec/L2TP] [on/off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
PPTP/IPSec/L2TP There are four types to be selected.
on/off on – enable VPN remote setting.
off – disable VPN remote setting.
Example
> vpn remote PPTP on
Set PPTP VPN Service : On
Syntax
vpn 2ndsubnet on
vpn 2ndsubnet off
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on/off It means to enable or disable second subnet.
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show_usable Display a list of LAN to LAN dial out profiles.
backup <add/del> <name> Set multiple VPN tunnels (LAN to LAN profiles) as backup tunnel.
<Member#1> <Member#2> add/del - Add or delete a profile for used in VPN Trunk.
name – Specify the name of the VPN trunk.
Member#1 – Indicate the first LAN to LAN profile.
Member#2 – Indicate the second LAN to LAN profile.
backup more_syslog These commands are used for RD debug.
<ON/OFF>
lb more_syslog <ON/OFF>
bind more_syslog <ON/OFF>
backup ERD <name> ERD means Environment Recovers Detection.
<Normal/Recover/Resume>< name – Specify the name of the VPN trunk.
second>
Normal – Indicate the Normal mode. All dial-out VPN TRUNK backup
Example
> vpn setup 1 name1 pptp_out 1.2.3.4 vigor 1234 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0
% Profile Change Log ...
% Profile Index : 1
% Profile Name : name1j
% Username : vigor
% Password : 1234
% Call Direction : Dial-Out
% Type of Server : PPTP
% Profile Index : 2
% Profile Name : market
% Username : vigor
% Password : 5678
% Call Direction : Dial-Out
% Type of Server : PPTP
% Dial to : 5.6.7.8
% Remote NEtwork IP : 192.168.1.31
% Remote NEtwork Mask : 255.255.255.0
> vpn trunk lb add comp 1 2
%% Combination VPN Load Balance profile list :
<Index> < Name > < Member1(Active)Type > <
Member2(Act
ive)Type >
1 comp 1(YES)PPTP 2(YES)P
PTP
% Setting OK.
> vpn trunk bind set 1 y comp 2 192.168.10.1~192.168.10.2
192.168.99.1~192.168.99.254 1~65535 0 OFF
% VPN Load Balance Tunnel Bind Table Index[1] detail:
===========================================================
Action = ACTIVE
Trunk Profile(000) Name= comp
Binding Dial Out Index = 2
Binding Src IP = 192.168.10.1 ~ 192.168.10.2
Binding Dest IP = 192.168.99.1 ~ 192.168.99.254
Binding Dest Port = 1 ~ 65535
Binding Fragmented = NO
Binding Protocol = ANY Protocol
>
Syntax
vpn NetBios set <H2l/L2l> <index> <Block/Pass>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
<H2l/L2l> H2l means Remote Access User Accounts.
L2l means LAN-to-LAN Profile.
Specify which one will be applied by NetBios.
<index> The index number of the profile.
<Block/Pass> Pass – Have an inquiry for data transmission between the hosts
located on both sides of VPN Tunnel while connecting.
Block – When there is conflict occurred between the hosts on both
Example
> vpn NetBios set H2l 1 Pass
% Remote Dial In Profile Index [1] :
% NetBios Block/Pass: [PASS]
Syntax
vpn mss show
vpn mss default
vpn mss set <connection type> <TCP maximum segment size range>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show It means to display current setting status.
default TCP maximum segment size for all the VPN connection will be set as
1360 bytes.
set Use it to specify the connection type and value of MSS.
<connection type> 1~4 represent various type.
1 – PPTP
2 – L2TP
3 – IPSec
4 – L2TP over IPSec
<TCP maximum segment size Each type has different segment size range.
range> PPTP – 1 ~ 1412
L2TP – 1 ~ 1408
IPSec – 1 ~ 1381
L2TP over IPSec – 1 ~ 1361
Example
>vpn mss set 1 1400
% VPN TCP maximum segment size (MSS) :
PPTP = 1400
L2TP = 1360
IPSec = 1360
L2TP over IPSec = 1360
>vpn mss show
VPN TCP maximum segment size (MSS) :
PPTP = 1400
L2TP = 1360
IPSec = 1360
L2TP over IPSec = 1360
Syntax
vpn ike -q
Example
> vpn ike -q
IKE Memory Status and Leakage List
Syntax
vpn Multicast set <H2l/L2l> <index> <Block/Pass>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
<H2l/L2l> H2l means Host to LAN (Remote Access User Accounts).
L2l means LAN-to-LAN Profile.
<index> The index number of the profile.
<Block/Pass> Set Block/Pass the Multicast Packets.
The default is Block.
Example
> vpn Multicast set L2l 1 Pass
% Lan to Lan Profile Index [1] :
% Status Block/Pass: [PASS]
Syntax
vpn pass2nd[on]
vpn pass2nd [off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on/off on – the packets can pass through NAT.
Example
> vpn pass2nd on
% 2nd subnet is allowed to pass VPN tunnel!
Syntax
vpn pass2nat [on]
vpn pass2nat [off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on/off on – the packets can pass through NAT.
off – the packets cannot pass through NAT.
Example
> vpn pass2nat on
% Packets would go through by NAT when VPN disconnect!!
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-i [value] Specify the index number of VPN profile.
–E [0/1]] Enable or disable the IPsec with the same subnet.
1 – enable.
0 – disable.
-e [value] Translate specified LAN to virtual subnet.
1 – LAN1
2 – LAN2
3 – LAN3 …
-I [xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx] Set the virtual subnet (e.g., 172.16.3.250).
-v Display current status of virtual subnet.
Syntax
wan ppp_mru <WAN interface number> <MRU size >
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
<WAN interface number> Type a number to represent the physical interface. For Vigor130,
the number is 1 (which means WAN1).
<MRU size > It means the number of PPP LCP MRU. The available range is from
1400 to 1600.
Example
>wan ppp_mru 1 ?
% Now: 1492
Syntax
wan mtu [value]
wan mtu2 [value]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
value It means the number of MTU for PPP. The available range is from
1000 to 1500.
For Static IP/DHCP, the maximum number will be 1500.
For PPPoE, the maximum number will be 1492.
For PPTP/L2TP, the maximum number will be 1460.
Syntax
wan DF_check [on]
wan DF_check [off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on/off It means to enable or disable DF.
Example
> wan DF_check on
%DF bit check enable!
> wan DF_check off
%DF bit check disable (reset DF bit)!
Example
> wan disable WAN
%WAN disabled.
Example
> wan enable WAN
%WAN1 enabled.
Syntax
wan forward [on]
wan forward [off]
Example
> wan forward ?
%WAN forwarding is Disable!
Example
> wan status
WAN1: Offline, stall=N
Mode: ---, Up Time=00:00:00
IP=---, GW IP=---
TX Packets=0, TX Rate(Bps)=0, RX Packets=0, RX Rate(Bps)=0
Primary DNS=0.0.0.0, Secondary DNS=0.0.0.0
Syntax
wan modem [init/init2/dial/pin][string]
wan modem paponly [on/off]
wan modem backup_wait [value]
wan modem pipe [Int][Din][Dout] (for USB WAN3 only)
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
init Set initial modem AT command (default value is
“AT&FE0V1X1&D2&C1S0=0”).
Init2 Set the second initial modem AT command.
dial Set dial modem AT command (default value is “ATDT*99#”).
pin Set PIN code for SIM card.
“0”:disable
paponly It means PAP Only. Set the PPP authentication of the USB WAN.
on: None.
off: PAP or CHAP.
backup_wait Set waiting time after boot if USB WAN is in backup mode. This
waiting time is reserved for the dial of main WANs so that the
backup USB WAN will not go up first.
Available setting is from 1 to 255. Unit is second.
pipe It is for RD debug only. Please don’t use it without our advice.
wakeup [on/off] It is for RD debug only. Please don’t use it without our advice.
vid Set VID of VID/PID match to bind the USB modem to specify WAN
interface. By default, this match is not set (0x0/0x0) and the router
specifies WAN interface by USB port.
pid Set PID of VID/PID match to bind the USB modem to specify WAN
interface. By default, this match is not set (0x0/0x0) and the router
specifies WAN interface by USB port.
status Display current status of USB modem.
Example
> wan modem pin 0000
> wan modem status
Modem Link Speed=0
Current Signal Strength=0
Last Fail Message:
Current Connect Stage:
Syntax
wan wimax [on/off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
On It means to enable WAN 3G/4G DHCP mode.
Example
> wan wimax ?
Current status is wimax OFF
> wan wimax on
>
Syntax
wan lte auth [0/1]
wan lte band
wan lte del [index #/all]
wan lte pass [string]
wan lte quota [-<command><parameter>l…]
wan lte read [index #/all]
wan lte reboot [-<command><parameter>l…]
wan lte reply [-<command><parameter>l…]
wan lte send [number][message]
wan lte stus
wan lte tag [index #/all]
wan lte user [string]
wan lte wms [send[cdma/gwpp]/recv[cdma/gwgw]/setting]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
auth [0/1] Set PPP authentication of LTE WAN.
0: None.
1: PAP or CHAP.
band Display working band information for LTE network connection.
del [index #/all] Delete an SMS from the LTE SIM card by specifying the index
number. Use “all” to delete all.
pass Set the password of LTE WAN.
quota Set settings of SMS Quota Limit function.
[-<command><parameter>l… Available commands with parameter are listed below:
]
[...] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-a <0/1>: Set whether to send an e-mail alert when SMS quota
exceeded. (0: no 1: yes)
-c <cycle>: Set the order of today in refresh cycle.
-d <day>: Set the refresh day.
-e <0/1>: Enable or disable SMS Quota Limit function. (0: disable 1:
enable)
Example
> wan lte band
Syntax
wan detect [wan1/wan2][on/off/always_on]
wan detect [wan1/wan2] target [ip addr]
wan detect [wan1/wan2] target2[ip addr]
wan detect [wan1/wan2] target_gw [1/0]
wan detect [wan1/wan2] ttl [value]
wan detect [wan1/wan2] interval [interval]
wan detect [wan1/wan2] retry [retry]
wan detect status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on Enable ping detection. The IP address of the target shall be set.
off Enable ARP detection (default).
always_on Disable link detect, always connected(only support static IP)
Example
> wan detect status
WAN1: always on
WAN2: off
WAN3: off
WAN4: off
WAN5: off
> wan detect wan1 target 192.168.1.78
Set OK
Syntax
wan lb [wan1/wan2/…] on
wan lb [wan1/wan2/…] off
wan lb status
Syntax Description
Example
> wan lb status
WAN1: on
WAN2: on
WAN3: on
WAN4: on
WAN5: on
WAN6: on
WAN7: on
Syntax
wan mvlan [pvc_no/status/save/enable/disable] [on/off/clear/tag tag_no] [service
type/vlan priority] [px ... ]
wan mvlan keeptag[pvc_no][on/off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
pvc_no It means index number of PVC. There are 10 PVC, 0(Channel-1) to
9(Channel-9) allowed to be configured.
However, bridge mode can be set on PVC number 2 to 9.
status It means to display the whole Bridge status.
save It means to save the configuration into flash of Vigor router.
enable/disable It means to enable/disable the Multi-VLAN function.
on/off It means to turn on/off bridge mode for the specific channel.
clear It means to turn off/clear the port.
tag tag_no It means to tag a number for the VLAN.
-1: No need to add tag number.
1-4095: Available setting numbers used as tagged number.
service type It means to specify the service type for VLAN.
0: Normal.
1: IGMP.
vlan priority It means to specify the priority for the VALN setting.
Range is from 0 to 7.
px It means LAN port. Available setting number is from 2 to 4. Port
number 1 is locked for NAT usage.
keeptag It means Multi-VLAN packets will keep their VLAN headers to LAN.
Syntax
wan multifno [channel #] [WAN interface #]
wan multifno status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
channel # There are 4 (?) channels including VLAN and PVC.
Available settings are:
1=Channel 1
3=Channel 3
4=Channel 4
5=Channel 5
WAN interface # Type a number to indicate the WAN interface.
1=WAN1
2=WAN2
status It means to display current bridge status.
Example
> wan multifno 5 1
% Configured channel 5 uplink to WAN1
> wan multifno status
> wan multifno status
% Channel 5 uplink ifno: 3
% Channel 6 uplink ifno: 3
% Channel 7 uplink ifno: 3
% Channel 8 uplink ifno: 3
% Channel 9 uplink ifno: 3
>
Syntax
wan vlan wan [#] tag [value]
wan vlan wan [#] [enable/disable]
wan vlan stat
Example
> wan vlan stat
Syntax
wan budget wan [#] rdate [day] [hour]
wan budget wan [#] [enable|disable]
wan budget wan [#] thres [budget limit (MB)]
wan budget wan [#] gthres [budget limit (GB)]
wan budget wan [#] mode [monthly|periodic|none]
wan budget wan [#] psday [th day in periodic]
wan budget wan [#] action [action bitmap]
wan budget status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
wan[#] Specify the WAN interface.
rdate Specify the WAN budget refresh time.
day – Available settings are from 1 to 30.
hour – Available settings are from 1 to 23.
E.g., wan budget wan 1 rdate 5 10
If monthy mode is selected: WAN budget will be refreshed on 5th
day at 10:00 in each month
If periodic mode is selected: WAN budget will be refreshed every 5
days and 10 hours
enable/disable enable - Enable the function of wan budget.
disable - Disable the function of wan budget.
thres [budget limit (MB)] Specify the maximum value for WAN budget limit. (Unit: MB)
budget limit – Type a number.
gthres [budget limit (GB)] Specify the maximum value of wan budget limit. (Unit: GB)
budget limit – Type a number.
mode Specify the calculation mode (monthly, periodically, or none) for
[monthly|periodic|none] WAN budget.
Example
> wan budget wan 1 action 5
% WAN 1 budget action set to 5
> wan budget wan 1 gthres 10
% WAN 1 budget limit set to 10 GB
Syntax
wan detect_mtu -w [number] -i [Host/IP address] -s [base_size] -d [decrease_size] (-c
[count])
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-w [number] Specify the WAN interface.
Value: Type the number of WAN interface. 1: WAN1; 2:WAN2….and
etc.
-I [Host/IP address] Specify the IPv4 target to detect. If can be an IPv4 address or
domain name.
Host/IP address: Type the IP address/domain name of the target.
-s [base_size] Set the MTU size base for Discovery.
base_size: Available setting is 1000 ~ 1500.
-d [decrease size] Set the MTU size to decrease between detections.
decrease size: Available setting is 1 ~ 100.
-c [count] Set the maximum times of ping failure during a Discovery.
count: Available settings are 1 ~ 10. Default value is 3.
Example
> wan detect_mtu -w 2 -i 8.8.8.8 -s 1500 -d 30 -c 10
detecting mtu size:1500!!!
mtu size:1470!!!
Syntax
wan detect_mtu6 –w [number] –i [IPv6 address] –s [base_size]
Example
> wan detect_mtu6 -w 2 -i 2404:6800:4008:c06::5e -s 1500
>
Syntax
hsportal -p <profile> [-l <lan>] [-s <ssid>] ...
hsportal -p <profile> -c
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-p Indicate available profile to be configured.
Number of profile: 1 /2 /3 / 4.
-l Apply to LAN interfaces. E.g., apply LAN1 and LAN2:
-l 1, 2.
-s Apply to WLAN interfaces. E.g., apply SSID1 and SSID2:
-s 1, 2.
-a Apply to WLAN5G interfaces. E.g., apply SSID1 and SSID2:
-s 1, 2.
-m Select login mode.
0:skip
1:click
2:social
3:pin
4:social or pin
-f Configure facebook login.
0: disable.
1: enable.
-g Configure google login.
0: disable.
1: enable.
-h Enable HTTPS redirection.
0: disable.
1: enable.
-v Enable portal detection.
0: disable.
1: enable.
-i Configure APP id.
For example, to configure facebook APP id, you can type:
>hsportal -p 1 -f -i this_is_app_id
Profile 1 set facebook login disabled ... [OK]
-k Configure app key.
For example, to configure google APP key, you can type:
> hsportal -p 1 -g -i this_is_app_key
Profile 1 set google login disabled ... [OK]
Example
> hsportal -p 1 -c
Reset profile 1 ... [OK]
> hsportal -p 1 -r 0
Profile 1 set landing page mode 0 ... [OK]
> hsportal -p 2 -g 1 -k app_key_google
Profile 2 set google login enabled ... [OK]
Profile 2 set API KEY ... [OK]
>
Syntax
wl acl enable [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 ssid4]
wl acl disable [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 ssid4]
wl acl add [MAC] [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 ssid4] [isolate]
wl acl del [MAC]
wl acl mode [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 ssid4] [white/black]
wl acl show
wl acl showmode
wl acl clean
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 It means to enable the settings for SSID1, SSID2, SSID3 and SSID4.
ssid4]
disable [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 It means to disable the settings for SSID1, SSID2, SSID3 and SSID4.
ssid4]
add [MAC] [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 It means to associate a MAC address to certain SSID interfaces'
ssid4] [isolate] access control settings. The isolate setting will limit the wireless
client's network capabilities to accessing the wireless LAN only.
[MAC] format: xx-xx-xx-xx-xx-xx
or xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx
or xx.xx.xx.xx.xx.xx
del [MAC] It means to delete a MAC address entry defined in the access
control list.
mode [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 It means to set white/black list for each SSID.
ssid4] [white/black]
Example
> > wl acl showmode
ssid1: none
ssid2: none
ssid3: none
ssid4: none
> wl acl add 00-50-70-ff-12-70
Set Done !!
> wl acl add 00-50-70-ff-12-70 ssid1 ssid2 isolate
Set Done !!
> wl acl show
----------Enable Mac Address Filter---------
ssid1: dis ssid2: dis ssid3: dis ssid4: dis
----------MAC Address Filter----------
Index Attribute MAC Address Associated SSIDs
0 00:50:70:ff:12:70 ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 ssid4
1 s 00:50:70:ff:12:70 ssid1 ssid2
Syntax
wl config mode [value]
wl config mode show
wl config channel [number]
wl config preamble [enable]
wl config txburst [enable]
wl config ssid [ssid_num enable ssid_name [hidden_ssid]]
wl config security [SSID_NUMBER] [mode]
wl config ratectl [ssid_num enable upload download ]
wl config isolate [ssid_num lan member]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
mode[value] It means to select connection mode for wireless connection.
Available settings are: "11bgn", "11gn", "11n", "11bg", "11g", or "11b".
mode show It means to display what the current wireless mode is.
channel [number] It means the channel of frequency of the wireless LAN.
Syntax
wl set [SSID] [CHAN[En]]
wl set txburst [enable]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
SSID It means to type the SSID for the router. The maximum character
that you can use is 32.
CHAN[En] It means to specify required channel for the router.
CHAN: The range for the number is between 1 ~ 13.
En: type on to enable the function; type off to disable the function.
txburst [enable] It means to enhance the performance in data transmission about
40%* more (by enabling Tx Burst). It is active only when both sides
of Access Point and Station (in wireless client) invoke this function
at the same time.
0: disable the function.
1: enable the function.
Example
> wl set MKT 2 on
% New Wlan Setting is:
% SSID=MKT
% Chan=2
% Wl is Enable
Syntax
wl act [En]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
En It means to enable or disable the function of VPN isolation.
0: diable
1: enable
Example
> wl act on
% Set Wlan to Enable.
Syntax
wl scan [start]
wl scan set [wlist/blist/stime][MAC]
wl scan del [wlist/blist] [MAC]
wl scan filter [ssid/channel/mac]
wl scan show [0/1/2/3]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
start It means to start AP scanning.
set [wlist/blist/stime] Set white list/block list/scan time.
[MAC] wlist – It means to set white list for passing. MAC address must be
added in the end.
e.g., wl scan set wlist 001122aabbcc
blist – It means to set black list for blocking. MAC address must be
added in the end.
stime – It means to set scanning time. Time value (2~5 second) must
be added in the end.
e.g., wl scan set time 5
del Remove white list/block list.
e.g., wl scan del wlist 001122aabbcc
filter Set which filter you want.
ssid – scanning the AP based on SSID setting.
channel - scanning the AP based on channel setting.
mac - scanning the AP based on MAC address setting..
show [0/1/2/3] It is used to show AP list.
0 - display white list
1 - display block list,
2 - display gray/unknown list,
3 - display all list
Syntax
wl stamgt [enable/disable] [ssid_num].
wl stamgt [show] [ssid_num].
wl stamgt set [ssid_num] [c] [r]
wl stamgt reset [ssid_num].
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable/disable It means to enable/disable the station management control.
ssid_num It means channel selection.
Available channel for 2.4G: 0/1/2/3
Available channel for 5G: 4/5/6/7.
show It means to display status or configuration of the selected channel.
c It means connection time. The unit is minute.
r It means reconnection time. The unit is minute.
Example
> wl stamgt enable 1
% Station Management Status: enabled
> wl stamgt set 1 60 60
> wl stamgt show 1
NO. SSID BSSID Connect time Reconnect time
1. Draytek 00:11:22:aa:bb:cc 0d:0:58:26 0d:0:0
Syntax
wl iso_vpn [ssid] [En]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
ssid It means the number of SSID.
1: SSID1
2: SSID2
3: SSID3
Example
> wl iso_vpn 1 on
% ssid: 1 isolate vpn on :1
Syntax
wl wpa 1/2/3
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
wl wpa Type 1/2/3 to represent different WPA modes.
1 – means WPA+WPA2
2 – means WPA2 Only
3 – means WPA Only
Example
> wl wpa 1
>
Syntax
wl wmm ap QueIdx Aifsn Cwmin Cwmax Txop ACM
wl wmm bss QueIdx Aifsn Cwmin Cwmax Txop ACM
wl wmm ack Que0_Ack Que1_Ack Que2_Ack Que3_Ack
wl wmm enable SSID0 SSID1 SSID2 SSID3
wl wmm apsd value
wl wmm show
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
ap It means to set WMM for access point.
bss It means to set WMM for wireless clients.
ack It means to map to the Ack policy settings of AP WMM.
enable It means to enable the WMM for each SSID.
0: disable
1: enable
Example
> wl wmm ap 0 3 4 6 0 0
QueIdx=0: APAifsn=3,APCwmin=4,APCwmax=6, APTxop=0,APACM=0
> wl wmm enable 1 0 1 0
WMM_SSID0 =1, WMM_SSID1 =0,WMM_SSID2 =1,WMM_SSID3 =0
> wl wmm show
Enable WMM: SSID0 =1, SSID1 =0,SSID2 =1,SSID3 =0
APSD=0
QueIdx=0: APAifsn=3,APCwmin=4,APCwmax=6, APTxop=0,APACM=0
QueIdx=1: APAifsn=7,APCwmin=4,APCwmax=10, APTxop=0,APACM=0
QueIdx=2: APAifsn=1,APCwmin=3,APCwmax=4, APTxop=94,APACM=0
QueIdx=3: APAifsn=1,APCwmin=2,APCwmax=3, APTxop=47,APACM=0
QueIdx=0: BSSAifsn=3,BSSCwmin=4,BSSCwmax=10, BSSTxop=0,BSSACM=0
QueIdx=1: BSSAifsn=7,BSSCwmin=4,BSSCwmax=10, BSSTxop=0,BSSACM=0
QueIdx=2: BSSAifsn=2,BSSCwmin=3,BSSCwmax=4, BSSTxop=94,BSSACM=0
QueIdx=3: BSSAifsn=2,BSSCwmin=2,BSSCwmax=3, BSSTxop=47,BSSACM=0
AckPolicy[0]=0: AckPolicy[1]=0,AckPolicy[2]=0,AckPolicy[3]=0
Syntax
wl ht bw value
wl ht gi value
wl ht badecline value
wl ht autoba value
wl ht rdg value
wl ht msdu value
wl ht txpower value
wl ht antenna value
wl ht greenfield value
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
wl ht bw value The value you can type is 0 (for BW_20) and 1 (for BW_40).
wl ht gi value The value you can type is 0 (for GI_800) and 1 (for GI_4001)
wl ht badecline value The value you can type is 0 (for disabling) and 1 (for enabling).
wl ht autoba value The value you can type is 0 (for disabling) and 1 (for enabling).
wl ht rdg value The value you can type is 0 (for disabling) and 1 (for enabling).
wl ht msdu value The value you can type is 0 (for disabling) and 1 (for enabling).
wl ht txpower value The value you can type ranges from 1 – 6 (level).
wl ht antenna value The value you can type ranges from 0-3.
0: 2T3R
1: 2T2R
2: 1T2R
3: 1T1R
wl ht greenfield value The value you can type is 0 (for mixed mode) and 1 (for green field).
Example
> wl ht bw value 1
BW=0
<Note> Please restart wireless after you set new parameters.
> wl restart
Wireless restart................
Example
> wl restart
Wireless restart................
Syntax
wl wds mode [value]
wl wds security [value]
wl wds ap [value]
wl wds hello [value]
wl wds status
wl wds show
wl wds mac [value]
wl wds flush
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
mode [value] It means to specify connection mode for WDS.
[value]: Available settings are :
d: Disable
b: Bridge
r: Repeapter
security [value] It means to configure security mode with encrypted keys for WDS.
mode: Available settings are:
disable: No security.
wep: WEP
wpapsk [key]: WPA/PSK
wpa2psk [key]: WPA2/PSK
key: Moreover, you have to add keys for wpapsk, wpa2psk, and wep,
and specify index number of schedule profiles to be followed by the
wireless connection.
WEP keys must be in 5/13 ASCII text string or 10/26 Hexadecimal
digit format; WPA keys must be in 8~63 ASCII text string or 64
Hexadecimal digit format.
e.g.,
wl dual wds security disable
wl dual wds security wep 12345
wl dual wds security wpa2psk 12345678
ap [value] It means to enable or disable the AP function.
Value: 1 – enable the function.
0 – disable the function.
hello [value] It means to send hello message to remote end (peer).
Value: 1 – enable the function.
Example
> wl wds status
Please enable WDS hello function first.
Syntax
wl btnctl [value]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
value 0: disable
1: enable
Example
> wl btnctl 1
Enable wireless botton control
Current wireless botton control is on
>
Syntax
wl set8021x –t [0/1]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-t Specify the type (external or internal) of wireless authentication
server.
0 – Indicate the external RADIUS server.
1- Indicate the local 802.1x server.
-v View the settings of 802.1x.
Example
> wl set8021x -t 1
% <Note> Please restart wireless after you set the parameters.
> wl set8021x -v
802.1X type is : Local 802.1X
>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable [value] It means to enable wireless airtime fairness function.
1 – enable
0 – disable
Trg_num [value] Set a threshold when the active station number achieves this
number, the airtime fairness function will be applied.
Available values will be 2 to 64.
show Display current status (enable or disable) and triggering client
number for airtime fairness function.
Example
> wl artfns enable 1
> wl artfns trg_num 3
> wl artfns show
airtime fairness: enable
trg_num: 3
>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 It means to enable the settings for SSID1, SSID2, SSID3 and SSID4.
ssid4]
disable [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 It means to disable the settings for SSID1, SSID2, SSID3 and SSID4.
ssid4]
add [MAC] [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 It means to associate a MAC address to certain SSID interfaces'
ssid4] [isolate] access control settings. The isolate setting will limit the wireless
client's network capabilities to accessing the wireless LAN only.
[MAC] format: xx-xx-xx-xx-xx-xx
or xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx
or xx.xx.xx.xx.xx.xx
isolate It means to isolate the wireless connection of the wireless client
(identified with the MAC address) from LAN.
del[MAC] It means to delete a MAC address entry defined in the access
control list.
[MAC] format: xx-xx-xx-xx-xx-xx
or xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx
or xx.xx.xx.xx.xx.xx
mode [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 It means to set white/black list for each SSID.
ssid4] [white/black]
show It means to display current status of access control.
showmode It means to show the mode for each SSID.
clear It means to clear all of the access control settings.
Example
> wl_dual acl showmode
SSID1: None
SSID2: None
SSID3: None
SSID4: None
> wl_dual acl add 00-50-70-ff-12-80
> wl_acl add 00-50-70-ff-12-80 ssid1 ssid2 isolate
Set Done !!
> wl_acl show
----------Enable Mac Address Filter---------
ssid1: dis ssid2: dis ssid3: dis ssid4: dis
----------MAC Address Filter----------
Syntax
wl_dual apscan start
wl_dual apscan show
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
start It means to execute the AP scanning.
show It means to display the content of the AP list.
Example
> wl_dual apscan start
> wl_dual apscan show
AP scan is ongoing.
> wl_dual apscan ?
% wl_dual apscan [start/show]
% start: do AP scan
% show: show AP list
Example
> wl_dual cardmac
Card MAC: 54:2a:a2:37:00:ef
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable[value] It means to enable/disable the 5GHz wireless function.
1: enable
0: disable
show It means to display if 5G wireless function is enabled or not.
mode[value] It means to select connection mode for wireless connection.
Available settings are: "11a", "11n_5g", "11n" and "11an".
mode show It means to display what the current wireless mode is.
channel [number] It means the channel of frequency of the wireless LAN.
The available settings are: 36, 40, 44, 48, 52, 56, 60, 64, 100, 104,
108, 112, 116, 120, 124, 128, 132, 136 and 140.
number=0, means Auto
number=36, means Channel 36
….
Number=52, means Channel 52.
channel show It means to display what the current channel is.
preamble [enable] It means to define the length of the sync field in an 802.11 packet.
Most modern wireless network uses short preamble with 56 bit sync
field instead of long preamble with 128 bit sync field. However,
some original 11b wireless network devices only support long
preamble.
0: disable to use long preamble.
1: enable to use long preamble.
preamble show It means to display if preamble is enabled or not.
ssid[ssid_num enable It means to set the name of the SSID, hide the SSID if required.
ssid_name] ssid_num: Type 1, 2, 3 or 4 to specify SSID1, SSID2, SSID3 or SSID4.
ssid_name: Give a name for the specified SSID.
ssid hide [ssid_num enab le] It means to hide the name of the SSID if required.
ssid_num: Type 1, 2, 3 or 4 to specify SSID1, SSID2, SSID3 or SSID4.
enable: Type 0 to hide the SSID or 1 to display the SSID.
ssid show It means to display a table of SSID configuration.
ratectl [ssid_num enable It means to set the rate control for the specified SSID.
upload download] ssid_num: Choose 1, 2, 3 or 4 to specify SSID1, SSID2, SSID3 or SSID4.
enable: It means to enable the function of the rate control for the
specified SSID. 0: disable and 1:enable.
upload: It means to configure the rate control for data upload. The
unit is kbps.
Example
> wl_dual config mode 11a
Current mode is 11a
% <Note> Please restart 5G wireless after you set the channel
> wl_dual config channel 60
Current channel is 60
% <Note> Please restart 5G wireless after you set the channel.
> wl_dual config preamble 1
Long preamble is enabled
% <Note> Please restart 5G wireless after you set the parameters.
> wl_dual config ssid 1 enable dray
SSID Enable Hide_SSID Name
1 1 0 dray
% <Note> Please restart 5G wireless after you set the parameters.
> wl_dual config ssid show
SSID Enable Hide_SSID Name
1 1 0 dray
2 0 0 DrayTek_5G_Guest
3 0 0
4 0 0
Example
> wl_dual restart
5G wireless restart................
Syntax
wl_dual security[SSID_NUMBER] [mode][key][index]
wl_dual security show
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Security [SSID_NUMBER] SSID_NUMBER: Type 1, 2, 3 or 4 to specify SSID1, SSID2, SSID3 or
[mode][key][index] SSID4.
mode: Available settings are:
disable: No security.
wpa1x: WPA/802.1x Only
wpa21x: WPA2/802.1x Only
wpamix1x: Mixed (WPA+WPA2/802.1x only)
wep1x: WEP/802.1x Only
wpapsk: WPA/PSK
wpa2psk: WPA2/PSK
wpamixpsk: Mixed (WPA+WPA2)/PSK
wep: WEP
key, index: Moreover, you have to add keys for wpapsk, wpa2psk,
wpamixpsk and wep, and specify index number of schedule profiles
to be followed by the wireless connection.
WEP keys must be in 5/13 ASCII text string or 10/26 Hexadecimal
digit format; WPA keys must be in 8~63 ASCII text string or 64
Hexadecimal digit format.
show It means to display current mode selection for each SSID.
Example
> wl_dual security 1 wpa2psk 123456789e
% <Note> Please restart 5G wireless after you set the parameters.
Syntax
wl dual stalist
Status Codes :
C: Connected, No encryption.
E: Connected, WEP.
P: Connected, WPA.
A: Connected, WPA2.
B: Blocked by Access Control.
N: Connecting.
F: Fail to pass WPA/PSK authentication.
Syntax
wl_dual wds mode [value]
wl_dual wds security [value]
wl_dual wds ap [value]
wl_dual wds hello [value]
wl_dual wds status
wl_dual wds show
wl_dual wds mac add [index addr]
wl_dual wds mac clear/disable/enable [index/all]
wl_dual wds flush
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
mode [value] It means to specify connection mode for WDS.
[value]: Available settings are :
d: Disable
b: Bridge
r: Repeapter
security [value] It means to configure security mode with encrypted keys for WDS.
mode: Available settings are:
disable: No security.
wep: WEP
wpapsk [key]: WPA/PSK
wpa2psk [key]: WPA2/PSK
key: Moreover, you have to add keys for wpapsk, wpa2psk, and wep,
and specify index number of schedule profiles to be followed by the
wireless connection.
WEP keys must be in 5/13 ASCII text string or 10/26 Hexadecimal
digit format; WPA keys must be in 8~63 ASCII text string or 64
Example
> wl_dual wds status
Please enable WDS hello function first.
Mode : Bridge
Security : WEP
AP Function : Enable
Send Hello Function : Enable
Bridge :
Index Enable MAC Address
1 0 00:00:00:00:00:00
2 0 00:00:00:00:00:00
3 0 00:00:00:00:00:00
4 0 00:00:00:00:00:00
Repeater :
Index Enable MAC Address
5 0 00:00:00:00:00:00
6 0 00:00:00:00:00:00
Syntax
wl_dual wps enable [value]
wl dual wps pbc
wl_dual wps pin [code]
wl_dual wps show
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable [value] It means to enable WPS.
1 – enable
0 – disable
pbc It means to start WPS by pressing the WLAN ON/OFF WPS button on
Vigor router.
pin [code] It means to start WPS by using client PIN code.
[code]: Client PIN code (digit number).
show It means to display current WPS settings.
Example
> wl_dual wps enable 1
WPS is enabled.
> wl_dual wps pin 88563337
WPS has triggered by PIN code.
The AP will wait for WPS request from your client for 2 minutes...
Syntax
wl_dual apcli show
wl_dual apcli enable [value]
wl_dual apcli security [mode]
wl_dual apcli ssid [ssid_name]
wl_dual apcli bssid
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show Display current status of wireless AP client.
Example
> wl_dual apcli enable 1
Wireless 5G AP-Clinet is enabled
Vigor> wl_dual apcli show
% Wireless 5G AP-Clinet is enabled
% Current SSID is
%% Security Mode: disable
% Wireless 5G client is disconnected
%% data rate=---, mode=---, signal=0%
> wl_dual apcli ssid carrie
% <Note> Please restart wireless 5g after you set the parameters.
Current SSID is carrie
Syntax
wl_dual artfns enable [value]
wl_dual artfns trg_num [value]
wl_dual artfns show
wl_dual artfns status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable [value] It means to enable wireless airtime fairness function.
1 – enable
Example
> wl_dual artfns show
airtime fairness for 5G: disable
trg_num: 2
> wl_dual artfns status
airtime fairness for 5G is disabled !!!
Syntax
radius enable [0/1]
radius authport [port number]
radius client [add] [idx] -i [address] -m [mask] -p [prefix] -l [length] -s [secret]
radius client [del] [idx]
radius show
radius set_dot1x_phase1 -e [method_idx]
radius set_dot1x_phase1 -d [method_idx]
radius set_dot1x_phase2 -e [method_idx]
radius set_dot1x_phase2 -d [method_idx]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable[0/1] Enable (1) or disable (0) the RADIUS server.
authport [port number] Configure the port number for authentication.
Port number: Available range is from 0 to 65535.
Default value is “1812”.
set_auth_method [method Specify which method will be used for authentication.
Example
> radius client add 1 -i 192.168.1.1 -m 255.255.255.0 -s 123
This setting will take effect after rebooting.
Please use "sys reboot" command to reboot the router.
Syntax
local_8021x enable [0/1]
local_8021x set_localdot1x_phase1 options...
local_8021x set_localdot1x_phase2 options...
local_8021x show
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable Enable or disable the configuration.
0: disable.
1: enable.
set_localdot1x_phase1 Only support PEAP now. The method_idx for such phase1 is “1”.
set_localdot1x_phase2 Only support MS-CHAPv2 now. The method_idx for such phase2 is
“1”.
Example
> local_8021x show
% Local 802.1X enable: enable
% phase1 support method: [PEAP]
% phase2 support method: [None]
Syntax
wol up [MAC Address]/[IP Address]
wol fromWan [on/off/any]
wol fromWan_Setting [idx][ip address][mask]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
MAC Address It means the MAC address of the host.
IP address It means the LAN IP address of the host. If you want to wake up LAN
host by using IP address, be sure that that IP address has been
bound with the MAC address (IP BindMAC).
on/off/any It means to enable or disable the function of WOL from WAN.
on: enable
off: disable
any: It means any source IP address can pass through NAT and wake
up the LAN client.
This command will allow the user to choose whether WoL packets
can be passed from the Internet to the LAN network from a specific
WAN interface.
[idx][ip address] [mask] It means the index number (from 1 to 4).
These commands will allow the user to configure the LAN clients
that the user may wake up from the Internet through the use of the
WoL packet.
ip address - It means the WAN IP address.
mask - It means the mask of the IP address.
Example
> wol fromWan on
> wol fromWan_Setting 1 192.168.1.45 255.255.255.0
>
Syntax
sser set [-e|-d|-c|-l|-o|-a|-r|-b]
user edit [PROFILE_IDX] [-e|-d|-n|-p|-t|-u|-i|-q|-r|-w|-s|-m|-x|-v]
user account [USER_NAME] [-t|-d|-q|-r|-w]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
set It means to configure general setup for the user management.
edit It means to modify the selected user profile.
account It means to set time and data quota for specified user account.
User Set
-e Enable User management function.
-d Disable User management function.
-a[Profile idx][User It means to pass an IP Address.
name][IP_Address] Profile idx- type the index number of the selected profile.
User name- type the user name that you want it to pass.
IP_Address- type the IP address that you want it to pass.
-l all Show online user.
-l userl all – all of the users will be displayed on the screen.
-l ip user name – type the user name that you want to view on the
screen.
ip – type the IP address that you want to view on the screen.
-o It means to show user account information.
e.g.,-o
-c[user name] Clear the user record.
-c all user name – type the user name that you want to get clear
corresponding record.
all – all of the records will be removed.
-buser [user name] Block specifies user or IP address.
-b ip [ ip address] user name – type the user name that you want to block.
ip address –– type the IP address that you want to block.
-u user [user name] Unblock specifies user or IP address.
-u ip [ ip address] user name – type the user name that you want to unblock.
ip address –– type the IP address that you want to unblock.
-r [user name | all] Remove the user record.
user name – type the name of the user profile.
all – all of the user profile settings will be removed.
-q It means to trigger the alert tool to do authentication.
-s It means to set login service.
0:HTTPS
1:HTTP
e.g.,-s 1
User edit
Syntax
appqos view
appqos enable [0/1]
appqos traceable [-v | -e AP_INDEX CLASS | -d AP_INDEX]
appqos untraceable [-v | -e AP_INDEX CLASS | -d AP_INDEX]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
view It means to display current status of APP QoS.
enable[0/1] It means to enable or disable the function of APP QoS.
traceable/ untraceable The APPs are divided into traceable and untraceable based on their
properties.
-v It means to view the content of all traceable APs.
Use “appqos traceable –v” to display all of the traceable APS with
speficed index number.
Use “appqos untraceable –v” to display all of the untraceable APS
with speficed index number.
-e It menas to enable QoS for application(s) and assign QoS class.
AP_INDEX Each index number represents one application.
Index number: 50, 51, 52, 53, 54, 58, 60, 62, 63, 64, 65, 66, 68 are
used for 13 traceabel APPs.
Index number: 0~49, 55~59, 61, 67, 69, and 70~123 are used for 125
untraceable AP.
CLASS Specifies the QoS class of the application, from 1 to 4
1:Class 1, 2:Class 2, 3:Class 3, 4:Other Class
-d It means to disable QoS for application(s).
Example
> appqos enable 1
Syntax
nand bad
nand usage
Syntax
apm show
apm clear
apm discover
apm query
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show It displays current information of APM profile.
clear It is used to remove all of the APM profile.
discover It is used to search VigorAP on LAN.
query It is used to query any VigorAP which has been registered to APM
(Central AP Management) in Vigor2925. Information related to the
registered AP will be send back to Vigor2925 for updating the web
page of Central AP Management.
Example
> apm clear ?
Clear all clients ... done
Syntax
apm profile clone [from index][to index][[new name]
apm profile del [index]
apm profile reset
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
clone It is used to copy the same parameters settings from one profile to
another APM profile.
del It is used to delete a specified APM profile. The default (index #1)
should not be deleted.
reset It is used to reset to factory settings for WLAN profile.
summary It is used to list all of the APM profiles with required information.
show It is used to display specified APM profile.
apply It is used to apply the selected APM profile onto specified VigorAP.
from index Type an index number in this field. It is the original APM profile to
be cloned to other APM profile.
to index Type an index number in this file. It is the target profile which will
clone the parameters settings from an existed APM profile.
new name Type a name for a new APM profile.
profile index Type the index number of existed profile.
client index1/2/3/4/5 It is useful for applying the selected APM profile to the specified
VigorAP.
Example
> apm profile clone 1 2 forcarrie
(Done)
1 - - - - -
2 forcarrie DrayTek Disable x - / -
3 - - - - -
4 - - - - -
Syntax
apm cache [show]
apm cache clear
Example
> apm cache show
MAC Name Auth
------------ -------------------- --------------------
>
Syntax
apm lbcfg [set] [value]
apm lbcfg[show]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
set It means to set the load balance configuration file for APM.
Show It shows the configuration value.
[value] You need to type 10 numbers in this field. Each number represents
different setting value.
[1] – The first number means the load balance function. Type
1 – enable load balance,
0 – disable load balance.
[2] – The second number means the station limit function. Type
1 –enable station limit,
0 – disable station limit.
[3] – The third number means the traffic limit function. Type
1 – enable traffic limit,
0 – disable traffic limit.
[4] – The forth number means the limit num of station.
Available range is 3~64.
[5] – The fifth number means the upload limit function. Type
1 – enable upload limit,
0 – disable upload limit.
[6] – The sixth number means the download limit function.
Type
1 – enable download limit,
0 – disable download limit.
[7] – The seventh number means disassociation by idle time.
Type
1 – enable disassociation,
0 – disable disassociation.
[8] – The eighth number means to enable or disable disassociation
Example
> apm lbcfg show
apm LoadBalance Config :
1. Enable LoadBalance : 0
2. Enable station limit : 0
3. Enable traffic limit : 0
4. limit Number : 64
5. Upload limit : 0
6. Download limit : 0
7. Enable disassociation by idle time : 0
8. Enable disassociation by Signal strength : 0
9. Traffic limit unit (upload) : 0
10.Traffic limit unit (download) : 0
flag : 0
> apm lbcfg set 1 1 0 15 0 0 0 0 1 1
> apm lbcfg show
apm LoadBalance Config :
1. Enable LoadBalance : 1
2. Enable station limit : 1
3. Enable traffic limit : 0
4. limit Number : 15
5. Upload limit : 0
6. Download limit : 0
7. Enable disassociation by idle time : 0
8. Enable disassociation by Signal strength : 0
9. Traffic limit unit (upload) : 1
10.Traffic limit unit (download) : 1
flag : 49
Syntax
apm napdetect [get]
apm napdetect [set] [enable/disable AP Detection 1/0][Refresh Time].
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Example
Note: To check the scanning result of AP detection, use the command of “wl scan show”.
> apm napdetect set 1 1
> wl scan show 3
Sta Ch SSID BSSID BssType Security Siganl(%) Beacon
Period First Detected Last Detected
11 DrayTek-LAN-B 02:1d:aa:4c:bd:a8 AP Mixed 26 100
11 DrayTek-LAN-A 00:1d:aa:4f:bd:a8 AP Mixed 42 100
Dec 09,10:35:44 Dec 09,10:35:44
Syntax
apm apsyslog [AP_Index]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
AP_Index Specify the index number which represents VigorAP.
Example
> apm apsyslog 1
8d 02:46:09 syslog: [APM] Send Rogue AP Detection data.
8d 02:53:04 syslog: [APM] Run AP Detection / Discovery.
8d 02:56:09 syslog: [APM] Send Rogue AP Detection data.
8d 03:00:42 kernel: 60:fa:cd:55:f5:ea had disassociated.
8d 03:03:12 syslog: [APM] Run AP Detection / Discovery.
8d 03:06:09 syslog: [APM] Send Rogue AP Detection data.
8d 03:13:21 syslog: [APM] Run AP Detection / Discovery.
8d 03:16:10 syslog: [APM] Send Rogue AP Detection data.
8d 03:16:41 kernel: 60:fa:cd:55:f5:ea had associated successfully
8d 03:16:55 kernel: 60:fa:cd:55:f5:ea had disassociated.
Syntax
apm syslog
Example
> apm syslog
"2015-11-04 12:24:21", "[APM] [VigorAP900_01daa902080] Get Rogue AP Detection
Syntax
apm stanum [AP_Index]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
AP_Index Specify the index number which represents VigorAP.
Example
> apm stanum
Syntax
ha set [-<command> <parameter>| ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several parameters in one line.
-e <1/0> 1: Enable the function of High Availability (HA).
0: Disable the function of High Availability (HA).
-l <1/0> 1: Enable the function of recording the operation record of HA in
Syslog.
0: Disable the function of recording the operation record of HA in
Syslog.
-M <1/0> Specify the Redundancy Method for HA.
1: Active-Standby
0: Hot-Standby
-v <1-255> Specify the group ID (VHID)
1- 255: Setting range.
Example
> > ha set -h -4 LAN1 192.168.1.1
% Enable IPv4 Virtual IP on LAN1
% Virtual IP can not be same as router IP (192.168.1.1)!!!
>
Syntax
ha show –c
ha show –g
Example
> ha show -g
% High Availability : Disable
% Redundancy Method : Active-Standby
% Group ID : 1
% Priority ID : 10
% Preempt Mode : Enable
% Update DDNS : Disable
% Management Interface : LAN1
% Authentication Key : draytek
% Syslog : OFF
%
% [ Index | Enable | Virtual IP ]
% LAN1 On 192.168.1.0
% LAN2 - 0.0.0.0
% LAN3 - 0.0.0.0
% LAN4 - 0.0.0.0
% LAN5 - 0.0.0.0
% LAN6 - 0.0.0.0
% DMZ - 0.0.0.0
% [ Index | Enable | Virtual IPv6 ]
% LAN1 On FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% LAN2 On FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% LAN3 On FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% LAN4 On FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% LAN5 On FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% LAN6 On FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% DMZ On FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
>
Syntax
ha status –a [Detail Level]
ha status –m [Detail Level]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-a Show the status for all of the routers in HA group.
-m Show the status of local router only.
Detail Level 0: Important status.
1: Important status, plus some information.
2: Show settings
Example
> ha status -m 2
% [Local Router] DrayTek
% IP : 192.168.1.1 (FE80::21D:AAFF:FEC6:4C50)
% Status : !
% High Availability : ! Disable
% Redundancy Method : Active-Standby
% Group ID : 1
% Priority ID : 10
% Update DDNS : Disable
% Protocol : IPv4
% Management Interface: LAN1
>
Syntax
swm show [LAN_port]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
LAN_port Specify the LAN port number (1 to 5).
Example
> swm show
Syntax
swm get [MAC]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
MAC Specify the MAC address of the switch.
Example
Result: [OK].
Syntax
swm post [MAC]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
MAC Specify the MAC address of the switch.
Example
> swm post 00507ff0c33c
Start post cfg to 00507ff0c33c external switch with correct settings.
Result: [OK].>
Syntax
swm auth [show/clear]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show Display recorded external switch MAC address list.
clear Clear specific index of authentication record table.
Index range: (1 - 30)
Example
> swm auth show
===== SWM Auth Records List=====
Index Model Mac
----- ------ --------------
1 G2261 00507ff0c33c
================================
Syntax
swm extvlan [LAN_Port][VLAN_idx][Port_Description]
Example
> swm extvlan 1 1 13
Set OK.
> swm post 1
Start post cfg to LAN (1) external switch with currect settings.//post cfg
Please wait a few seconds...
Result: [OK].
System will cover the original VLAN settings on your VigorSwitch. Please backup the
configuration file before you run this function.
System also will select the physical connect port as trunk port and let it join each VLAN group.
Before using such command, please use [swm show] to check valid VLAN index firstly.
Syntax
swm enable
Syntax
swm disable
Syntax
swm group set [IDX][NAME][1][PASSWD]
swm group set [IDX][NAME][0]
swm group show
swm group add [IDX][MAC]
swm group delete [IDX][MAC]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IDX Type the number to specify the index number of the group profile.
NAME Type a name for VigorSwitch group.
PASSWD Specify a password.
1,0 1 – Set group name and password.
0 - Set group name without password.
MAC Type the MAC address of the VigorSwitch.
add/delete Add – Make the selected switch (by specifying MAC address) to be
grouped as VLAN.
Syntax
swm profile add/delete [MAC]
swm profile show
swm profile enable_all/disable_all [MAC]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Add Make the specified switch to be managed by Vigor router by typing
the MAC address.
delete Remove the specified switch from Vigor router by typing the MAC
address.
show Display all the switch devices managed under Vigor router.
Enable_all Enable all of the switch devices.
Disable_all Disable all of the switch devices.
MAC Type the MAC address of the VigorSwitch.
Example
> swm profile show
Name IP Address MAC Model Group
---------------- ---------------- ------------ ------ -------------------------
P2261 192.168.1.226 00507ff0c33c P2261 switchvlan,
Syntax
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[MAC][COMMENT] Modify the comment of VigorSwitch.
MAC - Type the MAC address of the switch.
COMMENT – Type a description for the switch.
[MAC]{NAME} Modify the name of VigorSwitch.
MAC - Type the MAC address of the switch.
NAME – Type a name for the switch.
[MAC][PASSWD] Modify the password of VigorSwitch.
MAC - Type the MAC address of the switch.
PASSWD – Type the password for the switch.
[MAC][config] Modify the config file of VigorSwitch.
MAC - Type the MAC address of the switch.
config – Type the config name of the switch.
show Display all of the switches’ status.
[MAC][PORT][FLAG][SCHED1] Modify the port description for specific switch.
[SCHED2][DESCRIPTION]
Example
> swm detail show
Idx Name MAC Comment Config Status
---- ---------------- ------------ ---------------- ------------ --------
1 P2261 00507ff0c33c justfortest 1 None Connect
Syntax
swm maintain reboot [MAC]
swm maintain reset [MAC]
swm maintain show
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Reboot [MAC] Type the MAC address of the VigorSwitch that you want to reboot.
Reset [MAC] Type the MAC address of the VigorSwitch that you want to reset.
show Display the switch status (including name, IP address, MAC and
model)
Example
Syntax
swm snmp sys [MAC]
swm snmp iftbl [MAC][port_num]
swm snmp poe [MAC]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
sys [MAC] Type the MAC address of the VigorSwitch to display the SNMP system
information.
Iftbl[MAC][port_num] Type the MAC address and the port number of the VigorSwitch to
display SNMP port interface information.
Example
> swm snmp sys 00507ff0c33c
sysDescr:20-Port 10/100/1000Base-T + 4 TP/(100/1G) SFP Combo + 2 (100/1G) SFP Po
E+ L2 Plus Managed Switch
sysObjectID:1.3.6.1.4.1.5205.2.61
sysUpTime:24 hr 8 m 46 s
sysContact:
sysName:P2261
sysLocation:
sysServices:3
ifNumber:26
3 Antenna, 253
Antenna Installation, 4
3G/4G USB Modem, 58
AP Discovery, 256
3G/4G USB Modem (DHCP mode), 77, 79
AP Maintenance, 521, 529
AP Map, 521, 530
6
APN Name, 76, 77, 79
6rd Mode, 90 APP Enforcement, 369
6rd Prefix, 91 APP Enforcement Filter, 390
6rd Prefix Length, 91 APP Enforcement Profile, 391
APP QoS, 466
8 APPE Module Version, 395
Always On, 64, 70, 81, 83, 84, 85, 86, 87, 89, 91 Band Steering, 259
TTL (Time to Live), 68, 70, 78, 80, 81, 83, 85, 86, 87, VLAN Tag insertion, 62
89, 91 VNC, 346
Tunnel, 99 Voice Active Detector, 277
Tunnel Broker, 83, 84 VoIP, 265
Tunnel ID, 84 VoIP Wizard, 268
Tunnel TTL, 89 Volume Gain, 289
TX Power, 253 VPN, 293, 501
TxBURST, 253 VPN and Remote Access, 294
VPN Backup, 325
U VPN Client Wizard, 295
VPN Dial-Out Through, 298
UDP, 331
VPN Graph, 613
Unique Local Address (ULA) configuration, 121
VPN Load Balance, 325
Update DDNS, 184
VPN Management, 510
UPnP, 154, 174
VPN Server Wizard, 301
URL Access Control, 399